485BPOS
Victory Portfolios III
STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
SEPTEMBER 1, 2024
FUND NAME
FUND
SHARES
MEMBER
SHARES
REWARD
SHARES
INSTITUTIONAL
SHARES
CLASS
A
CLASS
C
CLASS
R6
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
USAUX
UIAGX
Victory Growth Fund
USAAX
UIGRX
Victory Growth & Income Fund
USGRX
UIGIX
Victory Income Stock Fund
USISX
UIISX
Victory Income Fund
USAIX
UIINX
UINCX
URIFX
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
USSBX
UISBX
UASBX
URSBX
Victory Science & Technology
Fund
USSCX
USTCX
Victory Money Market Fund
USAXX
Victory Core Plus Intermediate
Bond Fund
USIBX
UIITX
UITBX
UITCX
URIBX
Victory High Income Fund
USHYX
UIHIX
URHIX
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
USCAX
UISCX
Victory Capital Growth Fund
USCGX
UICGX
Victory Value Fund
UVALX
UIVAX
Victory Extended Market Index
Fund
USMIX
Victory 500 Index Fund
USSPX
USPRX
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
USNQX
UINQX
UANQX
UCNQX
URNQX
Victory Global Managed
Volatility Fund
UGMVX
UGOFX
Victory Ultra Short-Term
Bond Fund
UUSTX
UUSIX
USBAX
URUSX
(each a “Fund” and together, the “Funds”)
Each Fund is a series of Victory Portfolios III (the “Trust”)
This Statement of Additional Information (“SAI”) is not a prospectus and contains information in addition to, and more detailed than, that set forth in each Fund’s prospectus. It is intended to provide you with additional information regarding the activities and operations of the Trust and the Funds and should be read in conjunction with each Fund’s prospectus dated as of the same date of this SAI as set forth above, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time (each, a “Prospectus”). The SAI is incorporated by reference, in its entirety, into each Prospectus. You may obtain a free copy of the Prospectus for each Fund by writing to Victory Portfolios III, PO Box 182593, Columbus, OH 43218-2593, or by calling toll free (800) 235-8396, or at VictoryFunds.com.
The financial statement for each Fund and the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s Report thereon for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, are included in the respective Fund’s Form N-CSR of that date and are incorporated herein by reference. The annual report to shareholders is available, without charge, on the Funds’ website or by writing or calling the Trust at the above address or toll-free phone number.


General Information
Victory Capital Management Inc. (“Victory Capital,” “Adviser,” or “Manager”) serves as the adviser of the Funds, and Victory Capital Services, Inc. (“VCS” or “Distributor”) serves as the distributor of the Funds' shares on a continuing, best-efforts basis. Prior to July 1, 2019, USAA Asset Management Company (“AMCO” or “Predecessor Adviser”) served as the adviser of the Funds and USAA Investment Management Company served as the distributor of the Funds' shares.
The Trust, formerly known as USAA Mutual Funds Trust and USAA State Tax-Free Trust, is an open-end management investment company established as a statutory trust under the laws of the state of Delaware pursuant to a Master Trust Agreement dated June 21, 1993, as amended. The Trust is authorized to issue shares of beneficial interest in separate portfolios. The Trust currently includes 45 portfolios, 23 of which are described in this SAI.
For purposes of this SAI, the Victory Aggressive Growth Fund, Victory Capital Growth Fund, Victory Growth Fund, Victory Growth & Income Fund, victory Income Stock Fund, Victory Science & Technology Fund, Victory Small Cap Stock Fund, Victory Value Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, Victory Extended Market Index Fund, and Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund are referred to as "Equity Funds," while the Victory Income Fund, Victory High Income Fund, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund, Victory Money Market Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund are referred to as "Fixed Income Funds."
Much of the information in this SAI is intended to provide you with additional information regarding the activities and operations of the Trust and the Funds and should be read in conjunction with each Fund’s Prospectus. The Prospectus provides the basic information you should know before investing in a Fund.
Valuation of Securities
A Fund’s net asset value (“NAV”) per share is calculated each day, Monday through Friday, except days on which the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) is closed. The NYSE currently is scheduled to be closed on New Year’s Day, Martin Luther King, Jr. Day, Presidents’ Day, Good Friday, Memorial Day, Juneteenth, Independence Day, Labor Day, Thanksgiving, and Christmas, and on the preceding Friday or subsequent Monday when one of these holidays falls on a Saturday or Sunday, respectively. Each Fund reserves the right to calculate the NAV per share on a business day that the NYSE is closed.
The Adviser, acting as the valuation designee, has established the Pricing and Liquidity Committee (the “Committee”); and subject to the Trust’s Board of Trustees (the “Board”) oversight, the Committee administers and oversees each Fund’s valuation policies and procedures, which are approved by the Board. Among other things, these policies and procedures allow a Fund to use independent pricing services, quotations from securities dealers, and a wide variety of sources and information to establish and adjust the fair value of securities as events occur and circumstances warrant.
The Committee reports to the Board on a quarterly basis and provides information that assists the Board in satisfying their oversight of the Adviser's services as valuation designee. The Committee presents to the Board material fair value matters that occurred during the preceding quarter.
The Committee meets as often as necessary and makes recommendations on establishing, applying, and testing fair value methodologies. Additionally, the Committee assess and manages risk, evaluates pricing services, and applies fair value determinations in accordance with fair valuation policies and procedures.
The value of securities of each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) is determined by one or more of the following methods:
Equity securities, including exchange-traded funds (“ETFs”), exchange-traded notes (“ETNs”), and equity-linked structured notes, except as otherwise noted, traded primarily on domestic securities exchanges or the over-the-counter markets, are valued at the last sales price or official closing price on the exchange or primary market on which they trade. Equity securities traded primarily on foreign securities exchanges or markets are valued at the last quoted sale price, or the most recently determined official closing price calculated according to local market convention, available at the time a Fund is valued. If no last sale or official closing price is reported or available, the closing bid price generally is used for U.S. listed equities and the average of the bid and ask prices is used for foreign listed equities.
Securities trading in various foreign markets may take place on days when the NYSE is closed. Further, when the NYSE is open, the foreign markets may be closed. Therefore, the calculation of a Fund’s NAV may not take place at the same time the price of certain foreign securities held by a Fund is determined. In many cases, events affecting the values of foreign securities that occur between the time of their last quoted sales or official closing prices and the close of normal trading on the NYSE on a day a Fund’s NAV is calculated will not need to be reflected in the value of a Fund’s foreign securities. However, the Adviser and, if applicable, the Subadviser(s) will monitor for events that would materially affect the value of a Fund’s foreign securities. The Subadviser(s) have agreed to notify the Adviser of significant events they identify that may materially affect the value of a Fund's foreign securities. If
2

the Adviser determines that a particular event would materially affect the value of a Fund’s foreign securities, then the Committee will consider such available information that it deems relevant to determine a fair value for the affected foreign securities, in accordance with the valuation procedures. In addition, a Fund may use information from an external vendor or other sources to adjust the foreign market closing prices of foreign equity securities to reflect what the Committee believes to be the fair value of the securities as of the close of the NYSE. Fair valuation of affected foreign equity securities may occur frequently based on an assessment that events which occur on a fairly regular basis (such as U.S. market movements) are significant.
Debt securities are valued each business day by a pricing service (the “Service”) approved by the Adviser as valuation designee. The Service uses an evaluated bid or the last sales price to price securities when, in the Service’s judgment, these prices are readily available and are representative of the security’s market values. For many securities, such prices are not readily available. The Service generally prices those securities based on methods that include consideration of yields or prices of securities of comparable quality, coupon, maturity, and type; indications as to values from dealers in securities; and general market conditions.
Short-term securities with original or remaining maturities of 60 days or less generally may be valued at amortized cost, provided that it is determined that amortized cost represents the fair value of such securities. The Fund has adopted policies and procedures under which the Committee, subject to supervision by the Board, monitors the continued appropriateness of amortized cost valuations for such securities.
Repurchase agreements are valued at cost.
Investments in open-end investment companies, commingled, or other funds, other than ETFs, are valued at their NAV at the end of each business day.
Futures contracts are valued at the settlement price at the close of market on the principal exchange on which they are traded or, in the absence of any transactions that day, the values are based upon the last sale price on the prior trading date. Options contracts are valued at the mean of the last bid and ask prices. Options on futures are valued at the settlement price determined by the applicable exchange.
In the event that price quotations or valuations are not readily available, are not reflective of market value, or a significant event has been recognized in relation to a security or class of securities, the securities are valued in good faith by the Committee in accordance with valuation procedures approved by the Adviser as valuation designee. The effect of fair value pricing is that securities may not be priced on the basis of quotations from the primary market in which they are traded and the actual price realized from the sale of a security may differ materially from the fair value price. Valuing these securities at fair value is intended to cause a Fund’s NAV to be more reliable than it otherwise would be.
Fair value methods, but are not limited to, obtaining market quotations from secondary pricing services, broker-dealers, other pricing services, or widely used quotation systems. General factors considered in determining the fair value of securities include fundamental analytical data, the nature and duration of any restrictions on disposition of the securities, evaluation of credit quality, and an evaluation of the forces that influenced the market in which the securities are purchased and sold.
All securities held in the Victory Money Market Fund's are short-term debt securities, which are valued pursuant to Rule 2a-7 under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (“1940 Act”) Act and the Money Market Funds: Procedures to Stabilize Net Asset Value. This method values a security at its purchase price and, thereafter, assumes a constant amortization to maturity of any premiums or discounts. While this method provides relative certainty in valuation, it may result in periods during which the value of an instrument, as determined by amortized cost, is higher or lower than the price the Fund would receive upon the sale of the instrument.
The valuation of the Victory Money Market Fund's portfolio instruments based upon their amortized cost is subject to the Fund’s adherence to certain procedures and conditions. Consistent with regulatory requirements, the Adviser will only purchase securities with remaining maturities of 397 days or less and will maintain a dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity of no more than 60 days and a weighted average life of no more than 120 days. The Adviser will invest only in securities that have been determined to present minimal credit risk and that satisfy the quality and diversification requirements of applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).
The Board has established procedures designed to stabilize the Victory Money Market Fund's price per share, as computed for the purpose of sales and redemptions, at $1. There can be no assurance, however, that the Fund at all times will be able to maintain a constant $1 NAV per share. Such procedures include review of the Fund’s holdings at such intervals as is deemed appropriate to determine whether the Fund’s NAV, calculated by using available market quotations, deviates from $1 per share and, if so, whether such deviation may result in material dilution or is otherwise unfair to existing shareholders. In the event that it is determined that such a deviation exists, the Board will take such corrective action as it regards as necessary and appropriate. Such action may include, among other options, selling portfolio instruments prior to maturity to realize capital gains or losses or to shorten average portfolio maturity,
3

withholding dividends, establishing an NAV per share by using available market quotations, or suspending redemptions to the extent permitted under the SEC rules.
The Victory Money Market Fund may use credit ratings from the following designated nationally recognized statistical rating organizations (“NRSROs”) to determine the credit quality of a security that may be purchased by the Victory Money Market Fund under applicable securities laws: (1) Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”), (2) S&P Global Ratings (“S&P”), and (3) Fitch Ratings Inc. (“Fitch”).
Conditions of Purchase and Redemption
Nonpayment
If any order to purchase shares directly from the Trust is canceled due to nonpayment or if the Trust does not receive good funds by check or electronic funds transfer, Victory Capital Transfer Agency, Inc. (“Transfer Agent”), formerly known as USAA Transfer Agency Company d/b/a USAA Shareholder Account Services, will treat the cancellation as a redemption of shares purchased, and you may be responsible for any resulting loss incurred by a Fund or the Adviser. If you hold shares in an account with the Transfer Agent, the Transfer Agent can redeem shares from any of your account(s) with the Transfer Agent as reimbursement for all losses. In addition, you may be prohibited or restricted from making future purchases in other funds sponsored or managed by Victory Capital. A $29 fee is charged for all returned items, including checks and electronic funds transfers.
Limitations on the purchase of shares of the Victory Money Market Fund
The Victory Money Market Fund limits sales of its shares to accounts beneficially owned by natural persons. The Board has adopted policies and procedures reasonably designed to limit investments in the Victory Money Market Fund to accounts beneficially owned by natural persons. Under those policies and procedures, the Board has delegated to the Adviser the responsibility for determining whether each beneficial owner or prospective beneficial owner of shares of the Victory Money Market Fund is a natural person. Under those policies and procedures, generally the Adviser or its affiliates will rely on certain information provided in connection with opening an account when making its determination regarding natural persons. For example, where a Social Security number is provided on behalf of the beneficial owner, generally the Adviser or its affiliates will deem the beneficial owner to be a natural person eligible to invest in the Victory Money Market Fund; however, where a taxpayer identification number (also known as an employer identification number) is provided on behalf of the beneficial owner, generally the Adviser or its affiliates will deem the beneficial owner to be a non-natural person ineligible to invest in the Victory Money Market Fund. The Adviser or its affiliates also may rely on other criteria that it deems reasonable and appropriate for making its determination under the circumstances.
Transfer of Shares
Under certain circumstances, you may transfer Fund shares to another person by sending written instructions to the Transfer Agent. The account must be clearly identified, and you must include the number of shares to be transferred and the signatures of all registered owners. You also need to send written instructions signed by all registered owners and supporting documents to change an account registration due to events such as marriage or death. If a new account needs to be established, you must complete and return an application to the Transfer Agent.
Confirmations and Account Statements
Fund shareholders will receive a confirmation for each purchase, redemption, exchange, or share conversion transacted in their account. However, confirmations will not be sent for all dividend and capital gain distribution reinvestments and purchases through certain automatic investment plans and certain retirement plans, as well as certain automatic exchanges and withdrawals (excluding those in money market funds). These transactions will be confirmed at least quarterly on shareholder account statements.
Additional Information Regarding Redemption of Shares
The value of your investment at the time of redemption of your shares may be more or less than the cost at purchase, depending on the value of the securities held in each Fund’s portfolio. Requests for redemption that are subject to any special conditions or that specify an effective date other than as provided herein cannot be accepted. A gain or loss for federal income tax purposes may be realized on the redemption of shares of a Fund, depending upon their aggregate NAV when redeemed and your basis in those shares for those purposes.
Shares of a Fund may be offered to other investment companies that are structured as funds-of-funds, to institutional investors, to financial intermediaries, and to other large investors (e.g., managed account programs offered by affiliated and unaffiliated investment advisers). These investors may, from time to time, own or control a significant percentage of a Fund’s shares. Accordingly, each Fund
4

is subject to the potential for large-scale inflows and outflows as a result of purchases and redemptions by large investors in the Fund. These inflows and outflows may be frequent and could increase a Fund’s expense ratio, transaction costs, and taxable capital gain distributions (of net gains realized on the liquidation of portfolio securities to meet redemption requests), which could negatively affect the Fund’s performance and could cause shareholders to be subject to higher federal income tax with respect to their investments in the Fund. These inflows and outflows also could limit the Adviser's ability to manage investments of a Fund in an efficient manner, which could adversely impact the Fund's performance and its ability to meet its investment objective. For example, after a large inflow, a Fund may hold a higher level of cash than it might hold under normal circumstances while the Adviser seeks appropriate investment opportunities for the Fund. In addition, large inflows and outflows may limit the ability of a Fund to meet redemption requests and pay redemption proceeds within the time period stated in its prospectus because of unusual market conditions, an unusually high volume of redemption requests, or other reasons, and could cause a Fund to purchase or sell securities when it would not normally do so, which would be particularly disadvantageous for a Fund if it needs to sell securities at a time of volatility in the markets, when values could be falling.
Shares normally are redeemed in cash, although each Fund reserves the right to redeem some or all of its shares in kind by delivering securities from a Fund’s portfolio of investments, rather than cash, under unusual circumstances or in order to protect the interests of remaining shareholders. Securities distributed in kind would be valued for this purpose using the same method employed in calculating a Fund’s NAV. If a Fund redeems your shares in kind, you may bear transaction costs and will bear market risks until such securities are converted into cash.
Accounts held with the Transfer Agent with a balance of less than $500 may be subject to automatic redemption, provided that (1) the value of the account has been reduced, below the minimum initial investment in such Fund at the time the account was established, for reasons other than market action, (2) the account has remained below the minimum level for six months, and (3) 30 days’ prior written notice of the proposed redemption has been sent to you. The Trust anticipates closing certain small accounts yearly. Shares will be redeemed at the NAV on the date fixed for redemption. Prompt payment will be made directly to your bank account on file, or if none, by mail to your last known address.
Investments in the Victory Money Market Fund are limited to natural persons. Accordingly, the Victory Money Market Fund will redeem shares held by any existing shareholder that it determines is not a natural person. Consistent with guidance provided by the SEC, the Victory Money Market Fund will provide at least 60 days’ written notice to any such shareholder in advance of effecting any such redemption.
The Trust reserves the right to suspend the right of redemption or postpone the date of payment (1) for any periods during which the NYSE is closed, (2) when trading in the markets the Trust normally uses is restricted, or an emergency exists as determined by the SEC so that disposal of the Trust’s investments or determination of its NAV is not reasonably practicable, or (3) for such other periods as the SEC by order may permit for protection of the Trust’s shareholders. The Victory Money Market Fund may impose liquidity fees upon redemptions, subject to a determination by the Fund's Board that such liquidity fees are in the best interests of the Fund.
For the mutual protection of the investor and the Funds, the Trust may require a signature guarantee. If required, each signature on the account registration must be guaranteed. Signature guarantees are acceptable from FDIC member banks, brokers, dealers, municipal securities dealers, municipal securities brokers, government securities dealers, government securities brokers, credit unions, national securities exchanges, registered securities associations, clearing agencies, and savings associations. A signature guarantee for active duty military personnel stationed abroad may be provided by an officer of the United States Embassy or Consulate, a staff officer of the Judge Advocate General, or an individual’s commanding officer.
Funds' Right to Reject Purchase and Exchange Orders and Limit Trading in Accounts
The main safeguard of the Funds and each series of the Trust (together, the “Affiliated Funds”) against excessive short-term trading is their right to reject purchase or exchange orders if in the best interest of the affected Fund. In exercising this discretion to reject purchase and exchange orders, the Affiliated Funds deem that certain excessive short-term trading activities are not in the best interest of the affected Fund because such activities can hamper the efficient management of the Fund. Generally, persons with a history of three short-term transactions within 90 days or less are suspected of market timing and the shareholder’s trading privileges (other than redemption of Fund shares) will be suspended. The Affiliated Funds also reserve the right to restrict future purchases or exchanges if an investor is classified as engaged in other patterns of excessive short-term trading, including after one large disruptive purchase and redemption or exchange. Finally, each Fund reserves the right to reject any other purchase or exchange order in other situations that do not involve excessive short-term trading activities if in the best interest of the Fund. For this purpose, a short-term transaction is a purchase or redemption of a Fund and, as applicable, a subsequent redemption or purchase of the same Fund, or an exchange of all or part of that same Fund.
5

The following transactions are exempt from the excessive short-term trading activity policies described above:
• Transactions in the money market funds, Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund, and Victory Tax Exempt Short-Term Fund;
• Purchases and sales pursuant to automatic investment or withdrawal plans;
• Purchases and sales made through USAA 529 Education Savings Plan;
• Purchases and sales made in certain separately managed accounts in wrap fee programs;
• Purchases and sales by the Victory Target Retirement Funds, Victory Cornerstone Conservative Fund, and/or Victory Cornerstone Equity Fund; and
• Other transactions that are not motivated by short-term trading considerations if they are approved by Transfer Agent management personnel and are not disruptive to a Fund.
If a person is classified as having engaged in excessive short-term trading, the remedy will depend upon the trading activities of the investor in the account and related accounts and its disruptive effect, and can include warnings to cease such activity and/or restrictions or termination of trading privileges in a particular Affiliated Fund or all of the Affiliated Funds.
The Affiliated Funds rely on the Transfer Agent to review trading activity for excessive short-term trading. There can be no assurance, however, that its monitoring activities will successfully detect or prevent all excessive short-term trading. The Affiliated Funds or the Transfer Agent may exclude transactions below a certain dollar amount from monitoring and may change that dollar amount from time to time.
The Affiliated Funds seek to apply these policies and procedures uniformly to all investors; however, some investors purchase shares of Affiliated Funds through financial intermediaries that establish omnibus accounts to invest in the Affiliated Funds for their clients and submit net orders to purchase or redeem shares after combining their client orders. The Affiliated Funds subject to short-term trading policies generally treat each omnibus account as an individual investor and will apply the short-term trading policies to the net purchases and sales submitted by the omnibus account unless the Affiliated Funds or their Transfer Agent have entered into an agreement requiring the omnibus account to submit the underlying trading information for their clients upon our request and/or monitor for excessive trading. For those omnibus accounts for which we have entered into agreements to monitor excessive trading or provide underlying trade information, the financial intermediary or Affiliated Funds will review net activity in these omnibus accounts for activity that indicates potential, excessive short-term trading activity. If we detect suspicious trading activity at the omnibus account level, we will request underlying trading information and review the underlying trading activity to identify individual accounts engaged in excessive short-term trading activity. We will instruct the omnibus account to restrict, limit, or terminate trading privileges in a particular Affiliated Fund for individual accounts identified as engaging in excessive short-term trading through these omnibus accounts.
We also may rely on the financial intermediary to review and identify underlying trading activity for individual accounts engaged in excessive short-term trading activity, and to restrict, limit, or terminate trading privileges if we determine the intermediary’s policies to be at least as stringent as the Affiliated Funds’ policy. For shares purchased through financial intermediaries, there may be additional or more restrictive policies. You may wish to contact your financial intermediary to determine the policies applicable to your account.
Because of the increased costs to review underlying trading information, the Affiliated Funds will not enter into agreements with every financial intermediary that operates an omnibus account. The Affiliated Funds or their Transfer Agent could decide to enter into such contracts with financial intermediaries for all Funds or particular Funds, and can terminate such agreements at any time.
Redemption by Check
The checkwriting privilege for the Victory Money Market Fund generally is available only to existing shareholders who have previously utilized this service or to new shareholders on an exception basis. Checks must be written in amounts of at least $250.
Check reorders will be sent only to the person(s) in whose name the account is registered. The checks must be signed by the registered owner(s) exactly as the account is registered. You will continue to earn dividends until the shares are redeemed by the presentation of a check.
When a check is presented to the Transfer Agent for payment, a sufficient number of full and fractional shares from your account will be redeemed to cover the amount of the check. If the account balance is not adequate to cover the amount of a check, the check will be returned unpaid. Because the value of the account in the Victory Money Market Fund changes as dividends are accrued on a daily basis, checks may not be used to close an account.
6

The checkwriting privilege is subject to the customary rules and regulations of The Bank of New York Mellon (“BNY Mellon”) governing checking accounts. There is no charge to you for the use of the checks or for subsequent reorders of checks.
The Trust reserves the right to assess a processing fee against your account for any redemption check not honored by a clearing or paying agent. Currently, this fee is $29 and is subject to change at any time. Some examples of such dishonor are improper endorsement, checks written for an amount less than the minimum check amount, and insufficient or uncollectible funds.
The Trust, the Transfer Agent, and BNY Mellon each reserves the right to change or suspend the checkwriting privilege upon 30 days’ written notice to participating shareholders.
You may request that the Transfer Agent stop payment on a check. The Transfer Agent will use its best efforts to execute stop payment instructions but does not guarantee that such efforts will be effective. The Transfer Agent will charge you $20 for each stop payment you request.
Involuntary Redemptions
The Victory Money Market Fund will limit investments to accounts beneficially owned by natural persons. Accordingly, the Victory Money Market Fund may redeem shares held by accounts that it determines are not beneficially owned by natural persons. Consistent with guidance provided by the SEC, the Victory Money Market Fund will provide at least 60 days’ written notice in advance of effecting any such involuntary redemption. Shares held by these accounts will be sold at their NAV per share calculated on the day that the Victory Money Market Fund closes the account position and neither the Adviser, its affiliates, nor the Victory Money Market Fund will be responsible for any loss in an investor’s account or tax liability resulting from an involuntary redemption.
Purchasing Shares
Alternative Sales Arrangements — Fund Shares, Institutional Shares, Class A, Class R6, and Class C
Alternative sales arrangements permit an investor to choose the method of purchasing shares that is more beneficial depending on the amount of the purchase, the length of time the investor expects to hold shares, and other relevant circumstances. When comparing the classes of shares, when more than one is offered in the same Fund, investors should understand that the purpose and function of the Class C asset-based sales charge are the same as those of the Class A initial sales charge. Any salesperson or other person entitled to receive compensation for selling Fund shares may receive different compensation with respect to one class of shares in comparison to another class of shares. Generally, Class A shares have lower ongoing expenses than Class C shares, but are subject to an initial sales charge. Which class would be advantageous to an investor depends on the number of years the shares will be held. Over very long periods of time, the lower expenses of Class A shares may offset the cost of the Class A initial sales charge. Not all Investment Professionals (as described in each Fund’s Prospectus) will offer all classes of shares.
Each class of shares represents interests in the same portfolio investments of a Fund. However, each class has different shareholder privileges and features. The net income attributable to a particular class and the dividends payable on these shares will be reduced by incremental expenses borne solely by that class, including any asset-based sales charge to which these shares may be subject.
No initial sales charge is imposed on Class C shares. The Distributor may pay sales commissions to dealers and institutions who sell Class C shares of a Fund at the time of such sales. Payments with respect to Class C shares will equal 1.00% of the purchase price of the Class C shares sold by the dealer or institution. The Distributor will retain all payments received by it relating to Class C shares for the first year after they are purchased. After the first full year, the Distributor will make monthly payments in the amount of 0.75% for distribution services and 0.25% for personal shareholder services to dealers and institutions based on the average NAV of Class C shares, which are attributable to shareholders for whom the dealers and institutions are designated as dealers of record. Some of the compensation paid to dealers and institutions is recouped through the contingent deferred sales charge (“CDSC”) imposed on shares redeemed within 12 months of their purchase. Class C shares are subject to the Rule 12b-1 fees described in the SAI under “Rule 12b-1 Distribution and Service Plans.” Class C shares of the Funds will automatically convert to Class A shares under circumstances described in a Fund’s Prospectus. Financial institutions may be permitted to exchange Class C shares for a share class with lower expenses under circumstances described in a Fund’s Prospectus. Any options with respect to the reinvestment of distributions made by the Funds to Class C shareholders are offered only by the broker through whom the shares were acquired.
No initial sales charges or CDSCs are imposed on Institutional Shares. Institutional Shares are not subject to the Rule 12b-1 fees described in this SAI under “Rule 12b-1 Distribution and Service Plans.” There is no automatic conversion feature applicable to Institutional Shares. Distributions paid to holders of a Fund’s Institutional Shares may be reinvested in additional Institutional Shares of that Fund or Institutional Shares of a different Fund. Only certain investors are eligible to buy Institutional Shares, as set forth in a Fund’s Prospectus, and your financial adviser or other financial intermediary can help you determine whether you are eligible to invest.
7

No initial sales charges or CDSCs are imposed on Class R6 shares. Class R6 shares are not subject to the Rule 12b-1 fees described in this SAI under “Rule 12b-1 Distribution and Service Plans.” There is no automatic conversion feature applicable to Class R6 shares. Distributions paid to holders of a Fund’s Class R6 shares may be reinvested in additional Class R6 shares of that Fund or Class R6 shares of a different Fund. Class A shareholders, Class C shareholders whose shares are not subject to a CDSC and Institutional Shares shareholders may exchange into Class R6 shares of a Fund offering such shares provided they meet the eligibility requirements applicable to Class R6 shares. Only certain investors are eligible to buy Class R6 shares, as set forth in a Fund’s Prospectus, and your financial adviser or other financial intermediary can help you determine whether you are eligible to invest.
Each Fund reserves the right to change the criteria for eligible investors and the investment minimums. Each Fund also reserves the right to refuse a purchase order for any reason, including if it believes that doing so would be in the best interest of the Fund and shareholders.
The methodology for calculating the NAV, dividends, and distributions of the share classes of the Funds recognizes two types of expenses. General expenses that do not pertain specifically to a class are allocated to the shares of each class, based upon the percentage that the net assets of such class bears to a Fund’s total net assets and then pro rata to each outstanding share within a given class. Such general expenses include (1) management fees, (2) legal, bookkeeping and audit fees, (3) printing and mailing costs of shareholder reports, prospectuses, statements of additional information and other materials for current shareholders, (4) fees to the Trustees who are not affiliated with the Adviser, (5) custodian expenses, (6) share issuance costs, (7) organization and start-up costs, (8) interest, taxes and brokerage commissions, and (9) non-recurring expenses, such as litigation costs. Other expenses that are directly attributable to a class are allocated equally to each outstanding share within that class. Such expenses include (1) Rule 12b-1 distribution fees and shareholder servicing fees, (2) incremental transfer and shareholder servicing agent fees and expenses, (3) registration fees, and (4) shareholder meeting expenses, to the extent that such expenses pertain to a specific class rather than to a Fund as a whole.
Dealer Reallowances. The following table shows the amount of the front-end sales load that is reallowed to dealers as a percentage of the offering price of Class A shares of the Equity Funds, excluding the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund.
Amount of Purchase
Initial Sales Charge:
% of Offering Price
Concession to Dealers:
% of Offering Price
Up to $49,999
5.75%
5.00%
$50,000 to $99,999
4.50%
4.00%
$100,000 to $249,999
3.50%
3.00%
$250,000 to $499,999
2.50%
2.00%
$500,000 to $999,999
2.00%
1.75%
Over $1,000,000 *
0.00%
1.00%**
* There is no initial sales charge on purchases of $1 million or more; however, a sales concession and/or advance of a Rule 12b-1 fee may be paid and such purchases are potentially subject to a CDSC, as set forth below.
** Investment Professionals may receive payment on purchases of $1 million or more of Class A shares that are sold at NAV as follows: 0.75% of the current purchase amount if cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is less than $3 million; 0.50% of the current purchase amount if the cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is $3 million to $4,999,999; and 0.25% on of the current purchase amount if the cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is $5 million or more. In addition, in connection with such purchases, the Distributor or its affiliates may advance Rule 12b-1 fees of 0.25% of the purchase amount to Investment Professionals for providing services to shareholders.
Except as noted in this SAI, a CDSC of 0.75% may be imposed on any such shares redeemed within the first 18 months after purchase. CDSCs are based on the lower of the cost of the shares or NAV at the time of redemption. No CDSC is imposed on reinvested distributions.
The Distributor reserves the right to pay the entire commission to dealers. If that occurs, the dealer may be considered an “underwriter” under federal securities laws.
The following table shows the amount of the front-end sales load that is reallowed to dealers as a percentage of the offering price of Class A shares of the Fixed Income Funds and Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, excluding the Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund.
Amount of Purchase
Initial Sales Charge:
% of Offering Price
Concession to Dealers:
% of Offering Price
Up to $99,999
2.25%
2.00%
$100,000 to $249,999
1.75%
1.50%
Over $250,000*
0.00%
0.00%**
* There is no initial sales charge on purchases of $250,000 or more; however, a sales concession and/or advance of a Rule 12b-1 fee may be paid and such purchases are potentially subject to a CDSC, as set forth below.
8

** Investment Professionals may receive payment on purchases of $250,000 or more of Class A shares that are sold at NAV as follows: 0.75% of the current purchase amount if cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is less than $3 million; 0.50% of the current purchase amount if the cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is $3 million to $4,999,999; and 0.25% on of the current purchase amount if the cumulative prior purchases sold at NAV plus the current purchase is $5 million or more. In addition, in connection with such purchases, the Distributor or its affiliates may advance Rule 12b-1 fees of 0.25% of the purchase amount to Investment Professionals for providing services to shareholders.
Except as noted in this SAI, a CDSC of 0.75% may be imposed on any such shares redeemed within the first 18 months after purchase. CDSCs are based on the lower of the cost of the shares or NAV at the time of redemption. No CDSC is imposed on reinvested distributions.
The Distributor reserves the right to pay the entire commission to dealers. If that occurs, the dealer may be considered an “underwriter” under federal securities laws.
Sample Calculation of Maximum Offering Price
Class A shares of the Equity Funds are sold with a maximum initial sales charge of 5.75% and Class A shares of the Fixed Income Funds  and Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund are sold at a maximum initial sales charge of 2.25%. Set forth below is an example of the method of computing the offering price of the Class A shares of the Funds. The example assumes a purchase of Class A shares aggregating less than $50,000 subject to the schedule of sales charges set forth in the Prospectus at a price based upon the NAV of the Class A shares.
Equity Funds
 
NAV per share
$10.00
Per Share Sales Charge—5.75% of public offering price (6.10% of net asset value per share) for each Fund
$0.61
Per Share Offering Price to the Public
$10.61
Fixed Income Funds  and Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
NAV per share
$10.00
Per Share Sales Charge—2.25% of public offering price (2.30% of net asset value per share) for each Fund
$0.23
Per Share Offering Price to the Public
$10.23
Class C shares of each relevant Fund are sold at NAV without any initial sales charges and with a 1.00% CDSC on shares redeemed within 12 months of purchase. Fund Shares, Institutional Shares, and Class R6 shares of each relevant Fund are sold at NAV without any initial sales charges or CDSCs.
Reinstatement Privilege. Within 90 days of a redemption, a shareholder may reinvest all or part of the redemption proceeds of Class A or Class C shares in the same class of shares of a Fund or any of the other Funds into which shares of the Fund are exchangeable, as described above, at the NAV next computed after receipt by the transfer agent of the reinvestment order. No service charge is currently made for reinvestment in shares of the Funds. Class C share proceeds reinstated do not result in a refund of any CDSC paid by the shareholder, but the reinstated shares will be treated as CDSC exempt upon reinstatement. The shareholder must ask the Distributor for such privilege at the time of reinvestment. Any capital gain that was realized when the shares were redeemed is taxable, even if the proceeds are reinvested. Depending on the timing and amount of a potential reinvestment, some or all of a capital loss from redemption may not be deductible. If the redemption proceeds of Fund shares on which a sales charge was paid are reinvested in shares of the same Fund or another Fund offered by the Trust within 90 days of payment of the sales charge, the shareholder’s basis in the redeemed shares may not include the amount of the sales charge paid. Without the additional basis, the shareholder will have more gain or less loss upon redemption. The Funds may amend, suspend, or cease offering this reinvestment privilege at any time as to shares redeemed after the date of such amendment, suspension, or cessation. The reinstatement must be into an account bearing the same registration.
Redemptions in Kind. Subject to its election under Rule 18f-1 under the 1940 Act, each Fund reserves the right to honor requests for redemption or repurchase orders by making payment in whole or in part in readily marketable securities (“redemption in kind”) if the amount of such request is large enough to affect operations (for example, if the request is greater than $250,000 or 1% of the Fund’s assets). The securities will be chosen by the Fund and valued at the price used in calculating the Fund’s NAV on the day of redemption. A shareholder may incur transaction expenses in converting these securities to cash.
Investment Plans
Under certain circumstances, the Trust makes available the following investment plans to shareholders of the Funds. At the time you sign up for any of the following investment plans that use the electronic funds transfer service, you will choose the day of the month (the “Effective Date”) on which you would like to regularly purchase shares. When this day falls on a weekend or holiday, the electronic transfer will take place on the last business day prior to the Effective Date. You may terminate your participation in a plan at any time. Please call the Adviser for details and necessary forms or applications or sign up online at vcm.com.
9

Automatic Purchase of Shares
Automatic Investment Plan – The regular purchase of additional shares through electronic funds transfer from a checking or savings account. You may invest as little as $50 per transaction.
Automatic Transfer Plan – The periodic transfer of funds from a Victory money market fund to purchase shares in another non-money market Victory mutual fund. There is a minimum investment required for this program of $5,000 in the money market fund, with a monthly transaction minimum of $50.
Buy/Sell Service – The intermittent purchase or redemption of shares through electronic funds transfer to or from a checking or savings account. You may initiate a “buy” or “sell” whenever you choose.
Directed Dividends – If you own shares in more than one of the funds in the Victory Funds, you may direct that dividends and/or capital gain distributions received from one fund be used to purchase shares automatically in the same class of another of those funds.
Participation in these automatic purchase plans allows you to engage in dollar-cost averaging.
Systematic Withdrawal Plan
If you own shares in a single investment account (accounts in different Victory Funds cannot be aggregated for this purpose), you may request that enough shares to produce a fixed amount of money be liquidated from the account monthly, quarterly, or annually. The amount of each withdrawal must be at least $50. Using the electronic funds transfer service, you may choose to have withdrawals electronically deposited at your bank or other financial institution. You also may elect to have such withdrawals invested in another Victory Fund.
This plan may be initiated by completing a Systematic Withdrawal Plan application, which may be requested from the Adviser. You may terminate participation in the plan at any time. You are not charged for withdrawals under the Systematic Withdrawal Plan. The Trust will not bear any expenses in administering the plan beyond the regular Transfer Agent and custodian costs of issuing and redeeming shares. The Adviser will bear any additional expenses of administering the plan.
Withdrawals will be made by redeeming full and fractional shares on the date you select at the time the plan is established. Withdrawal payments made under this plan may exceed dividends and other distributions and, to that extent, would reduce the dollar value of your investment and could eventually exhaust the account. Reinvesting dividends and other distributions help replenish the account. Because share values and net investment income can fluctuate, you should not expect withdrawals to be offset by rising income or share value gains. Withdrawals that exceed the value in your account will be processed for the amount available, and the plan will be canceled.
Each redemption of shares of a Fund may result in realization of a gain or loss, which must be reported on your federal income tax return. Therefore, you should keep an accurate record of any gain or loss realized on each withdrawal.
Tax-Deferred Retirement Plans
Federal tax on distributions may be deferred if you hold shares of a Fund through certain types of retirement programs. For your convenience, the Adviser offers 403(b)(7) accounts and various forms of individual retirement accounts (“IRAs”). You may make investments in one or any combination of the Funds described in the prospectuses of the Trust (excluding any Fund that distributes tax-exempt-interest dividends).
Applications for the IRA and 403(b)(7) programs should be sent directly to Victory Capital Transfer Agency, Inc., P.O. Box 182593, Columbus, OH 43218-2593. Applications for these retirement accounts received by the Adviser will be forwarded to the Custodian for acceptance.
An administrative fee of $20 is deducted from the money sent to you after closing an account. Exceptions to the fee are: partial distributions and distributions due to disability or death. This charge is subject to change as provided in the various agreements. There may be additional charges, as mutually agreed upon between you and the Custodian, for further services requested of the Custodian.
You may obtain detailed information about the accounts from the Adviser. Each employer or individual establishing a tax-deferred retirement account also is advised to consult with a tax adviser before establishing the account.
10

Investment Objectives, Practices, Policies, and Risks
Investment Objective(s)
The section captioned Additional Fund Information in each Fund's prospectus describes the investment objective(s) and the investment policies applicable to each Fund. There can, of course, be no assurance that each Fund will achieve its investment objective(s). Each Fund’s objective(s) are not a fundamental policy and may be changed upon written notice to, but without the approval of, each Fund's shareholders. If there is a change in the investment objective(s) of a Fund, the Fund’s shareholders should consider whether the Fund remains an appropriate investment in light of then-current needs.
Investment Practices, Policies, and Risks
The following provides additional information about the investment policies, practices, types of instruments, and certain risks that the Funds may be subject to. Unless described as a principal investment policy in a Fund’s prospectus, these represent the non-principal investment policies of the Funds.
Adjustable-Rate Securities
Each Fund may invest in adjustable-rate securities. The interest rate on an adjustable-rate security fluctuates periodically. Generally, the security’s yield is based on a U.S. dollar-based interest-rate benchmark such as the Federal Funds Rate, the 90-day Treasury bill rate, or the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”). The yields on these securities are reset on a periodic basis (for example, daily, weekly, or quarterly) or upon a change in the benchmark interest rate. The yields are closely correlated to changes in money market interest rates.
Asset-Backed Securities
Each Fund may invest in asset-backed securities (“ABS”). ABS represent a participation in, or are secured by and payable from, a stream of payments generated by particular assets, such as credit card, motor vehicle, or trade receivables. They may be pass-through certificates, which have characteristics very similar to mortgage-backed securities, discussed below. With respect to the Victory Income Fund, Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund, and Victory High Income Fund, such pass-through certificates may include equipment trust certificates (“ETC”) secured by specific equipment, such as airplanes and railroad cars. ETC securities also may be enhanced by letters of credit. An ABS also may be in the form of asset-backed commercial paper, which is issued by a special purpose entity, organized solely to issue the commercial paper and to purchase interests in the assets.
The credit quality of ABS depends primarily on the quality of the underlying assets, the rights of recourse available against the underlying assets and/or the issuer, the level of credit enhancement, if any, provided for the securities, and the credit quality of the credit-support provider, if any. To lessen the effect of failures by obligors on underlying assets to make payments, the securities may contain elements of credit support which fall into two categories: (i) liquidity protection and (ii) protection against losses resulting from ultimate default by an obligor on the underlying assets. Liquidity protection refers to the provision of advances, generally by the entity administering the pool of assets, to ensure that the receipt of payments on the underlying pool occurs in a timely fashion. Protection against losses resulting from ultimate default is ensured by payment through insurance policies or letters of credit obtained by the issuer or sponsor from third parties. A Fund will not pay any additional or separate fees for credit support. The degree of credit support provided for each issue is generally based on historical information respecting the level of credit risk associated with the underlying assets. Delinquency or loss in excess of that anticipated or failure of the credit support could adversely affect the return on an investment in such a security. In addition, the risk of default by borrowers is greater during times of rising interest rates and/or unemployment rates and generally is higher in the case of asset pools that include subprime assets.
On occasion, the pool of assets also may include a swap obligation, which is used to change the cash flows on the underlying assets. As an example, a swap may be used to allow floating-rate assets to back a fixed-rate obligation. Credit quality depends primarily on the quality of the underlying assets, the level of credit support, if any, provided by the structure or by a third-party insurance wrap, and the credit quality of the swap counterparty, if any.
ABS may be subject to interest rate risk and prepayment risk. In a period of declining interest rates, borrowers may prepay the underlying assets more quickly than anticipated, thereby reducing the yield to maturity and the average life of the ABS. Moreover, when a Fund reinvests the proceeds of a prepayment in these circumstances, it will likely receive a rate of interest that is lower than the rate on the security that was prepaid. In a period of rising interest rates, prepayments of the underlying assets may occur at a slower than expected rate, creating maturity extension risk. This particular risk may effectively change a security that was considered short or intermediate term at the time of purchase into a longer-term security. Since the value of longer-term securities generally fluctuates more widely in response to changes in interest rates than does the value of shorter-term securities, maturity extension risk could increase the volatility of a Fund. The weighted average life of such securities is likely to be substantially shorter than their stated final maturity as a result of scheduled principal payments and unscheduled principal prepayments.
11

Bonds
Each Fund may invest in bonds, which are fixed or variable-rate debt obligations, including bills, notes, debentures, money market instruments and similar instruments and securities. Mortgage-backed securities and ABS are types of bonds, and certain types of income-producing, non-convertible preferred stocks may be treated as bonds for investment purposes. Bonds generally are used by corporations, governments, and other issuers to borrow money from investors. The issuer pays the investor a fixed or variable rate of interest and normally must repay the amount borrowed on or before maturity. Many preferred stocks and some bonds are “perpetual” in that they have no maturity date. Bonds are subject to interest rate risk and credit risk. Interest rate risk generally is the risk that interest rates will rise and that, as a result, bond prices will fall, lowering the value of a Fund’s investments in bonds. In general, bonds having longer durations are more sensitive to interest rate changes than are bonds with shorter durations. Credit risk generally is the risk that an issuer may be unable or unwilling to pay interest and/or principal on the bond. Credit risk can be affected by many factors, including adverse changes in the issuer’s own financial condition or in economic conditions.
Borrowing Money and Issuing Senior Securities
Pursuant to the investment restrictions that have been adopted by the Trust for each Fund, each Fund may not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act. “Senior securities” are defined as any bond, debenture, note, or similar obligation or instrument constituting a security and evidencing indebtedness, and any Fund obligations that have a priority over the Fund’s shares with respect to the payment of dividends or the distribution of Fund assets. The 1940 Act prohibits a Fund from issuing senior securities except that the Fund may borrow money in amounts of up to one-third (33 1/3%) of the Fund’s total assets (including the amount borrowed) less liabilities (other than borrowings) from banks. Any borrowings that exceed this amount will be reduced within three days (excluding Sundays and holidays) to the extent necessary to comply with the 33 1/3% limitation even if it is not advantageous to sell securities at that time. Borrowings may be used for a variety of purposes, including (i) for temporary or emergency purposes, (ii) in anticipation of or in response to adverse market conditions, (iii) for cash management purposes, and (iv) for investment purposes. Borrowed money will cost a Fund interest expense and/or other fees. The costs of borrowing may reduce a Fund’s return. To the extent that a Fund has outstanding borrowings, it will be leveraged. Leveraging generally exaggerates the effect on NAV of any increase or decrease in the market value of a Fund’s securities.
Each Fund together with other funds of the Trust and Victory Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable Insurance Funds, participates in a 364-day committed credit facility and a 364-day uncommitted, demand credit facility with Citibank, N.A. (Citibank). Each such credit facility may be renewed if so agreed by the parties. Under the agreement with Citibank, the Funds may borrow up to $600 million, of which $300 million is committed and $300 million is uncommitted. Of this amount, $40 million committed of the line of credit and $60 million of the uncommitted line of credit are reserved for use by the Victory Floating Rate Fund (a series of Victory Portfolios), with that Fund paying the related commitment fees for that amount. The purpose of each agreement is to meet temporary or emergency cash needs. For the committed credit facility, Citibank receives an annual commitment fee of 0.15%. Each Fund pays a pro-rata portion (adjusted for the amount of credit reserved for the Victory Floating Rate Fund) of these fees and pays the interest on any amount that it borrows.
Calculations of Dollar-Weighted Average Portfolio Maturity
Dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity is derived by multiplying the value of each debt instrument by the number of days remaining to its maturity, adding these calculations, and then dividing the total by the value of a Fund’s debt instruments. An obligation’s maturity typically is determined on a stated final maturity basis, although there are some exceptions to this rule.
With respect to obligations held by a Fund, if it is probable that the issuer of an instrument will take advantage of a maturity-shortening device, such as a call, refunding, or redemption provision, the date on which the instrument will probably be called, refunded, or redeemed may be considered to be its maturity date. Also, the maturities of mortgage-backed securities, some asset-backed securities (“ABS”) and securities subject to sinking fund arrangements are determined on a weighted average life basis, which is the average time for principal to be repaid. For mortgage-backed securities and some ABS, this average time is calculated by assuming prepayment rates of the underlying loans. These prepayment rates can vary depending upon the level and volatility of interest rates. This, in turn, can affect the weighted average life of the security. The weighted average lives of these securities will be shorter than their stated final maturities. In addition, for purposes of a Fund’s investment policies, an instrument will be treated as having a maturity earlier than its stated maturity date if the instrument has technical features such as puts or demand features that, in the judgment of the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser, will result in the instrument being valued in the market as though it has the earlier maturity.
Finally, for purposes of calculating the dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity of a Fund, the maturity of a debt instrument with a periodic interest reset date will be deemed to be the next reset date, rather than the remaining stated maturity of the instrument if, in the judgment of the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser, the periodic interest reset features will result in the instrument being valued in the market as though it has the earlier maturity.
12

The Victory Money Market Fund will determine the maturity of an obligation in its portfolio in accordance with Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act.
Certificates of Deposit and Bankers’ Acceptances
Each Fund may invest in certificates of deposit, which are receipts issued by a depository institution in exchange for the deposit of funds. The issuer agrees to pay the amount deposited plus interest to the bearer of the receipt on the date specified on the certificate. The certificate usually can be traded in the secondary market prior to maturity. Each Fund may invest in bankers’ acceptances, which typically arise from short-term credit arrangements designed to enable businesses to obtain funds to finance commercial transactions. Generally, an acceptance is a time draft drawn on a bank by an exporter or an importer to obtain a stated amount of funds to pay for specific merchandise. The draft is then “accepted” by a bank that, in effect, unconditionally guarantees to pay the face value of the instrument on its maturity date. The acceptance may then be held by the accepting bank as an earning asset or it may be sold in the secondary market at the going rate of discount for a specific maturity. Although maturities for acceptances can be as long as 270 days, most acceptances have maturities of six months or less.
To the extent a Fund holds instruments of foreign banks or financial institutions, it may be subject to additional investment risks that are different in some respects from those incurred if the Fund invests only in debt obligations of U.S. domestic issuers. Such risks include future political and economic developments, the possible imposition of withholding taxes by the particular country in which the issuer is located, the possible confiscation or nationalization of foreign deposits, the possible establishment of exchange controls, or the adoption of other foreign governmental restrictions which may adversely affect the payment of principal and interest on these securities.
Domestic banks and foreign banks are subject to different governmental regulations with respect to the amount and types of loans that may be made and interest rates that may be charged. In addition, the profitability of the banking industry depends largely upon the availability and cost of funds and the interest income generated from lending operations. General economic conditions and the quality of loan portfolios affect the banking industry. Unexpected changes with respect to these factors may adversely affect the issuance of and the secondary market for these securities.
Commercial Paper
Each Fund may invest in commercial paper, which consists of short-term (usually from 1 to 270 days) unsecured promissory notes issued by corporations in order to finance their current operations. A variable amount master demand note (which is a type of commercial paper) represents a direct borrowing arrangement involving periodically fluctuating rates of interest under a letter agreement between a commercial paper issuer and an institutional lender pursuant to which the lender may determine to invest varying amounts.
Investments in commercial paper are subject to the risk the issuer cannot issue enough new commercial paper to satisfy its outstanding commercial paper, also known as rollover risk. Commercial paper may become illiquid or may suffer from reduced liquidity in certain circumstances. Like all fixed-income securities, commercial paper prices are susceptible to fluctuations in interest rates. If interest rates rise, commercial paper prices will decline. The short-term nature of a commercial paper investment makes it less susceptible to interest rate risk than many other fixed-income securities because interest rate risk typically increases as maturity lengths increase. Commercial paper tends to yield smaller returns than longer-term corporate debt because securities with shorter maturities typically have lower effective yields than those with longer maturities. As with all fixed-income securities, there is a chance that the issuer will default on its commercial paper obligation.
Commodity-Linked Notes
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in commodity-linked notes, which are a type of structured note. Commodity-linked notes are privately negotiated structured debt securities indexed to the return of an index such as the Dow Jones-UBS Commodity Index Total Return, which is representative of the commodities market. They are available from a limited number of approved counterparties, and all invested amounts are exposed to the dealer’s credit risk. Commodity-linked notes may be leveraged. For example, if a Fund invests $100 in a three-times leveraged commodity-linked note, it will exchange $100 principal with the dealer to obtain $300 exposure to the commodities market because the value of the note will change by a magnitude of three for every percentage point change (positive or negative) in the value of the underlying index. This means a $100 note would be worth $70 if the commodity index decreased by 10 percent. Structured notes also are subject to counterparty risk.
Investments linked to the prices of commodities, including commodity-linked notes, are considered speculative. The values of commodity-linked notes are affected by events that might have less impact on the values of stocks and bonds. Prices of commodities and related contracts may fluctuate significantly over short periods due to a variety of factors, including changes in supply and demand relationships, weather, agriculture, fiscal, and exchange control programs, disease, pestilence, and international economic, political, military, and regulatory developments. In addition, the commodity markets may be subject to temporary distortions and other
13

disruptions due to, among other factors, lack of liquidity, the participation of speculators, and government regulation and other actions. These circumstances could adversely affect the value of the commodity-linked notes and make commodity-linked notes more volatile than other types of investments. Investments in commodity-linked notes may have substantial risks, including risk of loss of a significant portion of their principal value. They also can generate tax risks.
Convertible Securities
Each Fund may invest in convertible securities, which are bonds, preferred stocks, and other securities that pay interest or dividends and offer the buyer the ability to convert the security into common stock. The value of convertible securities depends partially on interest rate changes and the credit quality of the issuer. Because a convertible security affords an investor the opportunity, through its conversion feature, to participate in the capital appreciation of the underlying common stock, the value of convertible securities also depends on the price of the underlying common stock.
A convertible security entitles the holder to receive interest paid or accrued on debt or the dividend paid on preferred stock until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted, or exchanged. Before conversion, convertible securities have characteristics similar to nonconvertible income securities in that they ordinarily provide a stable stream of income with generally higher yields than those of common stocks of the same or similar issuers, but lower yields than comparable nonconvertible securities. The value of a convertible security is influenced by changes in interest rates, with investment value declining as interest rates increase and increasing as interest rates decline. The credit standing of the issuer and other factors also may have an effect on the convertible security’s investment value. Convertible securities are subordinate in rank to any senior debt obligations of the same issuer and, therefore, an issuer’s convertible securities entail more risk than its debt obligations.
The convertible securities in which the Funds invest may be rated below investment grade as determined by Moody’s Investors Service Inc. or S&P Global Ratings (“S&P”), or unrated but judged by the Adviser  or the applicable Subadviser to be of comparable quality (commonly called “junk” bonds). For a more complete description of debt ratings, see Appendix A. Such securities are deemed to be speculative and involve greater risk of default due to changes in interest rates, economic conditions, and the issuer’s creditworthiness. As a result, their market prices tend to fluctuate more than those of higher-quality securities. During periods of general economic downturns or rising interest rates, issuers of such securities may experience financial difficulties, which could affect their ability to make timely interest and principal payments. A Fund’s ability to timely and accurately value and dispose of lower-quality securities also may be affected by the absence or periodic discontinuance of liquid trading markets.
Cover
Transactions using certain derivative instruments, other than purchased options, expose a Fund to an obligation to another party. A Fund will not enter into any such transactions unless there appears to be a liquid secondary market for such investments; or unless it owns either (1) an offsetting (covered) position in securities, currencies or other options, futures contracts or forward contracts, or (2) cash or liquid assets with a value, marked-to-market daily, sufficient to cover its potential obligations to the extent not covered as provided in (1) above.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Cybersecurity Risk
Technology, such as the internet, has become more prevalent in the course of business; and as such, each Fund and its service providers are susceptible to operational and information security risk resulting from cyber incidents. Cyber incidents refer to both intentional attacks and unintentional events including: processing errors, human errors, technical errors including computer glitches and system malfunctions, inadequate or failed internal or external processes, market-wide technical-related disruptions, unauthorized access to digital systems (through “hacking” or malicious software coding), computer viruses, and cyber-attacks that shut down, disable, slow or otherwise disrupt operations, business processes, or website access or functionality (including denial of service attacks). Cyber incidents could adversely impact a Fund and its shareholders and cause the Fund to incur financial loss and expense, as well as face exposure to regulatory penalties, reputational damage, and additional compliance costs associated with corrective measures. Cyber incidents may cause a Fund or its service providers to lose proprietary information, suffer data corruption, lose operational capacity (e.g., the loss of the ability to process transactions, calculate a Fund’s NAV, or allow shareholders to transact business), and/or fail to comply with applicable privacy and other laws. Among other potentially harmful effects, cyber incidents also may result in theft, unauthorized monitoring and failures in the physical infrastructure or operating systems that support the Fund and its service providers. In addition, substantial costs may be incurred in order to prevent any cyber incidents in the future. While the Funds' service providers have established business continuity plans in the event of, and risk management systems to prevent, such cyber incidents, there are inherent limitations in such plans and systems including the possibility that certain risks have not been identified. Furthermore, each Fund cannot control the cybersecurity plans and systems put in place by its service providers or any other third parties whose operations may affect each Fund or its shareholders. In certain situations, the Funds, the Adviser, a Subadviser, or a service provider may be required to comply with law enforcement in responding to a cybersecurity incident, which may prevent each Funds from fully
14

implementing their cybersecurity plans and systems, and (in certain situations) may result in additional information loss or damage. Each Fund and its shareholders could be negatively impacted as a result.
Derivatives
Under circumstances in which such instruments are expected by the Manager or the applicable Subadviser to aid in achieving each Fund’s investment objective, each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may buy and sell certain types of derivatives. Derivatives are instruments that derive their value from the value of one or more underlying assets, reference rates or indices, and may include futures contracts, options on futures contracts, swaps, options on currencies, securities, and securities indexes. Derivatives also may possess the characteristics of both futures and securities (e.g., debt instruments with interest and principal payments determined by reference to the value of a commodity or a currency at a future time) and, therefore, possess the risks of both futures and securities investments.
Permissible derivative instruments include “market access products,” which offer synthetic exposure to an underlying local foreign stock. They include, for example, equity-linked notes, warrants, zero strike options, and total return swaps. Market access products are subject to the same risks as direct investments in securities of foreign issuers. If the underlying stock decreases in value, the market access product will decrease commensurately. In addition, market access products are subject to counterparty risk due to the fact that the security is issued by a broker. If the broker suffers a significant credit event and cannot perform under the terms of an agreement, an access product may lose value regardless of the strength of the underlying stock. The Victory Science & Technology Fund may invest in market access products.
Derivatives, such as futures contracts; options on currencies, securities, and securities indexes; options on futures contracts; and swaps enable a Fund to take both “short” positions (positions that anticipate a decline in the market value of a particular asset or index) and “long” positions (positions that anticipate an increase in the market value of a particular asset or index). Each Fund also may use strategies that involve simultaneous short and long positions in response to specific market conditions, such as where the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser anticipates unusually high or low market volatility.
The Adviser or the applicable Subadviser may enter into derivative positions for a Fund for either hedging or non-hedging purposes. The term hedging is applied to defensive strategies designed to protect a Fund from an expected decline in the market value of an asset or group of assets that a Fund owns (in the case of a short hedge) or to protect a Fund from an expected rise in the market value of an asset or group of assets which it intends to acquire in the future (in the case of a long or “anticipatory” hedge). Non-hedging strategies include strategies designed to produce incremental income (such as the option writing strategy) or “speculative” strategies, which are undertaken to equitize the cash or cash equivalent portion of a Fund’s portfolio or to profit from (i) an expected decline in the market value of an asset or group of assets which a Fund does not own or (ii) expected increases in the market value of an asset which it does not plan to acquire.
Generally, the Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory Extended Market Index Fund, and Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund will employ futures and options on futures to provide liquidity necessary to meet anticipated redemptions or for day-to-day operating purposes.
Rule 18f-4 regulates the use of derivatives for certain funds registered under the Investment Company Act (“Rule 18f-4”). With respect to Funds that qualify as a “Full Compliance Derivatives User” and in compliance with Rule 18f-4, those Funds have adopted and implemented policies and procedures to manage the Funds’ aggregate derivatives risk. In addition, those Funds may trade derivatives and certain other instruments that create future payment or delivery obligations subject to a value-at-risk (“VaR”) based leverage limit, have established and implemented a comprehensive derivatives risk management program and testing requirements, appointed a derivatives risk manager, and has complied with all reporting requirements relating to board and SEC reporting, which include providing additional disclosure both publicly and to the SEC regarding its derivatives positions. For Funds that qualify as limited derivatives users, Rule 18f-4 requires those Funds to have policies and procedures to manage their aggregate derivatives risk. These requirements have an impact on the Funds, including a potential increase in cost to enter into derivatives transactions.
Discretionary Liquidity Fee Risk
The Victory Money Market Fund may impose liquidity fees on redemptions subject to the determination by the Fund’s Board that such liquidity fees are in the best interests of the Fund. Upon such a determination, the Fund may impose a liquidity fee of up to 2% of the value of the shares redeemed. The imposition of a liquidity fee would reduce the amount you would receive upon redemption of your shares of the Fund.
15

Equity Securities
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory  Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund) may invest in equity securities listed on any domestic or foreign securities exchange or traded in the over-the-counter market as well as certain restricted or unlisted securities (although the Victory Short-Term Bond Fund's, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund's, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund's investments in equity securities are limited to preferred securities). As used herein, “equity securities” are defined as common stock, preferred stock, trust or limited partnership interests, rights and warrants to subscribe to or purchase such securities, sponsored or unsponsored depositary receipts such as American depositary receipts (“ADRs”), European depositary receipts (“EDRs”), global depositary receipts (“GDRs”), and convertible securities, consisting of debt securities or preferred stock that may be converted into common stock or that carry the right to purchase common stock. Common stocks, the most familiar type, represent an equity (ownership) interest in a corporation. They may or may not pay dividends or carry voting rights. Common stock occupies the most junior position in a company’s capital structure. Although equity securities have a history of long-term growth in value, their prices fluctuate based on changes in a company’s financial condition and on overall market and economic conditions. Smaller companies are especially sensitive to these factors.
Equity-Linked Structured Notes
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in equity-linked structured notes, which are derivative securities specifically designed to combine the characteristics of one or more underlying securities and their equity derivatives in a single note form. The return and/or yield or income component may be based on the performance of the underlying equity securities, an equity index, and/or option positions. Equity-linked structured notes typically are offered in limited transactions by financial institutions in either registered or non-registered form. An investment in equity-linked notes creates exposure to the credit risk of the issuing financial institution, as well as to the market risk of the underlying securities. There is no guaranteed return of principal with these securities and the appreciation potential of these securities may be limited by a maximum payment or call right. In certain cases, equity-linked notes may be more volatile and less liquid than less complex securities or other types of fixed-income securities. Such securities may exhibit price behavior that does not correlate with other fixed-income securities.
Eurodollar and Yankee Obligations
Each Fund may invest in Eurodollar obligations or Yankee obligations. Eurodollar obligations are dollar-denominated instruments that have been issued outside the U.S. capital markets by foreign corporations and financial institutions and by foreign branches of U.S. corporations and financial institutions. Yankee obligations are dollar-denominated instruments that have been issued by foreign issuers in the U.S. capital markets.
Eurodollar and Yankee obligations are subject to the same risks that pertain to domestic issues, notably credit risk, market risk, and liquidity risk. Additionally, Eurodollar (and to a limited extent, Yankee) obligations are subject to certain sovereign risks. One such risk is the possibility that a sovereign country might prevent capital, in the form of dollars, from leaving the country. Other risks include: adverse political and economic developments; the extent and quality of government regulation of financial markets and institutions; the imposition of foreign withholding taxes; and expropriation or nationalization of foreign issuers. However, Eurodollar and Yankee obligations will undergo the same type of credit analysis as domestic issues in which a Fund invests, and will have at least the same financial strength as the domestic issuers approved for a Fund.
European Securities
The European Union’s (the “EU”) Economic and Monetary Union (the “EMU”) requires member countries to comply with restrictions on interest rates, deficits, debt levels, and inflation rates, and other factors, each of which may significantly impact every European country and their economic partners. The economies of EU member countries and their trading partners may be adversely affected by changes in the exchange rate of the euro (the common currency of the EU), changes in EU or governmental regulations on trade and other areas, and the threat of default or an actual default by an EU member country on its sovereign debt, which could negatively impact a Fund’s investments and cause it to lose money. In recent years, the European financial markets have been negatively impacted by concerns relating to rising government debt levels and national unemployment; possible default on or restructuring of sovereign debt in several European countries; and economic downturns. Responses to financial problems by European governments, central banks and others, including austerity measures and reforms, may not produce the desired results, may result in social unrest and may limit future growth and economic recovery or have other unintended consequences. A European country’s default or debt restructuring would adversely affect the holders of the country’s debt and sellers of credit default swaps linked to the country’s creditworthiness and could negatively impact global markets more generally.
Uncertainties regarding the viability of the EU have impacted and may continue to impact markets in the United States and around the world. If one or more countries leave the EU or the EU dissolves, securities markets would likely be significantly disrupted. On January 31, 2020, the UK left the EU, commonly referred to as “Brexit,” and the UK ceased to be a member of the EU. Following a transition period during which the EU and UK government engaged in a series of negotiations regarding the terms of the UK’s future
16

relationship with the EU. The UK and the EU reached a trade agreement on December 31, 2020, which became effective May 1, 2021, after being approved by all applicable UK and EU governmental bodies in early 2021. There is significant market uncertainty regarding Brexit’s ramifications, and the range and potential implications of possible political, regulatory, economic, and market outcomes are difficult to predict. This uncertainty may affect other countries in the EU and elsewhere, and may cause volatility within the EU, triggering prolonged economic downturns in certain countries within the EU. It is also possible that various countries within the UK, such as Scotland or Northern Ireland, could seek to separate and remain a part of the EU.
The UK has one of the largest economies in Europe and is a major trading partner with the other EU countries and the United States. Brexit might negatively affect The City of London’s economy, which is heavily dominated by financial services, as banks might be forced to move staff and comply with two separate sets of rules or lose business to banks in Continental Europe. In addition, Brexit may create additional and substantial economic stresses for the UK, including a contraction of the UK economy and price volatility in UK stocks, decreased trade, capital outflows, devaluation of the British pound, wider corporate bond spreads due to uncertainty and declines in business and consumer spending as well as foreign direct investment. Further, the United Kingdom’s departure from the EU would potentially cause volatility within the EU, which could trigger prolonged economic downturns in certain European countries or spark additional member states to contemplate departing the EU (thereby exacerbating political instability in the region). Brexit may also adversely affect UK-based financial firms that have counterparties in the EU or participate in market infrastructure (trading venues, clearing houses, settlement facilities) based in the EU. These events and the resulting market volatility may have an adverse effect on the performance of a Fund.
Investing in the securities of Eastern European issuers is highly speculative and involves risks not usually associated with investing in the more developed markets of Western Europe. Securities markets of Eastern European countries typically are less efficient and have lower trading volume, lower liquidity, and higher volatility than more developed markets. Eastern European economies also may be particularly susceptible to disruption in the international credit market due to their reliance on bank-related inflows of capital. To the extent that a fund invests in European securities, it may be exposed to these risks through its direct investments in such securities, including sovereign debt, or indirectly through investments in money market funds and financial institutions with significant investments in such securities.
Exchange-Traded Funds (“ETFs”)
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in ETFs, which are, with a few exceptions, open-end investment companies that trade throughout the day. ETFs trade on stock exchanges and typically track a market index or specific sectors of the stock or bond markets. Because they trade like a stock, they offer trading flexibility desired by both individuals and institutions. The value of the underlying securities held by an ETF is a major factor in determining an ETF’s price. However, ETFs do not necessarily trade at their NAV. The price of an ETF also is determined by supply and demand and, as a result, the share price of an ETF may trade at a premium or discount to its NAV.
To the extent a Fund invests in ETFs, it will be exposed to the same risks of the ETFs’ holdings as the ETFs themselves in direct proportion to the allocation of the Fund’s assets among those ETFs. You also will indirectly bear fees and expenses charged by the ETFs in which the Fund invests in addition to the Fund’s direct fees and expenses. In addition, an ETF may be a “passive investor” and, therefore, invests in the securities and sectors contained in the index it seeks to track without regard for, or analysis of, the prospects of such securities or sectors. An ETF may invest in all of the securities in such index or in a representative sample of such securities. ETFs generally do not attempt to take defensive positions in volatile or declining markets or under other conditions. Furthermore, ETFs usually are not able to duplicate exactly the performance of the underlying indexes they track. The difference in performance between an ETF and the index it seeks to track can be due to, among other factors, the expenses that the ETF pays, regulatory constraints, investment strategies or techniques undertaken by the ETF, and changes to an underlying index. There also may be a lack of correlation between the securities in an index and those actually held by an ETF. The performance of a Fund that invests in such an ETF could be adversely impacted. In addition, although the ETFs generally are listed on securities exchanges, there can be no assurances that an active trading market for such ETFs will be maintained. Secondary market trading in the ETFs also may be halted by a national securities exchange because of market conditions or for other reasons. There can be no assurances that the requirements necessary to maintain the listing of the ETFs will continue to be met or will remain unchanged.
Exchange-Traded Notes (“ETNs”)
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in ETNs. ETNs are a type of unsecured, unsubordinated debt security, usually issued by large financial institutions. This type of debt security differs from other types of bonds and notes because ETN returns are based upon the performance of a market index minus applicable fees, no period coupon payments are distributed, and no principal protections exist. The purpose of ETNs is to create a type of security that combines the aspects of both bonds and ETFs. Similar to ETFs, ETNs are traded on a major exchange (i.e., NYSE) during normal trading hours. However, investors also can hold the debt security until maturity. At that time, the issuer will give the investor a cash amount that would be equal to the principal amount (subject to the day’s index factor).
17

One factor that affects the ETN’s value is the credit rating of the issuer. The value of an ETN also may be influenced by time to maturity, level of supply and demand for the ETN, volatility and lack of liquidity in underlying commodities or securities markets, changes in the applicable interest rates, changes in the issuer’s credit rating, and economic, legal, political, or geographic events that affect the referenced commodity or security. A Fund’s decision to sell its ETN holdings may be limited by the availability of a secondary market. If a Fund must sell some or all of its ETN holdings and the secondary market is weak, it may have to sell such holdings at a discount. There may be restrictions on a Fund’s right to redeem its investment in an ETN, which is generally meant to be held until maturity. ETNs are subject to counterparty credit risk and fixed-income risk. ETNs also are subject to tax risk. No assurance can be given that the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) will accept, or a court will uphold, how a Fund characterizes and treats ETNs for federal income tax purposes. Further, Congress and the IRS frequently consider proposals that would change the timing of recognition and tax character of income and gains from ETNs.
Foreign Securities
The Victory Aggressive Growth Fund, Victory Growth Fund, Victory Growth & Income Fund, Victory Income Stock Fund, Victory Small Cap Stock Fund, and Victory Value Fund may invest up to 20% of their assets, the Victory Science & Technology Fund may invest up to 50% of its assets, and the Victory Capital Growth Fund may invest up to 100% of its assets in foreign securities purchased in either foreign or U.S. markets, including ADRs and GDRs. The Victory High Income Fund, Victory Income Fund, Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, and Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund may invest up to 20% of their assets in non-dollar-denominated securities. Investing in foreign securities poses unique risks: currency exchange rate fluctuations; foreign market illiquidity; emerging markets risk; increased price volatility; exchange control regulations; foreign ownership limits; different accounting, reporting, and disclosure requirements; political or social instability, including policies of foreign governments which may affect their respective equity markets; foreign taxation requirements including withholding taxes; prohibitions or restrictions by certain foreign governments on foreign investing in their capital markets or in certain industries, or limitations on the removal of funds or assets; and difficulties in obtaining legal judgments. In the past, equity and debt instruments of foreign markets have been more volatile than equity and debt instruments of U.S. securities markets.
Investing in the securities of companies located in emerging market countries generally involves greater risk than investing in the securities of companies located in countries with developed markets. The Adviser  or the applicable Subadviser considers all countries of the world to be emerging market countries, except Austria, Australia, Belgium, Canada, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region (“Hong Kong”), Ireland, Israel, Italy, Japan, Luxembourg, the Netherlands, New Zealand, Norway, Portugal, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, the UK, and the United States. The People’s Republic of China (“PRC”) currently exercises sovereignty over Hong Kong; however, Hong Kong retains economic and political autonomy under the Basic Law, a “quasi-constitution” that has been in place since Hong Kong reverted to PRC sovereignty in 1997. The Basic Law is anticipated to remain in place until 2047; however, recent tensions between the Chinese government and many people in Hong Kong who perceive China as tightening control over Hong Kong's semi-autonomous liberal political, economic, legal and social framework may cause uncertainty in the Hong Kong and Chinese markets. Investments in emerging market countries may present market, credit, currency, liquidity, legal, political, technical and other risks different from, or greater than, the risks of investing in developed countries. For instance, these countries may be more likely than developed countries to experience rapid and significant developments in their political or economic structures. Some emerging market countries restrict foreign investments, impose withholding or other taxes on foreign investments, and/or may nationalize or expropriate the assets of private companies. Therefore, a Fund may be limited in its ability to make direct or additional investments in an emerging markets country. Such restrictions also may have negative impacts on transaction costs, market price, investment returns and the legal rights and remedies of a Fund. In addition, the securities markets of emerging markets countries generally are smaller, less liquid and more volatile than those of developed countries. Emerging market countries often have less uniformity in accounting and reporting requirements and less reliable settlement, registration and custodial procedures. Emerging market countries also may be subject to high inflation and rapid currency devaluations and may be heavily dependent on international trade, which can materially affect their securities markets. The risks associated with investing in a narrowly defined geographic area also generally are more pronounced with respect to investments in emerging market countries.
Any investments in foreign securities will be made in compliance with U.S. and foreign currency restrictions, tax laws, and laws limiting the amount and types of foreign investments. Pursuit of the Funds’ investment objectives will involve currencies of the United States and of foreign countries. Consequently, changes in exchange rates, currency convertibility, and repatriation requirements may favorably or adversely affect the Funds.
18

Forward Currency Contracts
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory  Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund) may enter into forward currency contracts. A forward contract involves an agreement to purchase or sell a specific currency at a specified future date or over a specified time period at a price set at the time of the contract. Forward currency contracts seek to protect against uncertainty in the level of future foreign exchange rates. These contracts are usually traded directly between currency traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. A forward contract generally has no deposit requirements, and no commissions are charged.
A Fund may enter into forward currency contracts under two circumstances. First, when a Fund enters into a contract for the purchase or sale of a security denominated in a foreign currency, it may desire to “lock in” the U.S. dollar price of the security until settlement. By entering into such a contract, a Fund will be able to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the foreign currency from the date the security is purchased or sold to the date on which payment is made or received. Second, when management of a Fund believes that the currency of a specific country may deteriorate relative to the U.S. dollar, it may enter into a forward contract to sell that currency. A Fund may not hedge with respect to a particular currency for an amount greater than the aggregate market value (determined at the time of making any sale of forward currency) of the securities held in its portfolio denominated or quoted in, or bearing a substantial correlation to, such currency.
The use of forward contracts involves certain risks. The precise matching of contract amounts and the value of securities involved generally will not be possible since the future value of such securities in currencies more than likely will change between the date the contract is entered into and the date it matures. The projection of short-term currency market movements is extremely difficult, and successful execution of a short-term hedging strategy is uncertain. Under normal circumstances, consideration of the prospect for currency parities will be incorporated into the longer-term investment strategies. The Adviser or the applicable Subadviser believes it is important, however, to have the flexibility to enter into such contracts when it determines it is in the best interest of a Fund to do so. It is impossible to forecast what the market value of portfolio securities will be at the expiration of a contract. Accordingly, it may be necessary for a Fund to purchase additional currency (and bear the expense of such purchase) if the market value of the security is less than the amount of currency a Fund is obligated to deliver, and if a decision is made to sell the security and make delivery of the currency. Conversely, it may be necessary to sell some of the foreign currency received on the sale of the portfolio security if its market value exceeds the amount of currency a Fund is obligated to deliver. A Fund is not required to enter into such transactions and will not do so unless deemed appropriate by the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser.
Although the Funds value their assets each business day in terms of U.S. dollars, they do not intend to convert their foreign currencies into U.S. dollars on a daily basis. They will do so from time to time, and shareholders should be aware of currency conversion costs. Although foreign exchange dealers do not charge a fee for conversion, they do realize a profit based on the difference (spread) between the prices at which they are buying and selling various currencies. Thus, a dealer may offer to sell a foreign currency to a Fund at one rate, while offering a lesser rate of exchange should a Fund desire to resell that currency to the dealer.
Forward contracts in which a Fund may engage include foreign exchange forwards. The consummation of a foreign exchange forward requires the actual exchange of the principal amounts of the two currencies in the contract (i.e., settlement on a physical basis). Because foreign exchange forwards are physically settled through an exchange of currencies, they are traded in the interbank market directly between currency traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. A foreign exchange forward generally has no deposit requirement, and no commissions are charged at any stage for trades; foreign exchange dealers realize a profit based on the difference (the spread) between the prices at which they are buying and the prices at which they are selling various currencies. When a Fund enters into a foreign exchange forward, it relies on the counterparty to make or take delivery of the underlying currency at the maturity of the contract. Failure by the counterparty to do so would result in the loss of any expected benefit of the transaction. A Fund may be required to obtain the currency that it must deliver under the foreign exchange forward through the sale of portfolio securities denominated in such currency or through conversion of other assets of a Fund into such currency.
Forward contracts in which a Fund may engage also include non-deliverable forwards (“NDFs”). NDFs are cash-settled, short-term forward contracts on foreign currencies (each a “Reference Currency”) that are non-convertible and that may be thinly traded or illiquid. NDFs involve an obligation to pay an amount (the “Settlement Amount”) equal to the difference between the prevailing market exchange rate for the Reference Currency and the agreed upon exchange rate (the “NDF Rate”), with respect to an agreed notional amount. NDFs have a fixing date and a settlement (delivery) date. The fixing date is the date and time at which the difference between the prevailing market exchange rate and the agreed upon exchange rate is calculated. The settlement (delivery) date is the date by which the payment of the Settlement Amount is due to the party receiving payment.
Although NDFs are similar to foreign exchange forwards, NDFs do not require physical delivery of the Reference Currency on the settlement date. Rather, on the settlement date, the only transfer between the counterparties is the monetary settlement amount representing the difference between the NDF Rate and the prevailing market exchange rate. NDFs typically may have terms from one month up to two years and are settled in U.S. dollars.
19

NDFs are subject to many of the risks associated with derivatives in general and forward currency transactions, including risks associated with fluctuations in foreign currency and the risk that the counterparty will fail to fulfill its obligations. Although NDFs historically have been traded over-the-counter, in the future, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (“Dodd-Frank Act”), they may be exchange-traded. Under such circumstances, they will be centrally cleared, and a secondary market for them will exist. With respect to NDFs that are centrally cleared, an investor could lose margin payments it has deposited with the clearing organization as well as the net amount of gains not yet paid by the clearing organization if the clearing organization breaches its obligations under the NDF, becomes insolvent or goes into bankruptcy. In the event of bankruptcy of the clearing organization, the investor may be entitled to the net amount of gains the investor is entitled to receive plus the return of margin owed to it only in proportion to the amount received by the clearing organization’s other customers, potentially resulting in losses to the investor. Even if some NDFs remain traded OTC, they will be subject to margin requirements for uncleared swaps and counterparty risk common to other swaps.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Futures Contracts
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may use futures contracts to implement its investment strategy. Futures contracts are publicly traded contracts to buy or sell an underlying asset or group of assets, such as a currency, interest rate, or an index of securities, at a future time at a specified price. Opening a position by buying a contract establishes a long position, while opening a position by selling a contract establishes a short position.
The purchase of a futures contract on a security or an index of securities normally enables a buyer to participate in the market movement of the underlying asset or index after paying a transaction charge and posting margin in an amount equal to a small percentage of the value of the underlying asset or index. A Fund initially will be required to deposit with the Trust’s custodian or the futures commission merchant (“FCM”) effecting the futures transaction an amount of “initial margin” in cash or securities, as permitted under applicable regulatory policies.
The initial margin in futures transactions is different from the margin in securities transactions in that the former does not involve the borrowing of funds by the customer to finance the transaction. Rather, the initial margin is like a performance bond or good faith deposit on the contract. Subsequent payments (called “maintenance or variation margin”) to and from the broker will be made on a daily basis as the price of the underlying asset fluctuates. This process is known as “marking to market.” For example, when a Fund has taken a long position in a futures contract and the value of the underlying asset has risen, that position will have increased in value and a Fund will receive from the broker a maintenance margin payment equal to the increase in value of the underlying asset. Conversely, when a Fund has taken a long position in a futures contract and the value of the underlying instrument has declined, the position would be less valuable, and a Fund would be required to make a maintenance margin payment to the broker.
At any time prior to expiration of the futures contract, a Fund may elect to close the position by taking an opposite position that will terminate a Fund’s position in the futures contract. A final determination of maintenance margin is then made, additional cash is required to be paid by or released to a Fund, and a Fund realizes a loss or a gain. While futures contracts with respect to securities do provide for the delivery and acceptance of such securities, such delivery and acceptance seldom are made.
The risk of loss in trading futures contracts can be substantial because of the low margin deposits required and the high degree of leveraging involved in futures pricing. As a result, a relatively small price movement in a futures contract may cause an immediate and substantial loss or gain. The primary risks associated with the use of futures contracts are: (i) imperfect correlation between the change in market value of the stocks held by a Fund and the prices of futures contracts; and (ii) possible lack of a liquid secondary market for a futures contract and the resulting inability to close a futures position prior to its maturity date. The degree of imperfection of correlation depends on circumstances such as variations in speculative market demand for futures on securities, including technical influences in futures trading, and differences between the financial instruments being hedged and the instruments underlying the standard contracts available for trading in such respects as interest rate levels, maturities, and creditworthiness of issuers.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Illiquid Securities
Each Fund may invest up to 15% (except the Victory Money Market Fund, which may invest only up to 5%) of its respective net assets in securities that are illiquid. Illiquid securities generally are those securities that may not reasonably be expected to be sold or disposed of in current market conditions within seven calendar days or less without the sale or disposition significantly changing the market value of the security. Investments in illiquid securities may impair a Fund’s ability to raise cash for redemptions or other purposes.
20

Initial Public Offerings (“IPOs”)
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory  Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund) may invest in IPOs, which subject a Fund to the risk that the market value of IPO shares will fluctuate considerably due to factors such as the absence of a prior public market, unseasoned trading, a potentially small number of shares available for trading, and limited information about the issuer. The purchase of IPO shares may involve high transaction costs. IPO shares are subject to market risk and liquidity risk. When a Fund’s asset base is small, a significant portion of the Fund’s performance could be attributable to investments in IPOs, because such investments would have a magnified impact on the Fund. As the Fund’s assets grow, the effect of the Fund’s investments in IPOs on the Fund’s performance probably will decline, which could reduce the Fund’s performance.
Interfund Borrowing and Lending
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) is entitled to rely on an exemptive order from the SEC allowing them to lend money to, and borrow money from, each other pursuant to a master interfund lending agreement (the “Interfund Lending Program”). Under the Interfund Lending Program, the Funds may lend or borrow money for temporary purposes directly to or from one another (an “Interfund Loan”), subject to meeting the conditions of the SEC exemptive order. All Interfund Loans will consist only of uninvested cash reserves that the lending Fund otherwise would invest in short-term repurchase agreements or other short-term instruments.
If a Fund has outstanding bank borrowings, any Interfund Loans to the Fund would: (a) be at an interest rate equal to or lower than that of any outstanding bank borrowing, (b) be secured at least on an equal priority basis with at least an equivalent percentage of collateral to loan value as any outstanding bank loan that requires collateral, (c) have a maturity no longer than any outstanding bank loan (and in any event not over seven days), and (d) provide that, if an event of default occurs under any agreement evidencing an outstanding bank loan to the Fund, that event of default by the Fund will automatically (without need for action or notice by the lending Fund) constitute an immediate event of default under the master interfund lending agreement, entitling the lending Fund to call the Interfund Loan immediately (and exercise all rights with respect to any collateral), and that such call will be made if the lending bank exercises its right to call its loan under its agreement with the borrowing Fund.
A Fund may borrow on an unsecured basis through the Interfund Lending Program only if its outstanding borrowings from all sources immediately after the interfund borrowing total 10% or less of its total assets, provided that if the borrowing Fund has a secured loan outstanding from any other lender, including but not limited to another Fund, the lending Fund’s Interfund Loan will be secured on at least an equal priority basis with at least an equivalent percentage of collateral to loan value as any outstanding loan that requires collateral. If a borrowing Fund’s total outstanding borrowings immediately after an Interfund Loan would be greater than 10% of its total assets, the Fund may borrow through the Interfund Lending Program only on a secured basis. A Fund may not borrow under the Interfund Lending Program or from any other source if its total outstanding borrowings immediately after the borrowing would be more than 33 1/3% of its total assets or any lower threshold provided for by the Fund’s fundamental restrictions or non-fundamental policies.
No Fund may lend to another Fund through the Interfund Lending Program if the loan would cause the lending Fund’s aggregate outstanding loans through the Interfund Lending Program to exceed 15% of its current net assets at the time of the loan. A Fund’s Interfund Loans to any one Fund shall not exceed 5% of the lending Fund’s net assets. The duration of Interfund Loans will be limited to the time required to receive payment for securities sold, but in no event more than seven days, and for purposes of this condition, loans effected within seven days of each other will be treated as separate loan transactions. Each Interfund Loan may be called on one business day’s notice by a lending Fund and may be repaid on any day by a borrowing Fund. The limitations detailed above and the other conditions of the SEC exemptive order permitting interfund borrowing and lending are designed to minimize the risks associated with interfund borrowing and lending for both a lending Fund and a borrowing Fund. However, no borrowing or lending activity is without risk. When a Fund borrows money from another Fund, there is a risk that the Interfund Loan could be called on one business day’s notice or not renewed, in which case the Fund may have to borrow from a bank at higher rates if an Interfund Loan is not available from another Fund. Interfund Loans are subject to the risk that a borrowing Fund could be unable to repay the loan when due, and a delay in repayment to a lending Fund or from a borrowing Fund could result in a lost investment opportunity or additional costs. No Fund may borrow more than the amount permitted by its investment limitations. The Interfund Lending Program is subject to the oversight and periodic review of the Board.
Lending of Securities
Each Fund may lend its securities in accordance with a lending policy that has been authorized by the Board and implemented by the Adviser. Securities may be loaned only to qualified broker-dealers or other institutional investors that have been determined to be creditworthy by the Adviser. When borrowing securities from a Fund, the borrower will be required to maintain collateral with the Trust in an amount at least equal to the fair value of the borrowed securities. During the term of each loan, each Fund will be entitled to receive payments from the borrower equal to all interest and dividends paid on the securities during the term of the loan by the issuer of the securities. In addition, each Fund will invest any cash received as collateral in high-quality short-term instruments such as
21

obligations of the U.S. government or of its agencies or instrumentalities, repurchase agreements, or shares of money market mutual funds, thereby earning additional income. Risks to a Fund in securities-lending transactions are that the borrower may not provide additional collateral when required or return the securities when due; and that the value of the collateral, including collateral investments, will be less than the amount required to be returned to the borrower.
No loan of securities will be made if, as a result, the aggregate of such loans would exceed 33 1/3% of the value of a Fund’s total assets. Each Fund may terminate a loan at any time.
Letters of Credit
Certain of the debt obligations (including municipal securities, certificates of participation, commercial paper, and other short-term obligations) that the Funds may purchase may be backed by an unconditional and irrevocable letter of credit of a bank, savings and loan association, or insurance company which assumes the obligation for payment of principal and interest in the event of default by the issuer. Only banks, savings and loan associations, and insurance companies which, in the opinion of the Manager are of comparable quality to issuers of other permitted investments of a Fund, may be used for letter of credit-backed investments.
Leveraged Loans
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in leveraged loans, a type of bank loan. Leveraged loans are adjustable-rate bank loans made to companies rated below investment grade. The interest rates on leveraged loans are reset periodically based upon the fluctuations of a base interest rate such as the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”) and a “spread” above that base interest rate that represents a risk premium to the lending banks and/or other participating investors. Many bank loans bear an adjustable rate of interest; however, leveraged loans provide for a greater “spread” over the base interest rate than other bank loans because they are considered to represent a greater credit risk. Because they are perceived to represent a greater credit risk, leveraged loans possess certain attributes that are similar to high-yield securities. However, because they are often secured by collateral of the borrower, leveraged loans possess certain attributes that are similar to other bank loans.
Limitations and Risks of Options and Futures Activity
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may engage in both hedging and non-hedging strategies. Although effective hedging generally can capture the bulk of a desired risk adjustment, no hedge is completely effective. A Fund’s ability to hedge effectively through transactions in futures and options depends on the degree to which price movements in the hedged asset correlate with price movements of the futures and options.
Non-hedging strategies typically involve special risks. The profitability of a Fund’s non-hedging strategies will depend on the ability of the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser to analyze both the applicable derivatives market and the market for the underlying asset or group of assets. Derivatives markets often are more volatile than corresponding securities markets, and a relatively small change in the price of the underlying asset or group of assets can have a magnified effect upon the price of a related derivative instrument.
Derivatives markets also are often less liquid than the market for the underlying asset or group of assets. Some positions in futures and options may be closed out only on an exchange that provides a secondary market. There can be no assurance that a liquid secondary market will exist for any particular futures contract or option at any specific time. Thus, it may not be possible to close such an option or futures position prior to maturity. The inability to close options and futures positions also could have an adverse impact on a Fund’s ability to effectively carry out its derivative strategies and might, in some cases, require the Fund to deposit cash to meet applicable margin requirements.
Under certain circumstances, futures exchanges may establish daily limits on the amount that the price of a futures contract or an option on a futures contract can vary from the previous day’s settlement price; once that limit is reached, no trades may be made that day at a price beyond the limit. Daily price limits do not limit potential losses because prices could move to the daily limit for several consecutive days with little or no trading, thereby preventing liquidation of unfavorable positions.
If a Fund were unable to liquidate a futures contract or an option on a futures position due to the absence of a liquid secondary market or the imposition of price limits, it could incur substantial losses. The Fund would continue to be subject to market risk with respect to the position. In addition, except in the case of purchased options, the Fund would continue to be required to make daily variation margin payments and might be required to maintain the position being hedged by the future or option.
Historically, advisers of registered investment companies trading commodity interests (such as futures contracts, options on futures contracts, and swaps), including the Funds, have been excluded from regulation as Commodity Pool Operators (“CPOs”) pursuant to Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) Regulation 4.5. In February 2012, the CFTC announced substantial amendments to the permissible exclusions, and to the conditions for reliance on the permissible exclusions, from registration as a CPO. To qualify for an exclusion under these amendments to CFTC Regulation 4.5, if a Fund uses commodity interests (such as futures contracts, options on futures contracts, and swaps) other than for bona fide hedging purposes (as defined by the CFTC), the aggregate initial
22

margin and premiums required to establish these positions, determined at the time the most recent position was established, may not exceed 5% of the Fund’s NAV (after taking into account unrealized profits and unrealized losses on any such positions and excluding the amount by which options that are “in-the-money” at the time of purchase are “in-the-money”) or, alternatively, the aggregate net notional value of those positions, determined at the time the most recent position was established, may not exceed 100% of the fund’s NAV (after taking into account unrealized profits and unrealized losses on any such positions). In addition, to qualify for an exclusion, a Fund must satisfy a marketing test, which requires, among other things, that a Fund not hold itself out as a vehicle for trading commodity interests. The amendments to CFTC Regulation 4.5 became effective on April 24, 2012.
The Adviser currently claims an exclusion (under CFTC Regulation 4.5) from registration as a CPO with respect to the Funds and, in its management of the Funds, intends to comply with one of the two alternative trading limitations described above and the marketing limitation. Complying with the trading limitations may restrict the Adviser’s ability to use derivatives as part of the Funds' investment strategies. Although the Adviser expects to be able to execute the Funds' investment strategies within the limitations, a Fund’s performance could be adversely affected. In addition, rules under the Dodd-Frank Act may limit the availability of certain derivatives, may make the use of derivatives by portfolios more costly, and may otherwise adversely impact the performance and value of derivatives.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Liquidity Determinations
Rule 22e-4 under the 1940 Act (the “Liquidity Rule”) requires the Funds to establish and maintain a liquidity risk management program (“LRMP”). The Liquidity Rule defines “illiquid security” as a security that a Fund reasonably expects cannot be sold or disposed of in current market conditions in seven calendar days or less without the sale or disposition significantly changing the market value of the security. Such securities include, but are not limited to, time deposits and repurchase agreements with maturities longer than seven days. Securities that may be resold under Rule 144A, securities offered pursuant to Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “1933 Act”), or securities otherwise subject to restrictions or limitations on resale under the 1933 Act shall not be deemed illiquid solely by reason of being unregistered. Victory Capital, under oversight of the Board, determines whether a particular security is deemed to be liquid based on the trading markets for the specific security and other factors.
Loan Interests and Direct Debt Instruments (“bank loans”)
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in loan interests and direct debt instruments, generally referred to as bank loans, which are interests in amounts owed by a corporate, governmental, or other borrower to lenders or lending syndicates (in the case of loans and loan participations), to suppliers of goods or services (in the case of trade claims or other receivables), or to other parties. These investments involve a risk of loss in case of the default, insolvency, or bankruptcy of the borrower.
Loans normally are not registered with the SEC or any state securities commission or listed on any securities exchange. As a result, there typically is less public information available about a specific loan than there would be if the loan were registered or traded on an exchange. Loans also may not be considered “securities,” and purchasers, such as a Fund, may not be entitled to rely on the anti-fraud protections of the federal securities laws with respect to any loans they own in the event of fraud or misrepresentation by a borrower.
A Fund may come into possession of material non-public information about a borrower as a result of its ownership of a loan or other debt instrument of such borrower. Because of prohibitions on trading in securities of issuers while possessing such information, a Fund might be unable to enter into a transaction in a publicly traded security of that borrower when it otherwise would be advantageous to do so.
Purchasers of loans and other forms of direct indebtedness depend primarily upon the creditworthiness of the borrower for payment of interest and repayment of principal. If scheduled interest or principal payments are not made, or are not made in a timely manner, the value of the instrument may be adversely affected. Loans that are fully secured provide more protections than unsecured loans in the event of failure to make scheduled interest or principal payments. However, there is no assurance that the liquidation of collateral from a secured loan would satisfy the borrower’s obligation, or that the collateral could be liquidated. Indebtedness of borrowers whose creditworthiness is poor involves substantially greater risks and may be highly speculative. Borrowers that are in bankruptcy or restructuring may never pay off their indebtedness, or may only pay a small fraction of the amount owed. Direct indebtedness of developing countries also involves a risk that the governmental entities responsible for the repayment of the debt may be unable, or unwilling, to pay interest and repay principal when due.
Investments in loans through direct assignment of a financial institution’s interests with respect to a loan may involve additional risks such as a loan foreclosure, and costs and liabilities associated with owning and disposing of the collateral. In addition, it is possible that a purchaser could be held liable as a co-lender. Direct debt instruments also may involve a risk of insolvency of the lending bank or other intermediary.
23

A loan often is administered by a bank or other financial institution that acts as agent for all holders. The agent administers the terms of the loan, as specified in the loan agreement. Unless the purchaser has direct recourse against the borrower, the purchaser may have to rely on the agent to apply appropriate credit remedies against a borrower under the terms of the loan or other indebtedness. If assets held by the agent for the benefit of a purchaser were determined to be subject to the claims of the agent’s general creditors, the purchaser might incur certain costs and delays in realizing payment on the loan or loan participation and could suffer a loss of principal or interest.
Direct indebtedness may include letters of credit, revolving credit facilities, or other standby financing commitments that obligate purchasers to make additional cash payments on demand. These commitments may have the effect of requiring a purchaser to increase its investment in a borrower at a time when it would not otherwise have done so, even if the borrower’s condition makes it unlikely that the amount will ever be repaid.
For purposes of a Fund’s investment limitations, a Fund generally will treat the borrower as the “issuer” of indebtedness held by a Fund. In the case of loan participations where a bank or other lending institution serves as financial intermediary between a Fund and the borrower, if the participation does not shift the direct debtor-creditor relationship with the borrower to a Fund, SEC interpretations require a Fund, in some circumstances, to treat both the lending bank or other lending institution and the borrower as “issuers” for purposes of a Fund’s investment policies. Treating a financial intermediary as an issuer of indebtedness may restrict a Fund’s ability to invest in indebtedness related to a single financial intermediary, or a group of intermediaries engaged in the same industry, even if the underlying borrowers represent many different companies and industries.
Loans may have extended settlement periods. Accordingly, the proceeds from the sale of a loan may not be available to make additional investments or to meet redemption obligations until potentially a substantial period after the sale of the loan. The extended trade settlement periods could force a Fund to liquidate other securities to meet redemptions and may present a risk that a Fund may incur losses in order to timely honor redemptions.
Master Demand Notes
Each Fund may invest in master demand notes, which are obligations that permit the investment of fluctuating amounts by each Fund, at varying rates of interest using direct arrangements between the Fund, as lender, and the borrower. These notes permit daily changes in the amounts borrowed. Each Fund has the right to increase the amount under the note at any time up to the full amount provided by the note agreement, or to decrease the amount, and the borrower may repay up to the full amount of the note without penalty. Frequently, such obligations are secured by letters of credit or other credit support arrangements provided by banks. Because master demand notes are direct lending arrangements between the lender and borrower, these instruments generally will not be traded; and there generally is no secondary market for these notes, although they are redeemable (and immediately repayable by the borrower) at face value, plus accrued interest, at any time. The Adviser will invest a Fund’s assets in master demand notes only if the Board or its delegate has determined that they are of credit quality comparable to the debt securities in which the Fund generally may invest.
Master Limited Partnerships (“MLPs”)
Each Fund may invest in MLPs. MLPs are publicly traded partnerships whose interests or “units” are traded on securities exchanges like shares of corporate stock. A typical MLP consists of a general partner and limited partners; however, some MLPs are established as limited liability companies. To be treated as a partnership for federal tax purposes, an MLP generally must derive at least 90% of its gross income for each taxable year from qualifying sources, including activities such as the exploration, development, mining, production, processing, refining, transportation, storage, and certain marketing of mineral or natural resources. MLPs provide investors with strategic exposure to physical assets, which can be attractive in inflationary environments.
Investments in securities of an MLP involve risks that differ from investments in common stock, including risks related to limited control and limited rights to vote on matters affecting the MLP, risks related to potential conflicts of interest between the MLP and the MLP’s general partner, cash flow risks, and dilution risks. Certain MLP securities may trade in lower volumes due to their smaller capitalizations, and may be subject to more abrupt or erratic price movements and lower market liquidity.
Investing in MLPs also involves certain risks related to the underlying assets of the MLPs. MLPs generally are considered interest-rate sensitive investments, and during periods of interest rate volatility, may not provide attractive returns. MLPs operate in the energy sector and may be adversely affected by fluctuations in the prices and levels of supply and demand for energy commodities. A decrease in the production or availability of energy commodities, including through their natural depletion over time, may adversely impact the financial performance of MLPs. MLPs are subject to significant federal, state, and local government regulation in virtually every aspect of their operations. Such regulation can change over time in both scope and intensity, and such changes could increase compliance costs and adversely affect the financial performance of MLPs. There is an inherent risk that MLPs and other companies operating in the energy sector may incur environmental costs and liabilities due to the nature of their businesses and the substances they handle. Natural disasters, such as hurricanes, also may impact MLPs.
24

MLPs also are subject to risks relating to their complex tax structure, including the risk that a change in current tax law or a change in the business of a given MLP could cause the MLP to lose its tax status as a partnership, which may reduce the value of the Fund’s investment in the MLP and lower income to a Fund. Depreciation or other cost recovery deductions passed through to a Fund from any investments in MLPs in a given year will generally reduce a Fund’s taxable income, but those deductions may be recaptured in one or more subsequent years. When recognized and distributed, recapture income will generally be taxable to Fund shareholders at the time of the distribution at ordinary income tax rates, even though those shareholders might not have held shares in the Fund at the time the deductions were taken, and even though those shareholders may not have corresponding economic gain on their shares at the time of the recapture.
Mortgage-Backed Securities
Each Fund may invest in mortgage-backed securities. Mortgage-backed securities include, but are not limited to, securities issued by the Government National Mortgage Association (“Ginnie Mae,” also known as “GNMA”), Federal National Mortgage Association (“Fannie Mae”), and Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“Freddie Mac”). These securities represent ownership in a pool of mortgage loans. They differ from conventional bonds in that principal is paid back to the investor as payments are made on the underlying mortgages in the pool. Accordingly, a Fund receives monthly scheduled payments of principal and interest along with any unscheduled principal prepayments on the underlying mortgages. Because these scheduled and unscheduled principal payments must be reinvested at prevailing interest rates, mortgage-backed securities do not provide an effective means of locking in long-term interest rates for the investor. Like other fixed-income securities, when interest rates rise, the value of mortgage-backed securities with prepayment features generally will decline. In addition, when interest rates are declining, the value of mortgage-backed securities with prepayment features may not increase as much as other fixed-income securities. The weighted average life of such securities is likely to be substantially shorter than the stated final maturity as a result of scheduled principal payments and unscheduled principal prepayments.
Ginnie Mae is a government-owned corporation that is an agency of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. It guarantees, with the full faith and credit of the United States, full and timely payment of all monthly principal and interest on its mortgage-backed securities. Until recently, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac were government-sponsored corporations owned entirely by private stockholders. Both issue mortgage-related securities that contain guarantees as to timely payment of interest and principal but that are not backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government. The value of the companies’ securities fell sharply in 2008 due to concerns that the firms did not have sufficient capital to offset losses. The U.S. Treasury historically has had the authority to purchase obligations of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. In addition, in 2008, due to capitalization concerns, Congress provided the U.S. Treasury with additional authority to lend Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac emergency funds and to purchase the companies’ stock, as described below. In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury and the Federal Housing Finance Agency (“FHFA”) announced that Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac had been placed in conservatorship.
Since that time, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac have received significant capital support through U.S. Treasury preferred stock purchases and U.S. Federal Reserve (the “Fed”) purchases of their mortgage-backed securities. While the Fed’s purchases have terminated, the U.S. Treasury announced in December 2009 that it would continue its support for the entities’ capital as necessary to prevent a negative net worth. From the time Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac were placed into conservatorship through the fourth quarter of 2017, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac required U.S. Treasury support of approximately $187.5 billion through draws under the preferred stock purchase agreements and have paid the U.S. Treasury approximately $278.8 billion in aggregate cash dividends. However, such payments do not constitute a repayment of the draws Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac received from the U.S. Treasury. In the first quarter of 2018, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac each reported that the passage of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act in December 2017 had resulted in a decrease in the value of their deferred tax assets. As a result, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac reported net losses during the fourth quarter of 2017 and indicated that they would request draws from the U.S. Treasury in the amount of $3.7 billion and $0.3 billion, respectively. Accordingly, no assurance can be given that the Fed, U.S. Treasury, or FHFA initiatives will ensure that Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac will remain successful in meeting their obligations with respect to the debt and mortgage-backed securities they issue. Moreover, there remains significant uncertainty as to whether (or when) Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac will emerge from conservatorship, which has no specified termination date. Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac also are the subject of several continuing class action lawsuits and investigations by federal regulators, which (along with any resulting financial restatements) may adversely affect the guaranteeing entities. The future of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac is in question as Congress is considering several pieces of legislation that would reform Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, which would propose to address their structure, mission, portfolio limits and guarantee fees, among other issues. The potential impact of these developments is unclear, but they could cause a Fund to lose money.
Unlike mortgage-backed securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government or one of the GSEs, mortgage-backed securities issued by private issuers do not have a government or GSE guarantee. Private issuers may purchase various forms of private insurance or guarantees, including individual loan, title, pool and hazard insurance, to support the timely payment of principal and interest of the underlying mortgage loans. However, there can be no assurance that the private insurers or guarantors can meet their obligations under the insurance policies or guarantee arrangements. In addition, privately issued mortgage-backed securities are not traded on an exchange and there may be a limited market for the securities, especially when there is a perceived weakness in the mortgage and real
25

estate market sectors. Without an active trading market, private mortgage-backed securities may be particularly difficult to value because of the complexities involved in assessing the value of the underlying mortgage loans.
On June 3, 2019, under the FHFA’s “Single Security Initiative,” Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac ceased issuing their own mortgage-based securities and started issuing uniform mortgage-backed securities (“UMBS”). The Single Security Initiative seeks to align the characteristics of certain Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac mortgage-based securities and to support the overall liquidity in certain markets. Each UMBS will have a 55-day remittance cycle and can be used as collateral in either a Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac security or held for investment. In addition, investors may be approached to convert existing mortgage-backed securities into UMBS, possibly with an inducement fee being offered to holders of Freddie Mac mortgage-backed securities. The effects that the Single Security Initiative may have on the market and other mortgage-backed securities are uncertain.
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) also may invest in mortgage-backed securities that include collateralized mortgage obligations (“CMOs”), commercial mortgage-backed securities (“CMBSs”), stripped mortgage-backed securities (“SMBSs”), interest only commercial mortgage-backed securities (“CMBS IOs”), and mortgage dollar rolls.
CMOs are obligations fully collateralized by a portfolio of mortgages or mortgage-related securities. CMOs are divided into pieces (tranches) with varying maturities. The cash flow from the underlying mortgages is used to pay off each tranche separately. CMOs are designed to provide investors with more predictable cash flows than regular mortgage securities, but such cash flows can be difficult to predict because of the effect of prepayments. Failure to accurately predict prepayments can adversely affect a Fund’s return on these investments. CMOs also may be less marketable than other securities.
CMBSs include securities that reflect an interest in, and are secured by, mortgage loans on commercial real property, such as industrial and warehouse properties, office buildings, retail space and shopping malls, apartments, hotels and motels, nursing homes, hospitals and senior living centers. Many of the risks of investing in CMBSs reflect the risks of investing in the real estate securing the underlying mortgage loans. These risks reflect the effects of local and other economic conditions on real estate markets, the ability of tenants to make loan payments, and the ability of a property to attract and retain tenants. In addition, commercial properties, particularly industrial and warehouse properties, are subject to environmental risks and the burdens and costs of compliance with environmental laws and regulations. CMBSs may be less liquid and exhibit greater price volatility than other types of mortgage-backed securities.
SMBSs are derivative multi-class mortgage securities. SMBSs may be issued by agencies or instrumentalities of the U.S. government, or by private originators of, or investors in, mortgage loans, including savings and loan associations, mortgage banks, commercial banks, investment banks, and special purpose entities of the foregoing. SMBSs are usually structured with two classes that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions on a pool of mortgage assets. A common type of SMBS will have one class receiving some of the interest and most of the principal from the mortgage assets, while the other class will receive most of the interest and the remainder of the principal. In the most extreme case, one class will receive all of the interest (the interest only or “IO” class), while the other class will receive all of the principal (the principal-only or “PO” class). The yield to maturity on an IO class is extremely sensitive to the rate of principal payments (including prepayments) on the related underlying mortgage assets, and a rapid rate of principal payments may have a material adverse effect on a Fund’s yield to maturity from these securities. If the underlying mortgage assets experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail to recoup some or all of its initial investment in these securities even if the security is in one of the highest rating categories. Although SMBSs are purchased and sold by institutional investors through several investment banking firms acting as brokers or dealers, established trading markets for these types of securities are not as developed and, accordingly, these securities may be deemed “illiquid” and subject to a Fund’s limitations on investment in illiquid securities.
CMBS IOs are similar to the SMBSs described above but are contrasted by being backed by loans that have various forms of prepayment protection, which include lock-out provisions, yield maintenance provisions, and prepayment penalties. Therefore, they generally have less prepayment risk than SMBSs, and also are less sensitive to interest rate changes. CMBS IOs are subject to default-related prepayments that may have a negative impact on yield.
In mortgage dollar roll transactions, a Fund sells mortgage-backed securities for delivery in the current month and simultaneously contracts to purchase substantially similar securities on a specified future date. While the Fund would forego principal and interest paid on the mortgage-backed securities during the roll period, the Fund would be compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the lower price for the future purchase as well as by any interest earned on the proceeds of the initial sale. At the time a Fund enters into a mortgage dollar roll, it designates on its books and records cash or liquid securities to secure its obligation for the forward commitment to buy mortgage-backed securities. Mortgage dollar roll transactions may be considered a borrowing by a Fund. The mortgage dollar rolls entered into by a Fund may be used as arbitrage transactions in which the Fund will maintain an offsetting position in investment grade debt obligations or repurchase agreements that mature on or before the settlement date on the related mortgage dollar roll. Because a Fund will receive interest on the securities or repurchase agreements in which it invests the transaction proceeds, such transactions may involve leverage.
26

Municipal Lease Obligations (“MLOs”)
Each Fund may invest in MLOs, which are installment purchase contract obligations, and certificates of participation in such obligations (collectively, “lease obligations”). Lease obligations do not constitute general obligations of a municipality for which the municipality’s taxing power is pledged, although a lease obligation is ordinarily backed by a municipality’s covenant to budget for the payments due under the lease obligation.
Certain lease obligations contain “non-appropriation” clauses, which provide that the municipality has no obligation to make lease obligation payments in future years unless money is appropriated for such purpose on a yearly basis. Although “non-appropriation” lease obligations are secured by the leased property, disposition of the property in the event of foreclosure might prove difficult. In evaluating a potential investment in such a lease obligation, the Adviser  or the applicable Subadviser will consider: (1) the credit quality of the obligor; (2) whether the underlying property is essential to a governmental function; and (3) whether the lease obligation contains covenants prohibiting the obligor from substituting similar property if the obligor fails to make appropriations for the lease obligation.
Options on Futures Contracts
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in options on futures contracts to implement its investment strategy. An option on a futures contract gives the purchaser the right, in return for the premium paid, to assume a position in a futures contract (a long position if the option is a call and a short position if the option is a put) at a specified exercise price at any time during the period of the option.
The trading of options on futures contracts entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option. The risk of imperfect correlation, however, generally tends to diminish as the maturity date of the futures contract or expiration date of the option approaches. In addition, a Fund utilizing options on futures contracts is subject to the risk of market movements between the time that the option is exercised and the time of performance thereunder. This could increase the extent of any loss suffered by a Fund in connection with such transactions.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Options on Securities and Securities Indexes
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may purchase and sell options on securities or securities indexes to implement its investment strategy. There are two basic types of options: “puts” and “calls.” Each type of option can be used to establish either a long or a short position, depending upon whether a Fund is the purchaser or a writer of the option. A call option on a security, for example, gives the purchaser of the option the right to buy, and the writer of the option the obligation to sell, the underlying asset at the exercise price during the option period. Conversely, a put option on a security gives the purchaser of the option the right to sell, and the writer of the option the obligation to buy, the underlying asset at the exercise price during the option period.
Purchased options have limited risk equal to the amount of the premium paid for the option. Such options afford the opportunity for gain corresponding to the increase or decrease in the value of the optioned asset. In general, a purchased put increases in value as the value of the underlying security falls and a purchased call increases in value as the value of the underlying security rises.
The principal reason to write options is to generate extra income (the premium paid by the buyer). Written options have varying degrees of risk. An uncovered written call option theoretically carries unlimited risk, as the market price of the underlying asset could rise far above the exercise price before its expiration. This risk is tempered when the call option is covered, that is, when the option writer owns the underlying asset. In this case, the writer runs the risk of the lost opportunity to participate in the appreciation in value of the asset rather than the risk of an out-of-pocket loss. A written put option has defined risk, that is, the difference between the agreed-upon price that a Fund must pay to the buyer upon exercise of the put and the value, which could be zero, of the asset at the time of exercise.
The obligation of the writer of an option continues until the writer effects a closing purchase transaction or until the option expires. To secure its obligation to deliver the underlying asset in the case of a call option, or to pay for the underlying asset in the case of a put option, a covered writer is required to deposit in escrow the underlying security or other assets in accordance with the rules of the applicable clearing corporation and exchanges.
Among the options that a Fund may purchase or sell are options on a securities index. In general, options on an index of securities are similar to options on the securities themselves except that delivery requirements are different. For example, a put option on an index of securities does not give the holder the right to make actual delivery of a basket of securities but instead gives the holder the right to receive an amount of cash upon exercise of the option if the value of the underlying index has fallen below the exercise price. The amount of cash received will be equal to the difference between the closing price of the index and the exercise price of the option expressed in dollars times a specified multiple. As with options on equity securities, or futures contracts, a Fund may offset its position in index options prior to expiration by entering into a closing transaction on an exchange or it may let the option expire unexercised.
27

A securities index assigns relative values to the securities included in the index, and the index options are based on a broad market index. In connection with the use of such options, a Fund may cover its position by identifying assets having a value equal to the aggregate face value of the option position taken.
Indexed securities are instruments whose prices are indexed to the prices of other securities, securities indexes, commodities indexes, currencies, precious metals or other commodities, or other financial indicators. Indexed securities typically, but not always, are debt securities or deposits whose value at maturity or coupon rate is determined by reference to a specific instrument or statistic.
Inflation-protected securities, for example, can be indexed to a measure of inflation, such as the Consumer Price Index (“CPI”).
Commodity-indexed securities, for example, can be indexed to a commodities index such as the Dow Jones-UBS Commodity Index Total Return.
The performance of indexed securities depends to a great extent on the performance of the security, currency, commodity, or other instrument or measure to which they are indexed, and also may be influenced by interest rate changes in the United States and abroad. Indexed securities may be more volatile than the underlying instruments or measures. Indexed securities also are subject to the credit risks associated with the issuer of the security, and their values may decline substantially if the issuer’s creditworthiness deteriorates. Recent issuers of indexed securities have included banks, corporations, the U.S. Treasury, and certain other U.S. government agencies. In calculating a Fund’s dividends, index-based adjustments may be considered income.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Periodic Auction Reset Bonds
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in periodic auction reset bonds. Periodic auction reset bonds are bonds whose interest rates are reset periodically through an auction mechanism. For purposes of calculating the portfolio weighted average maturity of each Fund, the maturity of periodic auction reset bonds will be deemed to be the next interest reset date, rather than the remaining stated maturity of the instrument.
Periodic auction reset bonds, similar to short-term debt instruments, are generally subject to less interest rate risk than long-term fixed rate debt instruments because the interest rate will be periodically reset in a market auction. Periodic auction reset bonds with a long remaining stated maturity (i.e., 10 years or more), however, could have greater market risk than fixed short-term debt instruments, arising from the possibility of auction failure or insufficient demand at an auction, resulting in greater price volatility of such instruments compared to fixed short-term bonds.
Preferred Stocks
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory  Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund) may invest in preferred stocks, which represent a class of capital stock. Generally, preferred stock has a specified dividend and ranks after bonds and before common stocks in its claim on income for dividend payments and on assets should the company be liquidated. Preferred stockholders do not ordinarily enjoy any of the voting rights of common stockholders. Most preferred stock is cumulative, meaning that if dividends are passed (not paid for any reason), they accumulate and must be paid before common dividends. Typically, a preferred stock pays a fixed dividend that does not fluctuate, although the company does not have to pay this dividend if it lacks the financial ability to do so. However, an adjustable-rate preferred stock pays a dividend that is adjustable, usually quarterly, based on changes in the U.S. Treasury bill rate or other money market rates. A convertible preferred stock is exchangeable for a given number of common shares and thus tends to be more volatile than nonconvertible preferred, which behaves more like a fixed-income bond. The main benefit to owning preferred stock is that the investor has a greater claim on the company’s assets than common stockholders. Preferred stockholders always receive their dividends, and in the event the company goes bankrupt are paid off before common stockholders. Each Fund may purchase preferred stock where the issuer has omitted, or is in danger of omitting, payment of its dividend. Such investments would be made primarily for their capital appreciation potential.
Private Investments in Public Companies
A Fund may acquire common stock or a security convertible into common stock, such as a warrant or convertible preferred stock, directly from an issuer seeking to raise capital in a private placement pursuant to Regulation D under the 1933 Act. These transactions are commonly referred to as a private placement in a publicly held company, or “PIPE” (i.e., Private Investment in Public Equity). The issuer’s common stock usually is publicly traded on a U.S. securities exchange or in the OTC market, but the securities acquired will be subject to restrictions on resale imposed by U.S. securities laws absent an effective registration statement. In recognition of the illiquid nature of the securities being acquired, the purchase price paid in a PIPE transaction (or the conversion price of the convertible securities being acquired) typically will be fixed at a discount to the prevailing market price of the issuer’s common stock at the time of the transaction. As part of a PIPE transaction, the issuer usually will be contractually obligated to seek to register within an agreed upon period of time for public resale under the U.S. securities laws, the common stock, or the shares of common stock issuable upon
28

conversion of the convertible securities. If the issuer fails to so register the shares within that period, the buyer may be entitled to additional consideration from the issuer (e.g., warrants to acquire additional shares of common stock), but the buyer may not be able to sell its shares unless and until the registration process is successfully completed. Thus, PIPE transactions present certain risks not associated with open market purchases of equities.
Among the risks associated with PIPE transactions is the risk that the issuer may be unable to register the shares for public resale in a timely manner or at all, in which case the shares may be sold only in a privately negotiated transaction, typically at a price less than that paid, assuming a suitable buyer can be found. Disposing of the securities may involve time-consuming negotiation and legal expenses, and selling them promptly at an acceptable price may be difficult or impossible. Even if the shares are registered for public resale, the market for the issuer’s securities may nevertheless be “thin” or illiquid, making the sale of securities at desired prices or in desired quantities difficult or impossible.
While private placements may offer attractive opportunities not otherwise available in the open market, the securities purchased are usually “restricted securities” or are “not readily marketable.” Restricted securities cannot be sold without being registered under the 1933 Act, unless they are sold pursuant to an exemption from registration (such as Rules 144 or 144A under the 1933 Act). Securities that are not readily marketable are subject to other legal or contractual restrictions on resale.
Put Bonds
Each Fund may invest in securities (including securities with variable interest rates), the interest on which is excludable from gross income for federal income tax purposes (“tax-exempt securities”), that may be redeemed or sold back (put) to the issuer of the security or a third party prior to stated maturity (put bonds). Such securities normally will trade as if maturity is the earliest put date, even though stated maturity is longer. Under a Fund’s portfolio allocation procedure, maturity for put bonds is deemed to be the date on which the put becomes exercisable.
Real Estate Investment Trusts (“REITs”)
Because each Fund (except the Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund, and Victory Money Market Fund) may invest a portion of its assets in equity securities of REITs, these Funds also may be subject to certain risks associated with direct investments in real estate, including the cyclical nature of real estate values, risks related to general and local economic conditions, overbuilding and increased competition, increases in property taxes and operating expenses, demographic trends and variations in rental income, changes in zoning laws, casualty or condemnation losses, environmental risks, and increases in interest rates and other real estate capital market influences.
In addition, each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest a portion of its assets in the debt and preferred securities of REITs and, therefore, may be subject to certain other risks, such as credit risk, associated with investment in these securities. REITs may be affected by changes in the value of their underlying properties and by defaults by borrowers or tenants. Furthermore, REITs depend upon the specialized management skills of their managers and may have limited geographic diversification, thereby subjecting them to risks inherent in financing a limited number of projects. REITs generally depend on their ability to generate cash flow to make distributions to shareholders, and certain REITs have self-liquidation provisions by which mortgages held may be paid in full and distributions of capital returns may be made at any time. A shareholder in a Fund that invests in REITs will bear not only its proportionate share of the expenses of the Fund, but also will bear, indirectly, the management expenses of the underlying REITs.
Recent Market Conditions and Regulatory Developments
U.S. and international markets have experienced significant volatility in recent months and years. As a result of such volatility, investment returns may fluctuate significantly and could decline suddenly. Global economies and financial markets are highly interconnected, which increases the likelihood that conditions in one country or region will adversely impact issuers in a different country or region.
Due to concerns regarding recent high inflation in many sectors of the U.S. and global economies, the U.S. Federal Reserve (“Fed”) and many foreign central banks and monetary authorities raised interest rates and implemented other policy initiatives in an effort to control inflation, and they may continue to do so. It is difficult to predict the timing, frequency, magnitude or direction of further interest rate changes, and the evaluation of macro-economic and other conditions or events could cause a change in approach in the future. Fixed-income and related markets may continue to experience heightened levels of interest rate and price volatility. Inflation risk is the uncertainty over the future real value (after inflation) of an investment. A Fund’s investments may not keep pace with inflation, and the value of an investment in a Fund may be eroded over time by inflation. Changes in government or central bank policies could negatively affect the value and liquidity of a Fund’s investments and cause it to lose money, and there can be no assurance that the initiatives undertaken by governments and central banks will be successful.
The Fed’s or foreign central banks’ actions may result in an economic slowdown in the United States and abroad, which could negatively impact a Fund’s investments. There are concerns that monetary policy may provide less support should economic growth
29

slow. An economic slowdown may negatively affect national and global economies, as well as national and global securities and commodities markets, and may continue for an extended period of time and have unforeseen impacts.  Any deterioration in economic fundamentals may increase the risk of default or insolvency of particular issuers, negatively impact market values, cause credit spreads to widen, and reduce bank balance sheets. Any of these could cause an increase in market volatility, reduce liquidity across various markets, or decrease confidence in the markets. 
In March 2023, the shutdown of certain financial institutions raised economic concerns over disruption in the U.S. banking system. There can be no certainty that the actions taken by the U.S. government to strengthen public confidence in the U.S. banking system will be effective in mitigating the effects of financial institution failures on the economy and enhancing public confidence in the U.S. banking system. In addition, widespread loan defaults in the commercial real estate sector could have a cascading effect on the broader banking system, straining the financial health of lending institutions and potentially causing more banks to fail, which could adversely affect the value of a Fund’s investments.
High public debt in the United States and other countries creates ongoing systemic and market risks and policymaking uncertainty, and there has been a significant increase in the amount of debt due to the economic effects of the coronavirus disease (COVID-19) pandemic and ensuing economic relief and public health measures. Economic, political and other developments may result in a further increase in the amount of public debt, including in the United States. The long-term consequences of high public debt are not known, but high levels of public debt may negatively affect economic conditions and the value of markets, sectors and companies in which a Fund invests.
Political and diplomatic events within the United States, including a contentious domestic political environment, changes in political party control of one or more branches of the U.S. government, the U.S. government’s inability at times to agree on a long-term budget and deficit reduction plan, a U.S. government shutdown (or the threat of such a shutdown), and disagreements over, or threats not to increase, the U.S. government’s borrowing limit (or “debt ceiling”), as well as political and diplomatic events abroad, may affect investor and consumer confidence and may adversely impact financial markets and the broader economy, perhaps suddenly and to a significant degree. A downgrade of the ratings of U.S. government debt obligations, or concerns about the U.S. government’s credit quality in general, could have a substantial negative effect on the U.S. and global economies. Moreover, although the U.S. government has honored its credit obligations, there remains a possibility that the United States could default on its obligations. The consequences of such an unprecedented event are impossible to predict, but it is likely that a default by the United States or other crisis would be highly disruptive to the U.S. and global securities markets and could significantly impair the value of the Funds’ investments.
Tensions, war, or other open conflicts between nations, such as between Russia and Ukraine, in the Middle East, and in eastern Asia, the resulting responses by the United States and other countries, and the potential for wider conflict have had, and could continue to have, severe adverse effects on regional and global economies and could further increase volatility and uncertainty in the financial markets. The extent and duration of ongoing hostilities or military actions and the repercussions of such actions are impossible to predict. These events have resulted in, and could continue to result in, significant market disruptions, including in certain industries or sectors such as the oil and natural gas markets, and may further strain global supply chains and negatively affect inflation and global growth. The resulting adverse market conditions could be prolonged. These and any related events could significantly impact a Fund’s performance and the value of an investment in a Fund, whether or not the Fund invests in securities of issuers located in or with significant exposure to the countries or regions directly affected.
Certain illnesses spread rapidly and have the potential to significantly and adversely affect the global economy and have material adverse impacts on a Fund. Public health crises caused by outbreaks of infectious diseases or other public health issues may disrupt market conditions and operations and economies around the world, exacerbate other pre-existing economic, political, and social tensions and risks, and negatively affect market performance and the value of investments in individual companies in significant and unforeseen ways. The impact of any outbreak may last for an extended period of time. For example, the impact of the coronavirus disease (COVID-19) pandemic caused significant volatility and severe losses in global financial markets. The COVID-19 pandemic and efforts to contain its spread resulted in significant disruptions to business operations, supply chains and customer activity, higher default rates, widespread business closures and layoffs, travel restrictions and border closings, extended quarantines and stay-at-home orders, event and service cancellations, labor shortages, and significant challenges in healthcare service preparation and delivery, as well as general concern, uncertainty and social unrest. The continued impact of COVID-19 is uncertain. Other outbreaks of infectious diseases or other public health issues that may arise in the future may have similar or worse effects.
Slowing global economic growth, the rise in protectionist trade policies, and changes to some major international trade agreements (including, for example, the trade agreement between the United Kingdom and the European Union) could affect the economies of many countries in ways that cannot necessarily be foreseen at the present time. Relationships between the United States and certain foreign countries have become increasingly strained. If relations with certain countries deteriorate, it could adversely affect U.S. issuers as well as non-U.S. issuers that rely on the United States for trade. For example, the United States has imposed tariffs and other trade barriers on Chinese exports, has restricted sales of certain categories of goods to China, and has established barriers to investments in China. In addition, the Chinese government is involved in a longstanding dispute with Taiwan that has included threats of invasion.
30

If relations between the United States and China do not improve or continue to deteriorate, or if China were to attempt unification of Taiwan by coercion or force, economies, markets and individual securities may be severely affected both regionally and globally, and the value of a Fund’s investments may go down. 
Advancements in technology may also adversely impact market movements and liquidity and may affect the overall performance of a Fund. For example, the advanced development and increased regulation of artificial intelligence may impact the economy and the performance of a Fund. As artificial intelligence is used more widely, the profitability and growth of a Fund’s holdings may be impacted, which could impact the overall performance of a Fund.
In addition, global climate change may have a significant adverse effect on property and security values. A rise in sea levels, changes in weather patterns, an increase in powerful storms and/or an increase in flooding could cause real estate properties to lose value or become unmarketable altogether. Unlike previous declines in the real estate market, properties in affected zones may never recover their value. Large wildfires have devastated, and in the future may devastate, entire communities and may be very costly to any business found to be responsible for the fire or conducting operations in affected areas. Regulatory changes and divestment movements in the United States and abroad tied to concerns about climate change could adversely affect the value of certain land and the viability of industries whose activities or products are seen as accelerating climate change. Losses related to climate change could adversely affect corporate borrowers and mortgage lenders, the value of mortgage-backed securities, the bonds of municipalities that depend on tax revenues and tourist dollars generated by affected properties, and insurers of the properties and/or of corporate, municipal or mortgage-backed securities. Because property and security values are driven largely by buyers’ perceptions, it is difficult to know the time period over which these market effects might unfold.
All of these risks may have a material adverse effect on the performance and financial condition of the companies and other issuers in which the Funds invest, and on the overall performance of a Fund.
Reference Rate Transition Risk
The London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) had historically been the principal floating rate benchmark in the financial markets. However, LIBOR is being discontinued as a floating rate benchmark, although certain synthetic U.S. dollar LIBOR tenors will be published through September 30, 2024, for certain legacy contracts. Then-existing LIBOR obligations have been transitioned or will transition to another benchmark, depending on the LIBOR currency and tenor. For some existing LIBOR-based obligations, the contractual consequences of the discontinuation of LIBOR may not be clear.
As an alternative to LIBOR, the market has generally coalesced around the use of the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”) as a replacement for U.S. dollar LIBOR. Various SOFR-based rates, including SOFR-based term rates, and various non-SOFR-based rates have developed in response to the discontinuation of U.S. dollar LIBOR, which may create various risks for the Fund and the financial markets more generally. There are non-LIBOR forward-looking floating rates that are not based on SOFR and that may be considered by participants in the financial markets as LIBOR alternatives. Unlike forward-looking SOFR-based term rates, such rates are intended reflect a bank credit spread component.
Non-LIBOR floating rate obligations, including obligations based on the SOFR, may have returns and values that fluctuate more than those of floating rate debt obligations that are based on LIBOR or other rates. Also, because SOFR and some alternative floating rates are relatively new market indexes, markets for certain non-LIBOR obligations may never develop or may not be liquid. Market terms for non-LIBOR floating rate obligations, such as the spread over the index reflected in interest rate provisions, may evolve over time, and prices of non-LIBOR floating rate obligations may be different depending on when they are issued and changing views about correct spread levels.
It is not clear how replacement rates for LIBOR–including SOFR-based rates and non-SOFR-based rates–will continue to develop and to what extent they will be used. There is no assurance that these replacement rates will be suitable substitutes for LIBOR, and thus the substitution of such rates for LIBOR could have an adverse effect on the Funds and the financial markets more generally. Concerns about market depth and stability could affect the development of non-SOFR-based term rates, and such rates may create various risks, which may or may not be similar to the risks relating to SOFR.
31

Repurchase Agreements
Each Fund may invest in repurchase agreements, which are collateralized by underlying securities. The Victory Money Market Fund may invest in repurchase agreements that are collateralized by cash items or obligations issued or guaranteed as to both principal and interest by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities. A repurchase agreement is a transaction in which a security is purchased with a simultaneous commitment to sell it back to the seller (a commercial bank or recognized securities dealer) at an agreed upon price on an agreed upon date, usually not more than seven days from the date of purchase. The resale price reflects the purchase price plus an agreed upon market rate of interest, which is unrelated to the coupon rate or maturity of the purchased security. A Fund maintains custody of the underlying securities prior to their repurchase, either through its regular custodian or through a special “tri-party” custodian that maintains separate accounts for both the Fund and its counterparty. Thus, the obligation of the counterparty to pay the repurchase price on the date agreed to or upon demand is, in effect, secured by the underlying securities. In these transactions, the securities purchased by a Fund will be those in which it is authorized to invest and that have a total value in excess of the amount of the repurchase obligation. If the seller defaults and the value of the underlying security declines, a Fund may incur a loss and may incur expenses in selling the collateral. If the seller seeks relief under the bankruptcy laws, the disposition of the collateral may be delayed or limited. The Funds will invest in repurchase agreement transactions with parties whose creditworthiness has been reviewed and found satisfactory by the Adviser. The Victory Extended Market Index Fund may not invest more than 15% of its net assets in repurchase agreements maturing in more than seven days together with all other illiquid securities.
Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper and Rule 144A Securities
Each Fund may invest in commercial paper issued in reliance on the “private placement” exemption from registration afforded by Section 4(a)(2) of the 1933 Act (“Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper”). Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper is restricted as to disposition under the federal securities laws; therefore, any resale of Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper must be effected in a transaction exempt from registration under the 1933 Act. Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper normally is resold to other investors through or with the assistance of the issuer or investment dealers who make a market in Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper, thus providing liquidity.
Each Fund also may purchase restricted securities eligible for resale to “qualified institutional buyers” pursuant to Rule 144A under the 1933 Act (“Rule 144A Securities”). Rule 144A provides a non-exclusive safe harbor from the registration requirements of the 1933 Act for resales of certain securities to institutional investors.
However, investing in Rule 144A securities and Section 4(a)(2) Commercial Paper could have the effect of increasing the level of a Fund’s illiquidity to the extent that qualified institutional buyers become, for a time, uninterested in purchasing these securities.
Securities of Other Investment Companies
Each Fund may invest in securities issued by other investment companies that qualify as “money market funds” under applicable SEC rules. Any such investment would be made in accordance with the Fund’s investment policies and applicable law. In addition, each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may invest in securities issued by other non-money market investment companies (including ETFs). As a shareholder of another investment company, a Fund would indirectly bear, along with other shareholders, its pro rata portion of the other investment company’s expenses, including advisory fees. These expenses would be in addition to the advisory and other expenses that a Fund bears in connection with its own operations. The Funds may invest in securities issued by other investment companies subject to statutory limitations prescribed by the 1940 Act. Certain exceptions to these limitations are provided by the 1940 Act and the rules and regulations thereunder. Investing in other investment companies involves substantially the same risks as investing directly in the underlying instruments, but the total return on such instruments at the investment company level may be reduced by the operating expenses and fees of such investment companies, including advisory fees.
The SEC has adopted certain regulatory changes and taken other actions related to the ability of an investment company to invest in the securities of another investment company. These changes included, among other things, the rescission of certain SEC exemptive orders permitting investments in excess of the statutory limits, the withdrawal of certain related SEC staff no-action letters, and the adoption of Rule 12d1-4 under the 1940 Act. Rule 12d1-4 permits a portfolio to invest in other investment companies beyond the statutory limits, subject to certain conditions.
Securities of Smaller Companies
The Victory Extended Market Index Fund invests in smaller companies, which can involve greater risk than is customarily associated with funds that invest in more established companies. The securities of smaller companies may be subject to more abrupt or erratic market movements than larger, more established companies or the market average in general. These companies may have limited product lines, markets, or financial resources, or they may be dependent on a limited management group.
While the issuers in which the Fund will primarily invest may offer greater opportunities for capital appreciation than larger cap issuers, investments in smaller companies may involve greater risks and thus may be considered speculative.
32

To some extent, the securities in which the Fund invests will often be traded only in the over-the-counter (“OTC”) market or on a regional securities exchange and may not be traded every day or in the volume typical of trading on a national securities exchange. As a result, the disposition by the Fund of portfolio securities, to meet redemptions or otherwise, may require the Fund to sell these securities at a discount from market prices or during periods when in management’s judgment such disposition is not desirable or to make many small sales over a lengthy period of time.
Small companies generally are little known to most individual investors although some may be dominant in their respective industries. Management of the Fund believes that relatively small companies will continue to have the opportunity to develop into significant business enterprises. The Fund may invest in securities of small issuers in the relatively early stages of business development which have a new technology, a unique or proprietary product or service, or a favorable market position. Such companies may not be counted upon to develop into major industrial companies, but management believes that eventual recognition of their special value characteristics by the investment community can provide above-average long-term growth to the portfolio.
Equity securities of specific small-cap issuers may present different opportunities for long-term capital appreciation during varying portions of economic or securities markets cycles, as well as during varying stages of their business development. The market valuation of small-cap issuers tends to fluctuate during economic or market cycles, presenting attractive investment opportunities at various points during these cycles.
Smaller companies, due to the size and kinds of markets that they serve, may be less susceptible than large companies to intervention from the Federal government by means of price controls, regulations, or litigation.
Short Sales
The Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund may invest their assets in short sales. When a Fund takes a long position, it purchases a stock outright. When the Fund takes a short position, it sells at the current market price a stock it does not own but has borrowed in anticipation that the market price of the stock will decline. To complete, or close out, the short sale transaction, the Fund buys the same stock in the market and returns it to the lender. The price at such time may be more or less than the price at which the security was sold by the Fund. Until the security is replaced, the Fund is required to pay the lender amounts equal to any dividends or interest, which accrue during the period of the loan. To borrow the security, the Fund also may be required to pay a premium, which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet the margin requirements, until the short position is closed out. The Fund makes money when the market price of the borrowed stock goes down and the Fund is able to replace it for less than it earned by selling it short. Alternatively, if the price of the stock goes up after the short sale and before the short position is closed, the Fund will lose money because it will have to pay more to replace the borrowed stock than it received when it sold the stock short.
The Fund may not always be able to close out a short position at a particular time or at an acceptable price. A lender may request that the borrowed securities be returned to it on short notice, and the Fund may have to buy the borrowed securities at an unfavorable price. If this occurs at a time that other short sellers of the same security also want to close out their positions, a “short squeeze” can occur. A short squeeze occurs when demand is greater than supply for the stock sold short. A short squeeze makes it more likely that the Fund will have to cover its short sale at an unfavorable price. If that happens, the Fund will lose some or all the potential profit from, or even incur a loss as a result of, the short sale. The Fund believes that short sale obligations that are covered by an offsetting asset or right (acquiring the security sold short or having an option to purchase the security sold short at exercise price that covers the obligation), are not subject to the Fund’s borrowing restrictions. The Fund also is required to pay the lender of the security any dividends or interest that accrues on a borrowed security during the period of the loan. Depending on the arrangements made with the broker or custodian, the Fund may or may not receive any payments (including interest) on collateral it has deposited with the broker.
Short sales involve the risk that the Fund will incur a loss by subsequently buying a security at a higher price than the price at which the Fund previously sold the security short. Any loss will be increased by the amount of compensation, interest or dividends, and transaction costs the Fund must pay to a lender of the security. In addition, because the Fund’s loss on a short sale stems from increases in the value of the security sold short, the extent of such loss, like the price of the security sold short, is theoretically unlimited. By contrast, the Fund’s loss on a long position arises from decreases in the value of the security held by the Fund and therefore is limited by the fact that a security’s value cannot drop below zero.
The use of short sales, in effect, leverages the Fund’s portfolio, which could increase the Fund’s exposure to the market, magnify losses, and increase the volatility of returns.
Although the Fund’s share price may increase if the securities in its long portfolio increase in value more than the securities underlying its short positions, the Fund’s share price may decrease if the securities underlying its short positions increase in value more than the securities in its long portfolio.
33

Short-Term Instruments
When a Fund experiences large cash inflows, for example, through the sale of securities, and desirable securities that are consistent with the Fund’s investment objective(s) are unavailable in sufficient quantities or at attractive prices, the Fund may hold short-term investments (or shares of money market mutual funds) for a limited time at the discretion of the Adviser (or Subadviser, as applicable). Short-term instruments consist of foreign and domestic: (i) short-term obligations of sovereign governments, their agencies, instrumentalities, authorities or political subdivisions; (ii) other short-term debt securities; (iii) commercial paper; (iv) bank obligations, including negotiable certificates of deposit, time deposits and bankers' acceptances; and (v) repurchase agreements.
Special Purpose Acquisition Companies
A Fund may invest in stock, warrants and other securities of special purpose acquisition companies (“SPACs”). A SPAC typically is a publicly traded company that raises funds through an initial public offering (“IPO”) for the purpose of acquiring or merging with another company to be identified subsequent to the SPAC’s IPO. If a Fund purchases shares of a SPAC in an IPO it generally will bear a sales commission, which may be significant. The securities of a SPAC are often issued in “units” that include one share of common stock and one right or warrant (or partial right or warrant) conveying the right to purchase additional shares or partial shares. Unless and until a transaction is completed, a SPAC generally invests its assets (less a portion retained to cover expenses) in U.S. government securities, money market funds and similar investments whose returns or yields may be significantly lower than those of a Fund’s other investments. If an acquisition or merger that meets the requirements for the SPAC is not completed within a pre-established period of time, the invested funds are returned to the SPAC’s shareholders, less certain permitted expenses, and any rights or warrants issued by the SPAC will expire worthless.
Because SPACs and similar entities are in essence “blank check” companies without operating history or ongoing business other than seeking acquisitions, the value of their securities is particularly dependent on the ability of the entity’s management to identify and complete a profitable acquisition. An investment in a SPAC is subject to a variety of risks, including that (1) a portion of the monies raised by the SPAC for the purpose of effecting an acquisition or merger may be expended prior to the transaction for payment of taxes and other expenses; (2) a Fund generally will not receive significant income from its investments in SPACs (both prior to and after any acquisition or merger) and, therefore, the Fund’s investments in SPACs will not significantly contribute to the Fund’s distributions to shareholders; (3) an attractive acquisition or merger target may not be identified at all or a proposed merger or acquisition may be unable to obtain the requisite approval, if any, of SPAC shareholders and/or antitrust and securities regulators; (4) the warrants or other rights with respect to the SPAC held by a Fund may expire worthless or may be redeemed by the SPAC at an unfavorable price; (5) the Fund may be subject to opportunity costs to the extent that alternative investments would have produced higher returns; (6) an acquisition or merger once effected may prove unsuccessful and an investment in the SPAC may lose value; (7) while a SPAC is seeking a transaction target, its stock may be thinly traded and/or illiquid and there can be no assurance that a market will develop, leaving a Fund unable to sell its interest in a SPAC or to sell its interest only at a price below what the Fund believes is the SPAC interest’s intrinsic value; (8) an investment in a SPAC may be diluted by additional later offerings of interests in the SPAC or by other investors exercising existing rights to purchase shares of the SPAC; and (9) the values of investments in SPACs may be highly volatile and may depreciate significantly over time. The proceeds of a SPAC IPO that are placed in trust are subject to risks, including the risk of insolvency of the custodian of the funds, fraud by the trustee, interest rate risk and credit and liquidity risk relating to the securities and money market funds in which the proceeds are invested.
Swap Arrangements
Each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund) may enter into various forms of swap arrangements with counterparties with respect to interest rates, currency rates or indexes, including purchase of caps, floors and collars as described below. Swap agreements are two-party contracts entered into primarily by institutional investors for periods ranging from a few weeks to more than one year.
In an interest rate swap a Fund could agree for a specified period to pay a bank or investment banker the floating rate of interest on a so-called notional principal amount (i.e., an assumed figure selected by the parties for this purpose) in exchange for agreement by the bank or investment banker to pay a Fund a fixed rate of interest on the notional principal amount. In a currency swap a Fund would agree with the other party to exchange cash flows based on the relative differences in values of a notional amount of two (or more) currencies; in an index swap, a Fund would agree to exchange cash flows on a notional amount based on changes in the values of the selected indexes. The purchase of a cap entitles the purchaser to receive payments from the seller on a notional amount to the extent that the selected index exceeds an agreed upon interest rate or amount, whereas the purchase of a floor entitles the purchaser to receive such payments to the extent the selected index falls below an agreed upon interest rate or amount. A collar combines buying a cap and selling a floor.
Most swaps entered into by a Fund will be on a net basis. For example, in an interest rate swap, amounts generated by application of the fixed rate and floating rate to the notional principal amount would first offset one another, with the Fund either receiving or paying the difference between such amounts. In order to be in a position to meet any obligations resulting from swaps, a Fund will set up a segregated custodial account to hold liquid assets, including cash. For swaps entered into on a net basis, assets will be segregated having
34

an NAV equal to any excess of a Fund’s accrued obligations over the accrued obligations of the other party; for swaps on other than a net basis, assets will be segregated having a value equal to the total amount of a Fund’s obligations. Collateral is treated as illiquid.
Swap agreements historically have been individually negotiated, and most swap arrangements are currently traded over-the-counter. Certain standardized swaps currently are, and more in the future will be, centrally cleared and traded on either a swap execution facility or a designated contract market. Cleared swaps are transmitted through FCMs that are members of central clearinghouses with the clearinghouse serving as a central counterparty similar to transactions in futures contracts. Central clearing is expected to decrease counterparty risk and increase liquidity compared to uncleared swaps because central clearing interposes the central clearinghouse as the counterparty to each participant's swap. However, central clearing does not eliminate counterparty risk or illiquidity risk entirely. For example, swaps that are centrally cleared are subject to the creditworthiness of the clearing organization involved in the transaction. An investor could lose margin payments it has deposited with its FCM as well as the net amount of gains not yet paid by the clearing organization if the clearing organization becomes insolvent or goes into bankruptcy. In the event of bankruptcy of the clearing organization, the investor may be entitled to the net amount of gains the investor is entitled to receive plus the return of margin owed to it only in proportion to the amount received by the clearing organization’s other customers, potentially resulting in losses to the investor. In addition, depending on the size of a portfolio and other factors, the margin required under the rules of a clearinghouse and by a clearing member FCM may be in excess of the collateral required to be posted by a portfolio to support its obligations under a similar uncleared swap. It is expected, however, that regulators will adopt rules imposing certain margin requirements, including minimums, on uncleared swaps in the near future, which could reduce the distinction.
These swap arrangements will be made primarily for hedging purposes to preserve the return on an investment or on a portion of a Fund’s portfolio. However, a Fund may, as noted above, enter into such arrangements for income purposes to the extent permitted by applicable law. In entering into a swap arrangement, a Fund is dependent upon the creditworthiness and good faith of the counterparty. A Fund will attempt to reduce the risk of nonperformance by the counterparty by dealing only with established, reputable institutions. The swap market has grown substantially in recent years with a large number of banks and investment banking firms acting both as principals and as agents utilizing standardized swap documentation and in some cases transacting in swaps that are centrally cleared and exchange-traded. As a result, the swap market has become relatively liquid. Certain swap transactions involve more recent innovations for which standardized documentation has not yet been fully developed and generally will not be centrally cleared or traded on an exchange and, accordingly, they are less liquid than traditional swap transactions.
A Fund may enter into interest rate swaps, the use of which is a highly specialized activity that involves investment techniques and risks different from those associated with ordinary portfolio securities transactions. If the Adviser  or the applicable Subadviser is incorrect in its forecasts of market values, interest rates, or other applicable factors, the investment performance of a Fund would diminish compared with what it would have been if these investment techniques were not used. Moreover, even if the Adviser  or the applicable Subadviser is correct in its forecasts, there is a risk that the swap position may correlate imperfectly with the price of the asset or liability being hedged.
Each Fund may enter into credit default swap (“CDS”) contracts for investment purposes. The Funds also may invest in credit default swap indexes, which are portfolios of credit default swaps with similar characteristics. If a Fund is a seller of a CDS contract, a Fund would be required to pay the par (or other agreed upon) value of a referenced debt obligation to the counterparty in the event of a default by a third party, such as a U.S. or foreign corporate issuer, on the debt obligation. In return, a Fund would receive from the counterparty a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract provided that no event of default has occurred. If no default occurs, a Fund would keep the stream of payments and would have no payment obligations. As the seller, a Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap. As the seller, a Fund also is not required to remain in the CDS contract until default or maturity and could terminate the contract and incur a realized gain or loss.
Each Fund also may purchase CDS contracts in order to hedge against the risk of default of debt securities it holds, in which case a Fund would function as the counterparty referenced above. This would involve the risk that the swap may expire worthless and would only generate income in the event of an actual default by the issuer of the underlying obligation (as opposed to a credit downgrade or other indication of financial instability). It also would involve credit risk; the seller may fail to satisfy its payment obligations to a Fund in the event of a default. As the buyer, a Fund is not required to remain in the CDS contract until default or maturity and could terminate the contract and incur a realized gain or loss.
The regulation of the U.S. and non-U.S. swaps markets has undergone substantial change in recent years. Although the CFTC released final rules relating to clearing, reporting, recordkeeping and registration requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act, many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to further final rule making or phase-in periods, and thus their ultimate impact remains unclear. New regulations could, among other things, restrict a Fund's ability to engage in swap transactions (for example, by making certain types of swaps no longer available to a Fund) and/or increase the costs of such swap transactions (for example, by increasing margin or capital requirements), and an Underlying Fund might be unable to fully execute its investment strategies as a result. Limits or restrictions applicable to the counterparties with which a Fund engages in swaps also could prevent a Fund from using these instruments or affect the pricing or other factors relating to these instruments, or may change the availability of certain investment.
35

Regulations adopted by the CFTC, SEC and banking regulators may require a Fund to post margin on OTC swaps, and exchanges will set minimum margin requirements for exchange-traded and cleared swaps. The prudential regulators issued final rules that will require banks subject to their supervision to exchange variation and initial margin in respect of their obligations arising under OTC swap agreements. The CFTC adopted similar rules that apply to CFTC-registered swap dealers that are not banks. Such rules generally require a Fund to segregate additional assets in order to meet the new variation and initial margin requirements when they enter into OTC swap agreements. The European Supervisory Authorities (“ESA”), various national regulators in Europe, the Australian Securities & Investment Commission, the Japanese Financial Services Agency and the Canadian Office of the Superintendent of Financial Institutions adopted rules and regulations that are similar to that of the Federal Reserve. The variation margin requirements are now effective and the initial margin requirements are being phased-in through 2022 based on average daily aggregate notional amount of covered swaps between swap dealers and swap entities. Due to these regulations, a Fund could be required to engage in greater documentation and recordkeeping with respect to swap agreements.
Separately, on December 8, 2020, the CFTC adopted regulations allowing investment advisers for registered investment companies and other institutional investors to apply a minimum transfer amount (“MTA”) of variation margin based upon the separately managed investment account or sleeve (“Sleeve”) that the adviser is responsible for, rather than having to calculate the MTA across all accounts of the investor. An investment manager must abide by the following conditions: (1) any such swaps are entered into with the swap dealer by an asset manager on behalf of a Sleeve owned by the legal entity pursuant to authority granted under an investment management agreement; (2) the swaps of such Sleeve are subject to a master netting agreement that does not permit netting of initial or variation margin obligations across Sleeves of the legal entity that have swaps outstanding with the swap dealer; and (3) the swap dealer applies an MTA no greater than $50,000 to the initial and variation margin collection and posting obligations required of such Sleeve. As of the date of this SAI, the banking regulators have not provided similar relief, although swaps dealers subject to a banking regulator are expected to act in a manner consistent with the relief provided by the CFTC.
Regulations adopted by the prudential regulators require certain banks to include in a range of financial contracts, including swap agreements, terms delaying or restricting default, termination and other rights in the event that the bank and/or its affiliates become subject to certain types of resolution or insolvency proceedings. The regulations could limit a Fund's ability to exercise a range of cross-default rights if its counterparty, or an affiliate of the counterparty, is subject to bankruptcy or similar proceedings. Such regulations could further negatively impact a Fund’s use of swaps.
Swap agreements can take many different forms and are known by a variety of names including, but not limited to, interest rate swaps, mortgage swaps, total return swaps, inflation swaps, asset swaps (where parties exchange assets, typically a debt security), currency swaps, equity swaps, credit default swaps, commodity-linked swaps, and contracts for differences. Each Fund also may write (sell) and purchase options on swaps (swaptions).
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Synthetic Instruments
Each Fund may invest in tender option bonds, bond receipts, and similar synthetic municipal instruments. A synthetic instrument is a security created by combining an intermediate or long-term municipal bond with a right to sell the instrument back to the remarketer or liquidity provider for repurchase on short notice. This right to sell is commonly referred to as a tender option. Usually, the tender option is backed by a conditional guarantee or letter of credit from a bank or other financial institution. Under its terms, the guarantee may expire if the municipality defaults on payments of interest or principal on the underlying bond, if the credit rating of the municipality is downgraded, or interest on the underlying bond ceases to be excludable from gross income for federal income tax purposes. The recent economic downturn and budgetary constraints have made municipal securities more susceptible to downgrade, default, and bankruptcy. Synthetic instruments involve structural risks that could adversely affect the value of the instrument or could result in a Fund’s holding an instrument for a longer period of time than originally anticipated. For example, because of the structure of a synthetic instrument, there is a risk that a Fund will not be able to exercise its tender option.
Tax-Exempt Securities
Each Fund may purchase tax-exempt securities, which include general obligation bonds, which are secured by the issuer’s pledge of its faith, credit, and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest; revenue bonds, which are payable from the revenue derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source, but not from the general taxing power; and certain types of industrial development bonds issued by or on behalf of public authorities to obtain funds for privately operated facilities, provided that the interest paid on such securities qualifies as exempt from federal income taxes.
36

Temporary Defensive Policy
Each Fund may, on a temporary basis because of market, economic, political, or other conditions, invest up to 100% of its assets in investment-grade, short-term debt instruments. Such securities may consist of obligations of the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, and repurchase agreements secured by such instruments; certificates of deposit of domestic banks having capital, surplus, and undivided profits in excess of $100 million; bankers' acceptances of similar banks; commercial paper; and other corporate debt obligations.
Treasury Inflation-Indexed Securities
Each Fund may invest in treasury inflation-indexed securities (also referred to as “treasury inflation-protected securities” or “TIPS”), which are U.S. Treasury securities that have been designed to provide a real rate of return after being adjusted over time to reflect the impact of inflation. Their principal value periodically adjusts to take into account the rate of inflation. They trade at prevailing real, or after inflation, interest rates. The U.S. Treasury guarantees repayment of at least the face value of these securities in the event of sustained deflation or a drop in prices.
While these securities are expected to be protected from long-term inflationary trends, short-term increases in inflation may lead to a decline in value. If interest rates rise due to reasons other than inflation (for example, due to changes in currency exchange rates), investors in these securities may not be protected to the extent that the increase is not reflected in the bond’s inflation measure. If inflation is lower than expected while a Fund holds TIPS, the Fund may earn less on the TIPS than it would on conventional Treasury bonds.
U.S. Government Obligations
Each Fund may invest in various types of U.S. government obligations. U.S. government obligations include securities issued or guaranteed as to principal and interest by the U.S. government and supported by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Treasury. U.S. government obligations differ mainly in the length of their maturity. Treasury bills, the most frequently issued marketable government securities, have a maturity of up to one year and are issued on a discount basis. Treasury Notes have maturities of two, three, five, seven, or 10 years, and pay interest semi-annually. Treasury Bonds are issued with a 20- or 30-year term and pay interest semi-annually. U.S. government obligations also include securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies or instrumentalities, including government-sponsored enterprises (“GSEs”). Some obligations of such agencies or instrumentalities of the U.S. government are supported by the full faith and credit of the United States or U.S. Treasury guarantees. Others are supported by the right of the issuer or guarantor to borrow from the U.S. Treasury. Others are supported by the discretionary authority of the U.S. government to purchase certain obligations of the agency or instrumentality or only by the credit of the agency or instrumentality issuing the obligation.
In the case of obligations not backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, the investor must look principally to the agency or instrumentality issuing or guaranteeing the obligation for ultimate repayment, which agency or instrumentality may be privately owned. There can be no assurance that the U.S. government would provide financial support to its agencies or instrumentalities (including GSEs) where it is not obligated to do so. In addition, U.S. government obligations are subject to fluctuations in market value due to fluctuations in market interest rates. As a general matter, the value of debt instruments, including U.S. government obligations, declines when market interest rates increase and rises when market interest rates decrease. Certain types of U.S. government obligations are subject to fluctuations in yield or value due to their structure or contract terms.
Variable-Rate and Floating-Rate Securities
Each Fund may invest in variable-rate and floating-rate securities, which bear interest at rates that are adjusted periodically to market rates. These interest rate adjustments can both raise and lower the income generated by such securities. These changes will have the same effect on the income earned by a Fund depending on the proportion of such securities held. Because the interest rates of variable-rate and floating-rate securities are periodically adjusted to reflect current market rates, the market value of the variable-rate and floating-rate securities is less affected by changes in prevailing interest rates than the market value of securities with fixed interest rates. The market value of variable-rate and floating-rate securities usually tends toward par (100% of face value) at interest rate adjustment time.
Similar to fixed-rate debt instruments, variable- and floating-rate instruments are subject to changes in value based on changes in market interest rates or changes in the issuer’s creditworthiness. In addition, variable- and floating-rate securities are subject to the risk of loss of principal and income. Although borrowers frequently provide collateral to secure repayment of these obligations they do not always do so and these securities may be unsecured. If borrowers do provide collateral, the value of the collateral may not completely cover the borrower’s obligations at the time of a default. If a borrower files for protection from its creditors under bankruptcy laws, these laws may limit a Fund’s rights to its collateral. In the event of a bankruptcy, the holder of a variable- or floating-rate loan may not recover its principal, may experience a long delay in recovering its investment, and may not receive interest during the delay.
37

Variable-Rate Demand Notes (“VRDNs”)
Each Fund may invest in VRDNs, which are securities that provide the right to sell the security at face value on either that day or within a rate-reset period. The interest rate is adjusted at a stipulated daily, weekly, monthly, quarterly, or other specified time interval to a rate that reflects current market conditions. The effective maturity for these instruments is deemed to be less than 397 days in accordance with detailed SEC regulatory requirements. These interest rate adjustments can both raise and lower the income generated by such securities. These changes will have the same effect on the income earned by a Fund depending on the proportion of such securities held. VRDNs are tax-exempt securities.
Warrants
To the extent that such investments are consistent with its investment objective, each Fund may invest in warrants. However, with respect to the Victory 500 Index Fund and the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, each Fund may invest up to 5% of its net assets in warrants. Warrants represent rights to purchase securities at a specific price valid for a specific period of time. The prices of warrants do not necessarily correlate with the prices of the underlying securities. Each Fund may only purchase warrants on securities in which the Fund may invest directly.
When-Issued and Delayed-Delivery Securities
Each Fund may invest in debt securities offered on a when-issued or delayed-delivery basis or for delayed draws on loans; that is, delivery of and payment for the securities take place after the date of the commitment to purchase, normally within 35 days. Securities that require more than 35 days to settle are considered a senior security and subject to Rule 18f-4. The payment obligation and the interest rate that will be received on the securities are each fixed at the time the buyer enters into the commitment. A Fund receives a commitment fee for delayed draws on loans. A Fund may sell these securities before the settlement date.
Debt securities purchased on a when-issued or delayed-delivery basis are subject to changes in value in the same way as other debt securities held in the Fund's portfolios; that is, both generally experience appreciation when interest rates decline and depreciation when interest rates rise. The value of such securities also will be affected by the public’s perception of the creditworthiness of the issuer and anticipated changes in the level of interest rates. Purchasing securities on a when-issued or delayed-delivery basis involves a risk that the yields available in the market when the delivery takes place may actually be higher than those obtained in the transaction itself.
On the settlement date of the when-issued or delayed-delivery securities or for delayed draws on loans, a Fund will meet its obligations from then-available cash, sale of other securities, or from sale of the when-issued or delayed-delivery securities themselves (which may have a value greater or less than the Fund’s payment obligations). The availability of liquid assets for this purpose to honor requests for redemption, and otherwise to manage its investment portfolio will limit the extent to which the Fund may purchase when-issued and delayed delivery securities. A Fund may realize a capital gain or loss in connection with such transactions.
For more information about these practices, see the “Derivatives” section.
Zero Coupon Bonds
Each Fund may invest in zero coupon bonds. A zero coupon bond is a security that is sold at a discount from its face value (original issue discount), makes no periodic interest payments, and is redeemed at face value when it matures. The lump sum payment at maturity increases the price volatility of the zero coupon bond in response to changes in interest rates when compared to a bond that distributes a semiannual coupon payment. In calculating its income, a Fund accrues the daily amortization of the original issue discount.
The following is provided as additional information with respect to the Victory Extended Market Index Fund, the Victory 500 Index Fund, and the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund.
Index Futures Contracts
Futures contracts are contracts to purchase or sell a fixed amount of an underlying instrument, commodity, or index at a fixed time and place in the future. U.S. futures contracts have been designed by exchanges that have been designated “contracts markets” by the CFTC, and must be executed through a futures commission merchant, or brokerage firm, which is a member of the relevant contract market. Futures contracts trade on a number of exchanges and clear through their clearing corporations. Each Fund may enter into contracts for the purchase or sale for future delivery of their Index.
At the same time a futures contract on the Index is entered into, a Fund must allocate cash or securities as a deposit payment (initial margin). Daily thereafter, the futures contract is valued and the payment of “variation margin” may be required, since each day the Fund would provide or receive cash that reflects any decline or increase in the contract’s value.
Although futures contracts (other than those that settle in cash) by their terms call for the actual delivery or acquisition of the instrument underlying the contract, in most cases the contractual obligation is fulfilled by offset before the date of the contract without having to
38

make or take delivery of the instrument underlying the contract. The offsetting of a contractual obligation is accomplished by entering into an opposite position in the identical futures contract on a commodities exchange on which the futures contract was entered into (or a linked exchange). Such a transaction, which is effected through a member of an exchange, cancels the obligation to make or take delivery of the instrument underlying the contract. Since all transactions in the futures market are made, offset, or fulfilled through a clearinghouse associated with the exchange on which the contracts are traded, a Fund will incur brokerage fees when it purchases or sells futures contracts.
The ordinary spreads between prices in the cash and futures market, due to differences in the nature of those markets, are subject to distortions. First, all participants in the futures market are subject to initial deposit and variation margin requirements. Rather than meeting additional variation margin requirements, investors may close futures contracts through offsetting transactions which could distort the normal relationship between the cash and futures markets. Second, the liquidity of the futures market depends on most participants entering into offsetting transactions rather than making or taking delivery. To the extent that many participants decide to make or take delivery, liquidity in the futures market could be reduced, thus producing distortion. Third, from the point of view of speculators, the margin deposit requirements in the futures market are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities market. Therefore, increased participation by speculators in the futures market may cause temporary price distortions. Due to the possibility of distortion, a correct forecast of securities price trends may still not result in a successful transaction.
In addition, futures contracts entail risks. Investments in futures contracts may cause a Fund to realize gains and losses for federal income tax purposes that would not otherwise be realized if the Fund invested directly in the underlying securities. As a result, this investment technique may accelerate the timing of taxable distributions.
Options on Index Futures Contracts
Each Fund may purchase and write options on futures contracts with respect to their Indexes. The purchase of a call option on an index futures contract is similar in some respects to the purchase of a call option on such an index. For example, when a Fund is not fully invested it may purchase a call option on an index futures contract to hedge against a market advance.
The writing of a call option on a futures contract with respect to an Index may constitute a partial offset against declining prices of the underlying securities that are deliverable upon exercise of the futures contract. If the futures price at expiration of the option is below the exercise price, a Fund will retain the full amount of the option premium that provides a partial offset against any decline which may have occurred in the Fund’s holdings. The writing of a put option on an index futures contract may constitute a partial offset against increasing prices of the underlying securities that are deliverable upon exercise of the futures contract. If the futures price at expiration of the option is higher than the exercise price, a Fund will retain the full amount of the option premium, which provides a partial offset against any increase in the price of securities that the Fund intends to purchase. If a put or call option a Fund has written is exercised, the Fund will incur a loss that will be reduced by the amount of the premium it receives. Depending on the degree of correlation between changes in the value of its portfolio securities and changes in the value of its futures positions, a Fund’s losses from existing options on futures may to some extent be reduced or increased by changes in the value of portfolio securities.
The purchase of a put option on a futures contract with respect to an Index is similar in some respects to the purchase of protective put options on the Index. For example, a Fund may purchase a put option on an index futures contract to hedge against the risk of lowering securities values.
The amount of risk a Fund assumes when it purchases an option on a futures contract with respect to an Index is the premium paid for the option plus related transaction costs. In addition to the correlation risks discussed above, the purchase of such an option also entails the risk that changes in the value of the underlying futures contract will not be fully reflected in the value of the option purchased. The amount of risk the Fund assumes when it writes an option on a futures contract with respect to an Index is theoretically unlimited, but it is reduced by the amount of the premium received for the option less related transaction costs.
Options on Securities Indexes
Each Fund may write (“sell”) covered call and put options to a limited extent on its Index (“covered options”) in an attempt to increase income. Such options give the holder the right to receive a cash settlement during the term of the option based upon the difference between the exercise price and the value of the Index. The Fund may forgo the benefits of appreciation on the Index or may pay more than the market price of the Index pursuant to call and put options written by the Fund.
By writing a covered call option, a Fund forgoes, in exchange for the premium less the commission (“net premium”), the opportunity to profit during the option period from an increase in the market value of the Index above the exercise price. By writing a covered put option, the Fund, in exchange for the net premium received, accepts the risk of a decline in the market value of the Index below the exercise price.
Each Fund may terminate its obligation as the writer of a call or put option by purchasing an option with the same exercise price and expiration date as the option previously written.
39

When a Fund writes an option, an amount equal to the net premium received by the Fund is included in the liability section of the Fund’s Statement of Assets and Liabilities as a deferred credit. The amount of the deferred credit will be subsequently marked to market to reflect the current market value of the option written. The current market value of a traded option is the last sale price or, in the absence of a sale, the mean between the closing bid and ask prices. If an option expires on its stipulated expiration date or if a Fund enters into a closing purchase transaction, the Fund will realize a gain (or loss if the cost of a closing purchase transaction exceeds the premium received when the option was sold), and the deferred credit related to such option will be eliminated. If a call option is exercised, a Fund will realize a gain or loss from the sale of the underlying security and the proceeds of the sale will be increased by the premium originally received. The writing of covered call options may be deemed to involve the pledge of the securities against which the option is being written. Securities against which call options are written will be segregated on the books of the custodian for a Fund.
Each Fund may purchase call and put options on its Index. A Fund would normally purchase a call option in anticipation of an increase in the market value of the Index. The purchase of a call option would entitle a Fund, in exchange for the premium paid, to purchase the underlying securities at a specified price during the option period. A Fund would ordinarily have a gain if the value of the securities increased above the exercise price sufficiently to cover the premium and would have a loss if the value of the securities remained at or below the exercise price during the option period.
A Fund would normally purchase put options in anticipation of a decline in the market value of its Index (protective puts). The purchase of a put option would entitle a Fund, in exchange for the premium paid, to sell, the underlying securities at a specified price during the option period. The purchase of protective puts is designed merely to offset or hedge against a decline in the market value of the Index. A Fund would ordinarily recognize a gain if the value of the Index decreased below the exercise price sufficiently to cover the premium and would recognize a loss if the value of the Index remained at or above the exercise price. Gains and losses on the purchase of protective put options would tend to be offset by countervailing changes in the value of the Index.
Each Fund has adopted certain other non-fundamental policies concerning index option transactions which are discussed below. Each Fund’s activities in index options also may be restricted by the requirements of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, for qualification as a regulated investment company.
The hours of trading for options on an Index may not conform to the hours during which the underlying securities are traded. To the extent that the option markets close before the markets for the underlying securities, significant price and rate movements can take place in the underlying securities markets that cannot be reflected in the option markets. It is impossible to predict the volume of trading that may exist in such options, and there can be no assurance that viable exchange markets will develop or continue.
Because options on securities indexes require settlement in cash, a Fund may be forced to liquidate portfolio securities to meet settlement obligations.
Obligations of Foreign Governments, Banks, and Corporations
Each Fund may invest in U.S. dollar-denominated short-term obligations issued or guaranteed by one or more foreign governments or any of their political subdivisions, agencies or instrumentalities that are determined by its Manager to be of comparable quality to the other obligations in which that Fund may invest. To the extent that such investments are consistent with its investment objective, each Fund also may invest in debt obligations of supranational entities. Supranational entities include international organizations designated or supported by governmental entities to promote economic reconstruction or development and international banking institutions and related government agencies. Examples include the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (the “World Bank”), the European Coal and Steel Community, the Asian Development Bank, and the InterAmerican Development Bank. The percentage of a Fund’s assets invested in obligations of foreign governments and supranational entities will vary depending on the relative yields of such securities, the economic and financial markets of the countries in which the investments are made, and the interest rate climate of such countries. Each Fund also may invest a portion of its total assets in high-quality, short-term (one year or less) debt obligations of foreign branches of U.S. banks or U.S. branches of foreign banks that are denominated in and pay interest in U.S. dollars.
Security Substitution
At times when a corporate action involving a constituent is pending, an arbitrage opportunity may exist. For example, if a constituent is acquiring another company (which may or may not be an index constituent) for stock, the target company may be trading at a discount to the acquiring company, given the conditions of the deal and the market. In this case, value may be added to a Fund by purchasing the target company stock in anticipation of the acquisition and corresponding exchange of the target company stock for the acquiring company stock. A Fund would effectively increase in weighting of the acquiring company in line with the holding’s increased weighting in the index at a price lower than that of the acquiring company’s stock.
40

The following is provided as additional information with respect to the Victory Extended Market Index Fund.
Strategies Involving Options, Futures, Swaps, Indexed Instruments, and Foreign Exchange Transactions
The Fund also may invest in derivative instruments that it believes may serve as substitutes for individual securities in an attempt to broadly represent a particular market, market segment or index, as the case may be. The derivative instruments in which the Fund may invest include the purchase and writing of options on securities indices and the writing of covered call options on stocks or derivative instruments correlated with an index or components of the index rather than securities represented in that index. The Fund will normally invest a substantial portion of its assets in options and futures contracts correlated with an index representing the Fund’s particular market segment or index. The Fund also may utilize options on futures, swaps and other indexed instruments, and convertible bonds. Derivatives may be employed as a proxy for a direct investment in securities underlying the index.
Options, futures, and other derivative instruments also may be employed to gain market exposure quickly in the event of subscriptions in order to provide liquidity, to invest uncommitted cash balances, and for bona fide hedging purposes. The Fund also may use derivatives in connection with the investment strategy that seeks to profit from differences in price when the same (or similar) security, currency, or commodity is traded in two or more markets.
The Adviser will choose among the foregoing instruments based on its judgment of how best to meet the Fund’s goal. In connection therewith, the Adviser will assess such factors as current and anticipated securities prices, relative liquidity and price levels in the options, futures and swap markets compared to the securities markets, and the Fund’s cash flow and cash management needs.
Indexed Securities
The Fund may invest in securities the potential return of which is based on an index. As an illustration, the Fund may invest in a debt security that pays interest based on the current value of an interest rate index, such as the prime rate. Indexed securities involve credit risk, and certain indexed securities may involve leverage risk and liquidity risk. The Fund will invest in indexed securities for bona fide hedging. When used for anticipatory hedging purposes, indexed securities involve correlation risk.
Options on Securities and Securities Indices
Put Options
The Fund is authorized to purchase put options to seek to hedge against a decline in the value of its securities or to enhance its return. By buying a put option, the Fund acquires a right to sell such underlying securities or instruments at the exercise price, thus limiting the Fund’s risk of loss through a decline in the market value of the securities or instruments until the put option expires. The amount of any appreciation in the value of the underlying securities or instruments will be partially offset by the amount of the premium paid for the put option and any related transaction costs. Prior to its expiration, a put option may be sold in a closing sale transaction and profit or loss from the sale will depend on whether the amount received is more or less than the premium paid for the put option plus the related transaction costs. A closing sale transaction cancels out the Fund’s position as the purchaser of an option by means of an offsetting sale of an identical option prior to the expiration of the option it has purchased. The Fund also may purchase uncovered put options.
The Fund also has authority to write (i.e., sell) put options on the types of securities or instruments that may be held by the Fund, provided that such put options are covered, meaning that such options are secured by segregated, liquid instruments. The Fund will receive a premium for writing a put option, which increases the Fund’s return. The Fund will not sell puts if, as a result, more than 50% of the Fund’s assets would be required to cover its potential obligations under its hedging and other investment transactions. The Fund is also authorized to write (i.e., sell) uncovered put options on securities or instruments in which it may invest but for which it does not currently have a corresponding short position or has not deposited cash equal to the exercise value of the put option with the broker dealer through which it made the uncovered put option as collateral. The principal reason for writing uncovered put options is to receive premium income, even though in exchange the Fund may be required to acquire such securities or instruments at a net price above their current market value. The Fund has the obligation to buy the securities or instruments at an agreed upon price if the price of the securities or instruments decreases below the exercise price. If the price of the securities or instruments increases during the option period, the option will expire worthless and the Fund will retain the premium and will not have to purchase the securities or instruments at the exercise price.
Additional Options on Securities Indices
Call Options
The Fund may purchase call options on any of the types of securities or instruments in which it may invest. A purchased call option gives a portfolio the right to buy, and obligates the seller to sell, the underlying security at the exercise price at any time during the option period. The Fund also may purchase and sell call options on indexes. Index options are similar to options on securities except
41

that, rather than taking or making delivery of securities underlying the option at a specified price upon exercise, an index option gives the holder the right to receive cash upon exercise of the option if the level of the index upon which the option is based is greater than the exercise price of the option.
The Fund also is authorized to write (i.e., sell) covered call options on the securities or instruments in which it may invest and to enter into closing purchase transactions with respect to certain of such options. A covered call option is an option in which the Fund, in return for a premium, gives another party a right to buy specified securities owned by the Fund at a specified future date and price set at the time of the contract. The principal reason for writing call options is the attempt to realize, through the receipt of premiums, a greater return than would be realized on the securities alone. By writing covered call options, the Fund gives up the opportunity, while the option is in effect, to profit from any price increase in the underlying security above the option exercise price. In addition, the Fund’s ability to sell the underlying security will be limited while the option is in effect unless the Fund enters into a closing purchase transaction. A closing purchase transaction cancels out the Fund’s position as the writer of an option by means of an offsetting purchase of an identical option prior to the expiration of the option it has written. Covered call options also serve as a partial offset to the extent of the premium received against the price of the underlying security declining.
The Fund also is authorized to write (i.e., sell) uncovered call options on securities or instruments in which it may invest but that are not currently held by the Fund. The principal reason for writing uncovered call options is to realize income without committing capital to the ownership of the underlying securities or instruments. When writing uncovered call options, the Fund must deposit and maintain sufficient margin with the broker dealer through which it wrote the uncovered call option as collateral to ensure that the securities can be purchased for delivery if and when the option is exercised. During periods of declining securities prices or when prices are stable, writing uncovered calls can be a profitable strategy to increase the Fund’s income with minimal capital risk. Uncovered calls are riskier than covered calls because there is no underlying security held by the Fund that can act as a partial hedge. Uncovered calls have speculative characteristics and the potential for loss is unlimited. When an uncovered call is exercised, the Fund must purchase the underlying security to meet its call obligation. There is also a risk, especially with less liquid preferred and debt securities, that the securities may not be available for purchase. If the purchase price exceeds the exercise price, the Fund will lose the difference.
Types of Options
The Fund may engage in transactions in options on individual securities, baskets of securities or securities indices, or particular measurements of value or rate (an index), such as an index of the price of treasury securities or an index representative of short-term interest rates. Such investments may be made on exchanges and in the OTC markets. In general, exchange-traded options have standardized exercise prices and expiration dates and require the parties to post margin against their obligations, and the performance of the parties’ obligations in connection with such options is guaranteed by the exchange or a related clearing corporation. OTC options have more flexible terms negotiated between the buyer and seller, but generally do not require the parties to post margin and are subject to greater credit risk. OTC options also involve greater liquidity risk.
Futures
The Fund may engage in transactions in futures and options thereon. Futures are standardized, exchange-traded contracts which obligate a purchaser to take delivery, and a seller to make delivery, of a specific amount of an asset at a specified future date at a specified price. No price is paid upon entering into a futures contract. Rather, upon purchasing or selling a futures contract, the Fund is required to deposit collateral (margin) equal to a percentage (generally less than 10%) of the contract value. Each day thereafter until the futures position is closed, the Fund will pay additional margin representing any loss experienced as a result of the futures position the prior day or be entitled to a payment representing any profit experienced as a result of the futures position the prior day. Futures involve substantial leverage risk.
The sale of a futures contract limits the Fund’s risk of loss through a decline in the market value of portfolio holdings correlated with the futures contract prior to the futures contract’s expiration date. In the event the market value of the portfolio holdings correlated with the futures contract increases rather than decreases, however, the Fund will realize a loss on the futures position and a lower return on the portfolio holdings than would have been realized without the purchase of the futures contract.
The purchase of a futures contract may protect the Fund from having to pay more for securities as a consequence of increases in the market value for such securities during a period when the Fund was attempting to identify specific securities in which to invest.
In the event that such securities decline in value or the Fund determines not to complete a bona fide hedge transaction relating to a futures contract, however, the Fund may realize a loss relating to the futures position.
The Fund also is authorized to purchase or sell call and put options on futures contracts including financial futures and stock indices in connection with its hedging activities. Generally, these strategies would be used under the same market and market sector conditions (i.e., conditions relating to specific types of investments) in which the Fund would enter into futures transactions. The Fund may purchase put options or write call options on futures contracts and stock indices in lieu of selling the underlying futures contract in
42

anticipation of a decrease in the market value of its securities. Similarly, the Fund can purchase call options, or write put options on futures contracts and stock indices, as a substitute for the purchase of such futures to hedge against the increased cost resulting from an increase in the market value of securities which the Fund intends to purchase.
Effective December 31, 2012, the CFTC adopted certain regulatory changes that subject registered investment companies and advisers to registered investment companies to regulation by the CFTC if a fund invests more than a prescribed level of its liquidation value in CFTC-regulated futures, options, and swaps (“CFTC Derivatives”), or if the fund markets itself as providing investment exposure to such instruments. To the extent the Fund uses CFTC Derivatives, it intends to do so below such prescribed levels. The Fund will not market itself as a “commodity pool” or a vehicle for trading such instruments.
However, the Fund may have investments in “underlying funds” (and such underlying funds themselves may invest in underlying funds) not advised by the Adviser (which for purposes of the no-action letter referenced below may include certain securitized vehicles and/or mortgage real estate investment trusts (“REITS”) that may invest in CFTC Derivatives). The Adviser has no transparency into the holdings of these underlying funds because they are not advised by the Adviser. To address this issue of lack of transparency, the CFTC staff issued a no-action letter on November 29, 2012, permitting the adviser of a fund that invests in such underlying funds and that would otherwise have filed a claim of exclusion pursuant to Rule 4.5, to delay registration as a “commodity pool operator” until six months from the date on which the CFTC issues additional guidance on the treatment of CFTC Derivatives held by underlying funds. The Adviser has filed a claim with the CFTC to rely on this no-action relief with respect to the Fund.
Swap Agreements
The Fund is authorized to enter into equity swap agreements, which are OTC contracts in which one party agrees to make periodic payments based on the change in market value of a specified equity security, basket of equity securities or equity index in return for periodic payments based on a fixed or variable interest rate or the change in market value of a different equity security, basket of equity securities or equity index. Swap agreements may be used to obtain exposure to an equity or market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in circumstances in which direct investment is restricted by local law or is otherwise impractical.
The Fund will enter into an equity swap transaction only if, immediately following the time it enters into the transaction, the aggregate notional principal amount of equity swap transactions to which the Fund is a party would not exceed 5% of its net assets. Whether the Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend on the Adviser’s ability to correctly predict whether certain types of investments are likely to produce greater returns than other investments. Because they are two-party contracts and because they may have terms of greater than seven days, swap agreements may be considered to be illiquid. Moreover, the Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The Fund will seek to lessen the risk to some extent by entering into a transaction only if the counterparty meets the current credit requirement for OTC option counterparties. Swap agreements also bear the risk that the Fund will not be able to meet its payment obligations to the counterparty. The Fund, however, will segregate liquid securities, cash or cash equivalents, or other assets permitted to be so segregated by the Commission in an amount equal to or greater than the market value of the Fund’s liabilities under the swap agreement or the amount it would cost the Fund initially to make an equivalent direct investment, plus or minus any amount the Fund is obligated to pay or is to receive under the swap agreement. Restrictions imposed by the tax rules applicable to regulated investment companies, may limit the Fund’s ability to use swap agreements. The swaps market is largely unregulated. It is possible that development in the swap market, including potential government regulation, could adversely affect the Fund’s ability to terminate existing swap agreements or to realize amounts to be received under such agreements.
Risk Factors in Derivatives
The Fund may use instruments referred to as derivatives. Derivatives are financial instruments the value of which is derived from another security, a commodity (such as gold or oil), or an index (a measure of value or rates, such as the S&P 500 Index or the prime lending rate). Derivatives allow the Fund to increase or decrease the level of risk to which the Fund is exposed more quickly and efficiently than transactions in other types of instruments.
Derivatives are volatile and involve significant risks, including:
Credit risk -- the risk that the counterparty on a derivative transaction will be unable to honor its financial obligation to the Fund, or the risk that the reference entity in a credit default swap or similar derivative will not be able to honor its financial obligations.
Currency risk -- the risk that changes in the exchange rate between two currencies will adversely affect the value (in U.S. dollar terms) of an investment.
Leverage risk -- the risk associated with certain types of investments or trading strategies (for example, borrowing money to increase the amount of investments) that relatively small market movements may result in large changes in the value of an investment. Certain investments or trading strategies that involve leverage can result in losses that greatly exceed the amount originally invested.
43

Liquidity risk -- the risk that certain securities may be difficult or impossible to sell at the time that the seller would like or at the price that the seller believes the security is currently worth.
Correlation risk -- the risk that changes in the value of a derivative will not match the changes in the Fund’s portfolio holdings that are being hedged or of the particular market or security to which the Fund seeks exposure.
The Fund intends to enter into transactions involving derivatives only if there appears to be a liquid secondary market for such investments or, in the case of illiquid instruments traded in OTC transactions, such instruments satisfy the criteria set forth below under “Additional Risk Factors of OTC Transactions; Limitations on the Use of OTC Derivatives.” However, there can be no assurance that, at any specific time, either a liquid secondary market will exist for a derivative or the Fund will otherwise be able to sell such instrument at an acceptable price. It may therefore not be possible to close a position in a derivative without incurring substantial losses, if at all.
Certain transactions in derivatives (such as futures transactions or sales of put options) involve substantial leverage risk and may expose the Fund to potential losses which may exceed the amount originally invested by the Fund.
Additional Risk Factors of OTC Transactions; Limitations on the Use of OTC Derivatives
Certain derivatives traded in OTC markets, including indexed securities, swaps, and OTC options, involve substantial liquidity risk. The absence of liquidity may make it difficult or impossible for the Fund to sell such instruments promptly at an acceptable price. The absence of liquidity also may make it more difficult for the Fund to ascertain a market value for such instruments. The Fund will, therefore, acquire illiquid OTC instruments (i) if the agreement pursuant to which the instrument is purchased contains a formula price at which the instrument may be terminated or sold, or (ii) for which the Adviser anticipates the Fund can receive on each business day at least two independent bids or offers, unless a quotation from only one dealer is available, in which case that dealer’s quotation may be used.
Because derivatives traded in OTC markets are not guaranteed by an exchange or clearing corporation and generally do not require payment of margin, to the extent that the Fund has unrealized gains in such instruments or has deposited collateral with its counterparty, the Fund is at risk that its counterparty will become bankrupt or otherwise fail to honor its obligations. The Fund will attempt to minimize the risk that a counterparty will become bankrupt or otherwise fail to honor its obligations by engaging in transactions in derivatives traded in OTC markets only with financial institutions which have substantial capital or which have provided the Fund with a third-party guaranty or other credit enhancement.
Additional Limitations on the Use of Derivatives
The Fund may not use any derivative to gain exposure to an asset or class of assets that it would be prohibited by its investment restrictions from purchasing directly.
Merger Transaction Risk
The Fund may buy stock of the target company in an announced merger transaction prior to the consummation of such transaction.
In that circumstance, the Fund would expect to receive an amount (whether in cash, stock of the acquiring company or a combination of both) in excess of the purchase price paid by the Fund for the target company’s stock. However, the Fund is subject to the risk that the merger transaction may be canceled, delayed, or restructured in which case the Fund holding of the target company’s stock may not result in any profit for the Fund and may lose significant value.
Investment Restrictions
The following investment restrictions have been adopted by the Trust for each Fund. These restrictions may not be changed without approval by the lesser of (1) 67% or more of the voting securities present at a meeting of a Fund if more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund are present or represented by proxy or (2) more than 50% of that Fund’s outstanding voting securities. The investment restrictions of one Fund may thus be changed without affecting those of any other Fund.
Each Fund:
(1)may not borrow money, except to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder and any applicable relief.
(2)may not (except for the Victory Extended Market Index Fund and the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund)  purchase the securities of any issuer (other than securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government or any of its agencies or instrumentalities) if, as a result, more than 25% of the Fund’s total assets would be invested in the securities of companies whose principal business activities are in the same industry. The Victory Extended Market Index Fund and the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index
44

Fund each will concentrate to approximately the same extent that its underlying index concentrates in the stocks of a particular industry or group of industries.
(3)may not issue senior securities, except as permitted under the 1940 Act.
(4)may not underwrite securities of other issuers, except to the extent that it may be deemed to act as a statutory underwriter in the distribution of any restricted securities or not readily marketable securities.
(5)may make loans only as permitted under the 1940 Act, the rules and regulations thereunder, and any applicable exemptive relief.
(6)may not purchase or sell commodities or commodity contracts unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments issued by persons that purchase or sell commodities or commodities contracts; but this shall not prevent the Fund from purchasing, selling, and entering into financial futures contracts (including futures contracts on indices of securities, interest rates, and currencies), options on financial futures contracts (including futures contracts on indices of securities, interest rates, and currencies), warrants, swaps, forward contracts, foreign currency spot and forward contracts, or other derivative instruments that are not related to physical commodities.
(7)may not purchase or sell real estate unless acquired as a result of ownership of securities or other instruments, except that each Fund may invest in securities or other instruments backed by real estate or securities of companies that deal in real estate or are engaged in the real estate business.
In addition, with respect to the Victory Money Market Fund, banks are not considered a single industry for purposes of investment restriction (2), and certificates of deposit, time deposits, bankers' acceptances, and other similar money market instruments issued by domestic banks may be excluded from the industry concentration limits set forth in that restriction.
With respect to each Funds' concentration policy described above, the Fund applies that restriction to investments in a particular industry or group of industries. In addition, the Adviser and Subadvisers may determine an “industry” by using various recognized industry classification services including, but not limited to industry classifications established by S&P, Bloomberg L.P., and Frank Russell Company, with certain modifications. The Adviser and Subadvisers also may include additional industries as separate classifications, to the extent applicable. Because the Adviser has determined that certain categories within, or in addition to, those set forth by S&P have unique investment characteristics, additional industries may be included as industry classifications. The Adviser classifies municipal obligations by projects with similar characteristics, such as toll road revenue bonds, housing revenue bonds, or higher education revenue bonds.
Additional Restrictions
Each of the following funds has an investment policy that requires it to invest normally at least 80% of its assets in the type of security suggested by its name:
• Victory Income Stock Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in common stocks, with at least 65% of the Fund’s assets normally invested in common stocks of companies that pay dividends;
• Victory Short-Term Bond Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in a broad range of debt securities that will maintain a dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity of three years or less;
• Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in a broad range of debt securities that will maintain a dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity between three to 10 years;
• Victory Science & Technology Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in equity securities of companies expected to benefit from the development and use of scientific and technological advances and improvements;
• Victory Small Cap Stock Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in equity securities of companies with small market capitalizations;
• Victory Extended Market Index Fund invests, under normal circumstances, at least 80% of its assets in securities or other financial instruments that are components of or have economic characteristics similar to the securities included in the Victory Extended Market Index;
• Victory 500 Index Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in the common stocks of companies composing the Victory US Large Cap 500 Index;
45

• Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund invests at least 80% of its assets in the common stocks of companies composing the Nasdaq-100 Index1;
• Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund invests normally at least 80% of its assets in investment-grade debt securities that have a dollar-weighted average portfolio maturity of 18 months or less.
To the extent required by SEC rules, each such policy may be changed only upon at least 60 days’ written notice to the applicable Fund’s shareholders.
1
Nasdaq-100®, and Nasdaq® are trade or service marks of The Nasdaq Stock Market, Inc. (which with its affiliates are the Corporations) and have been licensed for use by the Nasdaq-100 Index Fund (the “Product”). The Product is not sponsored, sold or promoted by the Corporations and the Corporations make no representation about the advisability of investing in them. THE CORPORATIONS MAKE NO WARRANTIES AND BEAR NO LIABILITY WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCT.
VICTORY US LARGE CAP 500 INDEX
Index and Index Provider
The Victory US Large Cap 500 Index (the “Victory 500 Index”) is an unmanaged, market-cap weighted index that consists of the largest 500 companies within the VettaFi US Equity 3000 IndexSM (“Parent Index”). The Parent Index measures the performance of the largest 3000 U.S. equity securities with readily available price data. The Victory 500 Index was created by Victory Capital in conjunction with VettaFi, unaffiliated third-party, and it is currently administered, calculated, and published by VettaFi. VettaFi calculates and disseminates the Victory 500 Index on a daily basis. A description of the Victory 500 Index Fund’s (the “500 Fund”) use of the Victory 500 Index is included in that Fund’s Prospectus under “Principal Investment Strategies,” and additional details about the Victory 500 Index are provided below.
The Victory 500 Index’s performance prior to the first publish date has been back-tested applying the same methodology based on fundamental criteria that was in effect when the Victory 500 Index was first published and is considered hypothetical. The Victory 500 Index is not sponsored by VettaFi or its affiliates.
Rebalancing
The Victory 500 Index is reconstituted semi-annually and rebalanced quarterly. In conjunction with rebalancing, the Victory 500 Index’s rules are applied to its universe of publicly traded securities in order to determine which securities are eligible for inclusion in the Victory 500 Index. New securities are added to the Victory 500 Index only on the rebalancing dates and only securities that comply with the Victory 500 Index’s methodology are eligible to be included in the Victory 500 Index. Securities that no longer meet eligibility for the Victory 500 Index upon rebalancing are omitted.
Maintenance
VettaFi maintains the Victory 500 Index throughout the year, which includes monitoring and adjustments for company additions and deletions, stock splits, corporate restructurings, and other corporate actions. Corporate actions are generally implemented after the close of trading on the day prior to the ex-date of such corporate actions. A security also may be removed from the Victory 500 Index in between rebalancing if it no longer represents an investable asset due to legal constraints or other independent factors.
Warranty; Errors
Neither Victory Capital nor the 500 Fund make any representation or warranty, express or implied, including without limitation to the 500 Fund’s shareholders or any member of the public regarding the advisability of investing in securities generally or in the 500 Fund particularly or the ability of the Victory 500 Index to track general stock market performance. The 500 Fund does not pay a fee to Victory Capital for creating and providing the Victory 500 Index, but the Fund pays a fee to VettaFi for its services. VettaFi has no obligation to take the needs of the 500 Fund’s shareholders into consideration in determining, composing, or calculating the Victory 500 Index.
Neither Victory Capital nor the 500 Fund guarantees the accuracy, completeness, or performance of the Victory 500 Index or the data included therein and shall have no liability in connection with the Victory 500 Index or its calculation, including any errors or omissions in calculating the Victory 500 Index. Errors with respect to the quality, accuracy, and completeness of the data within the Victory 500 Index may occur from time to time and may not be identified and corrected for a period of time, if at all. Any gains, losses, or costs to the 500 Fund as a result of errors in the Index will be borne by the 500 Fund.
46

Portfolio Transactions and Brokerage Commissions
Subject to the general supervision of the Board, the Adviser is responsible for making decisions with respect to the purchase and sale of portfolio securities on behalf of the Funds. The Adviser is also responsible for the implementation of those decisions, including the selection of broker/dealers to effect portfolio transactions, the negotiation of commissions, and the allocation of principal business and portfolio brokerage.
Transactions on stock exchanges involve the payment of brokerage commissions. In transactions on stock exchanges in the United States, these commissions are negotiated. Traditionally, commission rates have generally been fixed for trades on stock markets outside the United States. In recent years, however, an increasing number of overseas stock markets have adopted a system of negotiated rates. It is expected that equity securities will ordinarily be purchased in the primary markets, whether over-the-counter or listed, and that listed securities may be purchased in the over-the-counter market if such market is deemed the primary market. In the case of securities traded on the over-the-counter markets, there is generally no stated commission, but the price usually includes an undisclosed commission or markup. In underwritten offerings, the price includes a disclosed, fixed commission (the underwriter’s concession) or discount.
Fixed income and convertible securities are bought and sold through broker-dealers acting on a principal basis. Generally, these trades are not charged a commission, but rather are marked up or marked down by the executing broker-dealer. The Adviser does not know the actual value of the markup/ markdown. However, the Adviser attempts to ascertain whether the overall price of a security is reasonable through the use of competitive bids.
Subject to the consideration of obtaining best execution, the Adviser may use brokerage commissions generated from client transactions to obtain services and/or research from broker-dealers to assist in the Adviser’s investment management decision-making process. These services and research are in addition to and do not replace the services and research that the Adviser is required to perform and do not reduce the investment advisory fees payable to the Adviser by the Funds. Such information may be useful to the Adviser in serving both the Funds and other clients and, conversely, such supplemental research information obtained by the placement of orders on behalf of other clients may be useful to the Adviser in carrying out its obligations to the Funds.
Brokerage commissions may never be used to compensate a third party for client referrals unless the client has directed such an arrangement. In addition, brokerage commissions may never be used to obtain research and/or services for the sole benefit of any employee or non-client entity.
It is the policy of the Adviser to obtain the “best execution” of its clients’ securities transactions. The Adviser strives to execute each client’s securities transactions in such a manner that the client’s total costs or proceeds in each transaction are the most favorable under the circumstances. Commission rates paid on securities transactions for client accounts must reflect comparative market rates.
The Adviser will consider the full range and quality of a broker’s services in placing brokerage including, but not limited to, the value of research provided, execution capability, commission rate, willingness and ability to commit capital, ownership and responsiveness. The lowest possible commission cost alone does not determine broker selection. The transaction that represents the best quality execution for a client account will be executed. Commission ranges and the actual commission paid for trades of listed stocks and over-the-counter stocks may vary depending on, but not limited to, the liquidity and volatility of the stock and services provided to the Adviser by the broker.
The Adviser will make a good faith determination that the commissions paid are reasonable in relationship to the value of the services received. The continuous review of stock commissions is the responsibility of the Head of Capital Markets and client trading, brokerage and soft-dollar oversight is performed by the Trade Oversight Committee. Quarterly, the Adviser’s research analysts and portfolio managers will participate in a broker vote. The Adviser’s Equity Trading Desk will utilize the vote results during the broker selection process. Some brokers executing trades for the Adviser’s clients may, from time to time, receive liquidity rebates in connection with the routing of trades to Electronic Communications Networks. Since the Adviser is not a broker, however, it is ineligible to receive such rebates and does not obtain direct benefits for its clients from this broker practice.
Investment decisions for each Fund are made independently from those made for the other Funds or any other investment company or account managed by the Adviser. Such other investment companies or accounts may also invest in the same securities and may follow similar investment strategies as the Funds. The Adviser may combine transaction orders (“bunching” or “blocking” trades) for more than one client account where such action appears to be equitable and potentially advantageous for each account (e.g., for the purpose of reducing brokerage commissions or obtaining a more favorable transaction price.)  The Adviser will aggregate transaction orders only if it believes that the aggregation is consistent with its duty to seek best execution for its clients and is consistent with the terms of investment advisory agreements with each client for whom trades are being aggregated. Both equity and fixed-income
47

securities may be aggregated. When making such a combination of transaction orders for a new issue or secondary market trade in an equity security, the Adviser adheres to the following objectives: 
• Fairness to clients both in the participation of execution of orders for their account, and in the allocation of orders for the accounts of more than one client.
• Allocation of all orders in a timely and efficient manner.
In some rare cases, “bunching” and “blocking” trades may affect the price paid or received by a Fund or the size of the position obtained by the Fund in an adverse manner relative to the result that would have been obtained if only that particular Fund had participated in or been allocated such trades.
The aggregation of transactions for advisory accounts and proprietary accounts (including partnerships and other accounts in which the Adviser or its associated persons are partners or participants, and managed employee accounts) is permissible. No proprietary account may be favored over any other participating account and such practice must be consistent with the Adviser’s policies and procedures including its Code of Ethics.
Equity trade orders are executed based only on trade instructions received from portfolio managers by the trading desk. Portfolio managers may enter trades to meet the full target allocation immediately or may meet the allocation through moves in incremental blocks. Orders are processed on a “first-come, first-served” basis. At times, a rotation system may determine “first-come, first-served” treatment when the equity trading desk receives the same order for multiple accounts simultaneously. The Adviser will utilize a rotation whereby the Funds, even if aggregated with other orders, are in the first block(s) to trade within the rotation. To aggregate orders, the equity trading desk must determine that all accounts in the order will benefit. Any new trade that can be blocked with an existing open order may be added to the open order to form a larger block. The Adviser receives no additional compensation or remuneration of any kind as a result of the aggregation of trades. All accounts participating in a block execution receive the same execution price, an average share price, for securities purchased or sold on a trading day. Execution prices may not be carried overnight. Any portion of an order that remains unfilled at the end of a given day shall be rewritten (absent contrary instructions) on the following day as a new order. Accounts with trades executed the next day will receive a new daily average price to be determined at the end of the following day.
If the order is filled in its entirety, securities purchased in the aggregate transaction will be allocated among accounts participating in the trade in accordance with an Allocation Statement prepared at the time of order entry. If the order is partially filled, the securities will be allocated pro rata based on the Allocation Statement. Portfolio managers may allocate executed trades in a different manner than indicated on the Allocation Statement (e.g., non-pro rata) only if all client accounts receive fair and equitable treatment.
In some instances, such as trading in fixed income securities, it may not be practical to complete the Allocation Statement prior to the placement of the order. In that case, the trading desk will complete the Allocation Statement as soon as practicable, but no later than the end of the same business day on which the securities have been allocated to the trading desk by the broker.
Where the full amount of a block execution is not executed, the partial amount actually executed will be allocated on a pro rata basis whenever possible. The following execution methods maybe used in place of a pro rata procedure:  relative size allocations, security position weighting, priority for specialized accounts, or a special allocation based on compliance approval.
In making investment decisions for the Funds, the Adviser will not inquire or take into consideration whether an issuer of securities proposed for purchase or sale by a Fund is a customer of the Adviser, its parents, subsidiaries or affiliates, and, in dealing with their commercial customers, the Adviser, its parents, subsidiaries and affiliates will not inquire or take into consideration whether securities of such customers are held by the Funds. Portfolio securities will not be purchased from or sold to the Adviser, or the Distributor, or any affiliated person of any of them acting as principal, except to the extent permitted by rule or order of the SEC.
The following table shows the dollar amount of brokerage commissions paid by each Fund for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, all of which were paid to entities that are not affiliated with the Funds, the Adviser, or the Distributor.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
$413,078
$311,595
$564,440
Victory Growth Fund
$436,192
$479,846
$745,086
Victory Growth & Income Fund
$806,179(a)
$451,186
$734,540
Victory Income Stock Fund
$1,204,880
$707,152
$1,000,224
Victory Income Fund
$
$
$999
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$
$
$1,466
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$1,305,095
$1,208,004
$1,247,616
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$38,118
$22,701
$29,230
48

Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory High Income Fund
$9,286(b)
$24,788
$65,077
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$1,411,054
$1,100,295
$1,631,843
Victory Capital Growth Fund
$478,273
$319,566
$502,486
Victory Value Fund
$488,591
$426,329
$732,216
(a) Reflects increased trading activity due to current year transition or asset allocation shift.
(b) Reflects decreased trading activity in the purchases and sells of exchange-traded funds.
The following table shows the dollar amount of brokerage commissions paid by each Fund for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended December 31, 2022, all of which were paid to entities that are not affiliated with the Funds, the Adviser, or the Distributor.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
$441,938(a)
$94,021
$341,455
Victory 500 Index Fund
$212,581(a)
$76,259
$158,693
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
$140,561(a)
$11,660
$102,515
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
$160,293(a)
$47,853
$173,726
(a) Reflects increased trading activity for a complete fiscal year.
Affiliated Brokerage. The Board has authorized the allocation of brokerage to affiliated broker-dealers on an agency basis to effect portfolio transactions. The Board has adopted procedures incorporating the standards of Rule 17e-1 under the 1940 Act, which require that the commission paid to affiliated broker-dealers must be “reasonable and fair compared to the commission, fee or other remuneration received, or to be received, by other broker-dealers in connection with comparable transactions involving similar securities during a comparable period of time.”
The Trust will not acquire portfolio securities issued by, make savings deposits in, or enter into repurchase or reverse repurchase agreements with the Adviser or its affiliates. From time to time, when determined by the Adviser to be advantageous to the Funds, the Adviser may execute portfolio transactions through affiliated broker-dealers. All such transactions must be consistent with best execution and completed in accordance with procedures approved by the Board. For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal years ended July 31 (December 31, for Victory Extended Market Index Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund, and Victory Ultra-Short Bond Fund) 2022, the Funds paid no commissions to affiliated broker-dealers.
Allocation of Brokerage in Connection with Research Services. The Adviser or the applicable Subadviser directed a portion of the Fund's brokerage transactions to certain broker-dealers that provided the Adviser or the applicable Subadviser with research, analysis, advice, and similar services. For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, such brokerage transactions and related commissions and/or fixed price public offering underwriting concessions amounted to the following:
Fund
Brokerage
Commissions Paid
Total Dollar Amount
of Such Transactions
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
$249,130
$1,618,347,643
Victory Growth Fund
$215,534
$1,378,069,968
Victory Capital Growth Fund
$192,757
$822,194,732
Victory Growth & Income Fund
$520,621
$2,657,178,886
Victory High Income Fund
$6,969
$16,285,258
Victory Income Stock Fund
$852,128
$2,987,533,797
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$478,501
$660,400,125
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$738,346
$1,246,329,544
Victory Value Fund
$334,418
$1,061,359,901
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
$283,705
$574,818,378
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
$101,072
$289,338,768
Securities of Regular Brokers or Dealers. The SEC requires the Trust to provide certain information for those Funds that held securities of their regular brokers or dealers (or their parent companies) during the most recent fiscal year. The following table identifies, for each applicable Fund, those brokers or dealers, the type of security held, and the value of the Fund’s aggregate holdings of the securities of each such issuer as of the most recent fiscal year ended April 30, 2024:
49

Fund
Broker-Dealer
Type of Security
(Debt or Equity)
Aggregate
Value ($000s)
Victory 500 Index Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Equity
$76,420
Victory 500 Index Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$30,706
Victory 500 Index Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$143,719
Victory 500 Index Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Equity
$36,303
Victory 500 Index Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Equity
$55,680
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$735
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
Mizuho Financial Group,
Inc.
Equity
$85
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Equity
$227
Victory Capital Growth Fund
Barclays PLC
Equity
$2,691
Victory Capital Growth Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$11,030
Victory Capital Growth Fund
Mizuho Financial Group,
Inc.
Equity
$3,677
Victory Capital Growth Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Equity
$4,233
Victory Growth & Income Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Equity
$2,401
Victory Growth & Income Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$956
Victory Growth & Income Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$49,771
Victory Growth & Income Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Equity
$8,596
Victory Growth & Income Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Equity
$20,180
Victory Income Stock Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$133,233
Victory Income Stock Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Equity
$15,199
Victory Income Stock Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Equity
$54,273
Victory Value Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$19,270
Victory Value Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Equity
$30,890
Victory Value Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Equity
$26,557
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
Jefferies Financial Group,
Inc.
Equity
$884
Victory Income Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$1,160
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$5,800
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Equity
$2,538
Victory Income Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Debt
$10,587
Victory Income Fund
Barclays PLC
Debt
$12,278
Victory Income Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Debt
$4,741
Victory Income Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Debt
$24,254
Victory Income Fund
Mitsubishi UFJ Financial
Group, Inc.
Debt
$4,922
Victory Income Fund
Mizuho Financial Group,
Inc.
Debt
$12,563
Victory Income Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Debt
$15,440
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Debt
$505
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Barclays PLC
Debt
$1,506
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Debt
$1,501
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Debt
$1,780
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Mitsubishi UFJ Financial
Group, Inc.
Debt
$1,188
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Mizuho Financial Group,
Inc.
Debt
$1,004
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Debt
$1,000
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Debt
$3,262
50

Fund
Broker-Dealer
Type of Security
(Debt or Equity)
Aggregate
Value ($000s)
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Barclays PLC
Debt
$5,103
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Debt
$1,001
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Debt
$3,529
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Debt
$17,483
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Debt
$6,901
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Barclays PLC
Debt
$2,716
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Jefferies Financial Group,
Inc.
Debt
$3,172
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Debt
$11,089
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Mizuho Financial Group,
Inc.
Debt
$5,672
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
The Goldman Sachs Group,
Inc.
Debt
$4,413
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Debt
$27,209
Victory Money Market Fund
Bank of America Corp.
Debt
$80,000
Victory Money Market Fund
Citigroup, Inc.
Debt
$40,000
Victory Money Market Fund
Wells Fargo & Co.
Debt
$40,000
Portfolio Turnover
The rate of portfolio turnover of a Fund will not be a limiting factor when the Manager or the applicable Subadviser deems changes in a Fund’s (except the Victory Money Market Fund's) portfolio appropriate in view of its investment objective(s). Ordinarily, a Fund will not purchase or sell securities solely to achieve short-term trading profits, although a Fund may sell portfolio securities without regard to the length of time held if consistent with the Fund’s investment objective(s). Portfolio turnover is calculated on the basis of a Fund as a whole without distinguishing between the classes of shares issued.
The turnover rate for a Fund will vary from year-to-year, and, depending on market conditions, could be greater in periods of unusual market movement and volatility. Transaction costs associated with turnover are borne directly by the Fund and, ultimately, by its shareholders. A high rate of portfolio turnover (generally, over 100% annually) generally will involve correspondingly greater transaction costs. High portfolio turnover may result in the realization of substantial net capital gains. To the extent short-term capital gains are realized, distributions attributable to such gains will be ordinary income for federal income tax purposes.
The portfolio turnover rate is computed by dividing the dollar amount of securities purchased or sold (whichever is smaller) by the average value of securities owned during the year. Short-term investments such as, but not limited to, commercial paper and short-term U.S. government securities are not considered when computing the turnover rate.
Fund
2024
2023
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
45%
37%
Victory Growth Fund
35%
33%
Victory Growth & Income Fund
75%
43%
Victory Income Stock Fund
58%
32%
Victory Income Fund
25%
13%
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
46%
32%
Victory Science & Technology Fund
75%
56%
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
36%
42%
Victory High Income Fund
58%
60%
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
62%
55%
Victory Capital Growth Fund
59%
41%
Victory Value Fund
42%
43%
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
41%
5%
Victory 500 Index Fund
5%
4%
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
22%
2%
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
24%
7%
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
47%
15%
51

Fund History and Description of Shares
Each Fund is classified as diversified, except the Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, which is classified as non-diversified. Each Fund, except Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund, formerly were series of USAA Mutual Fund, Inc., a Maryland corporation. The Victory Growth Fund, Victory Income Fund, and Victory Money Market Fund were established in the Fall of 1980 and commenced public offering of their shares on February 2, 1981; the Victory Aggressive Growth Fund was established on July 8, 1981, and commenced public offering of its shares on October 19, 1981; the Victory Income Stock Fund was established on January 23, 1987, and commenced public offering of its shares on May 4, 1987; the Victory Growth & Income Fund and Victory Short-Term Bond Fund were established on March 23, 1993, and commenced public offering of their shares on June 1, 1993; the Victory Science & Technology Fund was established on May 9, 1997, and commenced public offering of its shares on August 4, 1997; the Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund (formerly Intermediate-Term Bond Fund), Victory High Income Fund (formerly High-Yield Opportunities), and Victory Small Cap Stock Fund were established on May 6, 1999, and commenced public offering of their shares on August 2, 1999; the Victory Capital Growth Fund was established on July 19, 2000, and commenced public offering of its shares on October 27, 2000; and the Victory Value Fund was established on April 26, 2001, and commenced public offering of its shares on August 3, 2001. The Victory 500 Index Fund (formerly the S&P 500 Index Fund) was established on February 9, 1996, and commenced public offering of its shares on May 2, 1996. The Victory Extended Market Index Fund and Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund were established on July 19, 2000, and commenced public offering of their shares on October 30, 2000. The Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond was established on June 25, 2010, and commenced public offering of its shares on October 18, 2010. The Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund was established on February 27, 2008, and commenced public offering of its shares on July 31, 2008. The Funds were reorganized into the Trust in August 2006. The Trust is permitted to offer additional funds or classes of shares. Each class of shares of a Fund is a separate share class of that Fund and is not a separate mutual fund.
Each Fund’s assets and all income, earnings, profits, and proceeds thereof, subject only to the rights of creditors, are specifically allocated solely to such Fund. They constitute the underlying assets of such Fund, are required to be segregated on the books of account, and are to be charged with the expenses of such Fund. The assets of each Fund are charged with the liabilities and expenses attributable to such Fund, except that liabilities and expenses may be allocated to a particular class. Any general expenses of the Trust not readily identifiable as belonging to a particular Fund are allocated on the basis of the Funds' relative net assets during the fiscal year or in such other manner as the Trustees determine to be fair and equitable.
Shares of each class of a Fund represent an equal proportionate interest in that Fund with every other share of that class and are entitled to dividends and other distributions out of the net income and realized net capital gains belonging to that Fund when declared by the Board. They generally will have identical voting, dividend, liquidation, and other rights, preferences, powers, restrictions, limitations, qualifications and terms and conditions, except that: (a) each has a different designation; (b) each class of shares bears its “Class Expenses”; (c) each has exclusive voting rights on any matter submitted to shareholders that relates solely to its arrangement; (d) each class has separate voting rights on any matter submitted to shareholders in which the interests of one class differ from the interests of any other class; (e) each class may have separate exchange privileges; and (f) each class may have different conversion features. Expenses currently designated as “Class Expenses” by the Board under the Multiple Class Plan pursuant to Rule 18f-3 under the 1940 Act include: legal, printing and postage expenses related to preparing and distributing materials such as shareholder reports, prospectuses, and proxies to current shareholders of a specific class; blue sky fees incurred by a specific class of shares; transfer agency expenses relating to a specific class of shares; expenses of administrative personnel and services required to support the shareholders of a specific class of shares; litigation expenses or other legal expenses relating to a specific class of shares; shareholder servicing expenses identified as being attributable to a specific class; and such other expenses actually incurred in a different amount by a class or related to a class’s receipt of services of a different kind or to a different degree than another class. In addition, each class of a Fund may pay a different advisory fee to the extent that any difference in amount paid is the result of the application of the same performance fee provisions in the advisory contract with respect to the Fund to the different investment performance of each class of the Fund. Upon liquidation of a Fund, shareholders are entitled to share pro rata in the net assets belonging to such Fund available for distribution. However, due to the differing expenses of the classes, dividends, and liquidation proceeds on the different classes of shares will differ.
Under the Trust’s Master Trust Agreement, no annual or regular meeting of shareholders is required. Thus, there ordinarily will be no shareholder meeting unless otherwise required by the 1940 Act. Under certain circumstances, however, shareholders may apply to the Trustees for shareholder information in order to obtain signatures to request a shareholder meeting. The Trust may fill vacancies on the Board or appoint new Trustees if the result is that at least two-thirds of the Trustees have been elected by shareholders. Moreover, pursuant to the Master Trust Agreement, any Trustee may be removed by the vote of two-thirds of the outstanding Trust shares, and holders of 10% or more of the outstanding shares of the Trust can require Trustees to call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose of voting on the removal of one or more Trustees. The Trust will assist in communicating to other shareholders about the meeting. On any matter submitted to the shareholders, the holder of any share class of the Fund is entitled to one vote per share (with proportionate voting for fractional shares) regardless of the relative NAVs of the Fund’s share classes. However, on matters affecting an individual Fund, a separate vote of the shareholders of that Fund is required. Shareholders of a Fund are not entitled to vote on any matter that does not affect that Fund but which requires a separate vote of another Fund.
52

Shares do not have cumulative voting rights, which means that holders of more than 50% of the shares voting for the election of Trustees can elect 100% of the Trust’s Board, and the holders of less than 50% of the shares voting for the election of Trustees will not be able to elect any person as a Trustee.
Shareholders of a particular Fund might have the power to elect all of the Trustees if that Fund has a majority of the assets of the Trust. When issued, each Fund’s shares are fully paid and nonassessable, have no pre-emptive or subscription rights, and are fully transferable. The Fund's conversion rights are as follows:
Converting from Institutional Shares to Fund Shares: If you no longer meet the eligibility requirements to invest in Institutional Shares of a Fund (e.g., you terminate participation in a discretionary managed account program), we may convert your Institutional Shares of the Fund to Fund Shares. The Fund will notify you before any such conversion to Fund Shares occurs.
Converting from Class A Shares to Fund Shares or Institutional Shares: If you hold Class A shares of a Fund through an account maintained with another financial institution and subsequently transfer your shares into (i) an account established directly with the Fund, (ii) your investment account, or (iii) an eligible advisory program with a financial intermediary, we may convert your Class A shares of the Fund to Fund Shares or Institutional Shares, as applicable.
Other Conversions: The Fund also may provide for other conversion privileges from time to time under which a shareholder of the Fund may convert shares into another class of shares of the same Fund under certain circumstances, subject to approval by the Fund’s officers.
Pricing: When a conversion occurs, you receive shares of one class of a Fund for shares of another class of the same Fund. At the time of conversion, the dollar value of the “new” shares you receive equals the dollar value of the “old” shares that were converted. In other words, the conversion has no effect on the value of your investment in a Fund at the time of the conversion. However, the number of shares you own after the conversion may be greater than or less than the number of shares you owned before the conversion, depending on the NAVs per share of the two share classes. A conversion between share classes of the same Fund is a non-taxable event.
Conversions are not subject to the Fund's restrictions on short-term trading activity discussed under Funds' Right to Reject Purchase and Exchange Orders and Limit Trading in Accounts in this SAI.
Tax Considerations
Taxation of the Funds
Each Fund, which is treated as a separate corporation for federal tax purposes, intends to continue to qualify each taxable year for treatment as a “regulated investment company” (“RIC”) under Subchapter M of Chapter 1 of Subtitle A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”). If a Fund so qualifies it will not be liable for federal income tax on its net investment income and net capital gains (i.e., the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss) that it distributes to its shareholders.
To continue to qualify for treatment as a RIC, a Fund must, among other things, (1) derive at least 90% of its gross income each taxable year from (a) dividends, interest, payments with respect to securities loans, and gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities, or foreign currencies, and or other income (including gains from options, futures, or forward contracts) derived with respect to its business of investing in stock, securities, or such currencies, and (b) net income from an interest in a “qualified publicly traded partnership” (or “QPTP”) (i.e., a publicly traded partnership that is treated as a partnership for federal tax purposes, satisfies certain requirements with respect to the sources of its income, and derives less than 90% of its gross income from the items described in clause (a) (“income requirement”); (2) distribute at least the sum of 90% of its investment company taxable income (generally consisting of net investment income, the excess, if any, of net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss, and net gains and losses from certain foreign currency transactions) and 90% of its net exempt interest income for the taxable year (“distribution requirement”); and (3) satisfy certain diversification requirements at the close of each quarter of the Fund’s taxable year (“diversification requirement”).
If a Fund failed to qualify for RIC treatment for any taxable year either (1) by failing to satisfy the distribution requirement, even if it satisfied the income requirements and diversification requirements (collectively, “Other Qualification Requirements”), or (2) by failing to satisfy any of the Other Qualification Requirements and was unable to, or determined not to, avail itself of Code provisions that enable a RIC to cure a failure to satisfy any of the Other Qualification Requirements as long as the failure “is due to reasonable cause and not due to willful neglect” and the RIC pays a tax calculated in accordance with those provisions and meets certain other requirements, then for federal income tax purposes it would be taxed as an ordinary corporation on the full amount of its taxable income for that year without being able to deduct the distributions it makes to its shareholders. In addition, for those purposes all those distributions, including distributions of net capital gain, would be taxable to its shareholders as dividends (i.e., ordinary income) to the extent of the Fund’s earnings and profits. For individual and certain other non-corporate shareholders (each, an “individual shareholder”), those dividends would be eligible to be taxed as “qualified dividend income” (as described in each Fund’s prospectus) (“QDI”), which is subject to federal income tax at the lower rates for net capital gain. In the case of corporate shareholders that meet
53

certain holding period and other requirements regarding their shares of the Fund, all or part of those dividends would be eligible for the dividends-received deduction. Furthermore, the Fund could be required to recognize unrealized gains, pay substantial taxes and interest, and make substantial distributions before requalifying for RIC treatment.
The Code imposes a 4% excise tax (“Excise Tax”) on a RIC that fails to distribute during a calendar year an amount at least equal to the sum of (1) 98% of its ordinary (taxable) income for the year, (2) 98.2% of its capital gain net income for the 12-month period ending on October 31 of that year, plus (3) any prior undistributed taxable income and gains. Each Fund intends to continue to make distributions necessary to avoid imposition of the Excise Tax. However, a Fund may in certain circumstances be required to liquidate portfolio investments to make those distributions, potentially resulting in additional taxable gain or loss.
The use of hedging strategies, such as writing (selling) and purchasing options and futures contracts and entering into forward currency contracts, involves complex rules that will determine for federal income tax purposes the amount, character, and timing of recognition of the gains and losses a Fund realizes. Gain from the disposition of foreign currencies (except certain gains that may be excluded by future regulations), and gains from options, futures contracts, and forward currency contracts a Fund derives with respect to its business of investing in securities or foreign currencies, will be treated as “qualifying income” under the income requirements. Swap agreements and other derivative instruments, such as commodity-linked derivative instruments, including commodity index-linked notes, commodity options, futures contracts, and options on futures contracts, may not be “qualifying income.”
Some futures contracts, foreign currency contracts, and “non-equity” options (i.e., certain listed options, such as those on a “broad-based” securities index) but not including any “securities futures contract” that is not a “dealer securities futures contract” (both as defined in the Code) and any interest rate swap, currency swap, basis swap, interest rate cap, interest rate floor, commodity swap, equity swap, equity index swap, credit default swap, or similar agreement in which a Fund invests may be subject to section 1256 of the Code (collectively, “section 1256 contracts”). Any section 1256 contracts a Fund holds at the end of its taxable year generally must be “marked-to-market” (that is, treated as having been sold at that time for their fair market value) for federal income tax purposes, with the result that unrealized gains or losses will be treated as though they were realized. Sixty percent of any net gain or loss recognized on these deemed sales, and 60% of any net realized gain or loss from any actual sales of section 1256 contracts, will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss, and the balance will be treated as short-term capital gain or loss. These rules may operate to increase the amount that a Fund must distribute to satisfy the distribution requirement (i.e., with respect to the portion treated as short-term capital gain), which will be taxable to its shareholders as ordinary income when distributed to them, and to increase the net capital gain a Fund recognizes, without in either case increasing the cash available to it.
Section 988 of the Code also may apply to forward currency contracts and options and futures contracts on foreign currencies. Under that section, each foreign currency gain or loss generally is computed separately and treated as ordinary income or loss. These gains or losses will increase or decrease the amount of a Fund’s investment company taxable income to be distributed to its shareholders as ordinary income, rather than affecting the amount of its net capital gain. In the case of overlap between sections 1256 and 988, special provisions determine the character and timing of any income, gain, or loss.
Section 1092 of the Code (dealing with straddles) also may affect the taxation of certain options, futures contracts, and forward currency contracts in which a Fund may invest. That section defines a “straddle” as offsetting positions with respect to actively traded personal property; for these purposes, options, futures contracts, and forward currency contracts are positions in personal property. Under that section, any loss from the disposition of a position in a straddle generally may be deducted only to the extent the loss exceeds the unrealized gain on the offsetting position(s) of the straddle. In addition, these rules may postpone the recognition of loss that otherwise would be recognized under the mark-to-market rules discussed above. The regulations under section 1092 also provide certain “wash sale” rules, which apply to transactions where a position is sold at a loss and a new offsetting position is acquired within a prescribed period, and “short sale” rules applicable to straddles. If a Fund makes certain elections, the amount, character, and timing of recognition of gains and losses from the affected straddle positions would be determined under rules that vary according to the elections made.
Each Fund will monitor its transactions, make appropriate tax elections, and make appropriate entries in its books and records when it acquires any option, futures contract, forward currency contract, foreign currency, or hedged investment to mitigate the effect of the foregoing rules, prevent its disqualification as a RIC, and minimize the imposition of federal income tax and the Excise Tax.
Certain Funds may invest in the stock of “passive foreign investment companies” (“PFICs”). A PFIC is any foreign corporation (with certain exceptions) that, in general, meets either of the following tests for a taxable year: (1) at least 75% of its gross income is passive or (2) an average of at least 50% of its assets produce, or are held for the production of, passive income. Under certain circumstances, a Fund will be subject to federal income tax on a portion of any “excess distribution” it receives on the stock of a PFIC and of any gain on its disposition of that stock (collectively, PFIC income), plus interest thereon, even if the Fund distributes the PFIC income as a dividend to its shareholders. The balance of the PFIC income will be included in the Fund’s investment company taxable income and, accordingly, will not be taxable to it to the extent it distributes that income to its shareholders. Fund distributions of such income will not be eligible for the reduced maximum federal income tax rates on individual shareholders’ QDI.
54

If a Fund invests in a PFIC and elects to treat the PFIC as a “qualified electing fund” (“QEF”), then in lieu of the foregoing tax and interest obligation, the Fund would be required to include in income each taxable year its pro rata share of the QEF’s annual ordinary earnings and net capital gain which the Fund would need to distribute to satisfy the distribution requirement and avoid imposition of the Excise Tax even if the QEF did not distribute those earnings and gain to the Fund. In most instances it will be very difficult, if not impossible, to make this election because some of the information required to make this election may not be easily obtainable.
Each Fund may elect to “mark to market” its stock in PFICs it owns at the end of its taxable year, in which event it would be required to distribute to its shareholders any resulting gains in accordance with the distribution requirement. “Marking-to-market,” in this context, means including in gross income each taxable year (and treating as ordinary income) the excess, if any, of the fair market value of the stock over a Fund’s adjusted basis therein (including mark-to-market gain for each prior taxable year for which an election was in effect) as of the end of that year. Pursuant to the election, a Fund also would be allowed to deduct (as an ordinary, not a capital, loss) the excess, if any, of its adjusted basis in PFIC stock over the fair market value thereof as of the taxable year-end, but only to the extent of any net mark-to-market gains with respect to that stock the Fund included in income for prior taxable years under the election. A Fund’s adjusted basis in each PFIC’s stock subject to the election would be adjusted to reflect the amounts of income included and deductions taken thereunder.
Investors should note that a Fund’s determination whether a foreign corporation is a PFIC is a determination that is based on facts and circumstances and thus is subject to change, and the principles and methodology used in determining whether a foreign corporation is a PFIC are subject to interpretation. It is possible that a Fund could invest in a foreign corporation that becomes, or is determined to be, a PFIC after the Fund invests. It is anticipated that any federal income tax imposed on a Fund with respect to investments in PFICs would be insignificant.
For federal income tax purposes, debt securities purchased by a Fund, including zero coupon bonds, may be treated as having original issue discount (“OID”) (generally, the excess of the stated redemption price at maturity of a debt obligation over its issue price). OID is treated for those purposes as income earned by a Fund as it accrues, whether or not any payment is actually received, and therefore is subject to the distribution requirement. Generally, the accrual of OID is determined on the basis of a constant yield to maturity, which takes into account the compounding of accrued interest. Because each Fund annually must distribute substantially all of its investment company taxable income (determined without regard to any deduction for dividends paid), including any accrued OID, to satisfy the distribution requirement and to avoid imposition of the Excise Tax, a Fund may be required in a particular taxable year to distribute as a dividend an amount that is greater than the total amount of cash it actually receives. Those distributions will be made from a Fund’s cash assets or from the proceeds of sales of its portfolio securities, if necessary. A Fund may realize capital gains or losses from those sales, which would increase or decrease its investment company taxable income and/or net capital gain.
If a Fund purchases a debt security on a secondary market at a price lower than its stated redemption price, the difference is “market discount.” Generally, any gain realized on the disposition of, and any partial payment of principal on, a debt security having market discount is treated as ordinary income to the extent the gain, or principal payment, does not exceed the “accrued market discount” on the debt security. Market discount generally accrues in equal daily installments.
A Fund also may purchase debt securities at a premium (i.e., at a purchase price in excess of face amount). The premium may be amortized if a Fund so elects. The amortized premium is first offset against interest received on the securities and then allowed as a deduction and generally must be amortized under an economic accrual method. The amortized bond premium on a security will reduce a Fund’s adjusted tax basis in the security.
Income from direct investments in commodities and certain types of derivative contracts regarding commodities, such as certain swaps on commodity indices, is not “qualifying income” for purposes of the income requirement. Although the IRS had issued a large number of private letter rulings (“PLRs”) (which the Funds may not cite as precedent) beginning in 2006 stating that income a RIC derives from certain “structured notes that create a commodity exposure” (i.e., commodity-linked notes) constitutes qualifying income, the IRS (1) suspended the issuance of those rulings in July 2011 and (2) in September 2016 issued guidance providing that it will not “ordinarily” issue PLRs on any issue relating to the treatment of a corporation as a RIC that requires a determination of whether a financial instrument or position is a “security.” Further, the IRS revoked the earlier PLRs regarding commodity-linked notes, and it is highly unlikely that future PLRs addressing the status of those notes will be issued. Accordingly, if a Fund invests in those notes to an extent that might threaten its ability to satisfy the income requirement, the Fund may be unable to qualify as a RIC for one or more taxable years.
Taxation of the Shareholders
For United States federal income tax purposes, distributions paid out of a Fund's current or accumulated earnings and profits will, except in the case of distributions of qualified dividend income and capital gain dividends described below, be taxable as ordinary dividend income. Certain income distributions paid by a Fund (whether paid in cash or reinvested in additional Fund shares) to individual taxpayers are taxed at rates applicable to net long-term capital gains (20%, or 15% or 0% for individuals at certain income levels). This tax treatment applies only if certain holding period requirements and other requirements are satisfied by the shareholder
55

and the dividends are attributable to qualified dividend income received by the Fund itself. For this purpose, “qualified dividend income” means dividends received by a Fund from United States corporations and “qualified foreign corporations,” provided that the Fund satisfies certain holding period and other requirements in respect of the stock of such corporations. There can be no assurance as to what portion of a Fund's dividend distributions will qualify for favorable treatment.
If a Fund engages in securities lending, the borrower generally will be obligated to pay the Fund an amount equal to ("in lieu of") any dividend paid on the loaned securities during the loan term. Even if the dividend otherwise would be QDI, distributions to the Fund's shareholders of such "in lieu of" payments will not be treated as such and instead will be taxed at the shareholders' marginal federal income tax rates.
Distributions of net capital gain, if any, designated as capital gains dividends are taxable to a shareholder as long-term capital gains, regardless of how long the shareholder has held Fund shares. A distribution of an amount in excess of a Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will be treated by a shareholder as a return of capital which is applied against and reduces the shareholder’s basis in his or her shares. To the extent that the amount of any such distribution exceeds the shareholder’s basis in his or her shares, the excess will be treated by the shareholder as gain from a sale or exchange of the shares. Distributions of gains from the sale of investments that the Fund owned for one year or less will be taxable as ordinary income.
A Fund may elect to retain its net capital gain or a portion thereof for investment and be taxed at corporate rates on the amount retained In such case, it may designate the retained amount as undistributed capital gains in a notice to its shareholders who will be treated as if each received a distribution of his pro rata share of such gain, with the result that each shareholder will (i) be required to report his pro rata share of such gain on his tax return as long-term capital gain, (ii) receive a refundable tax credit for his pro rata share of tax paid by the Fund on the gain and (iii) increase the tax basis for his shares by an amount equal to the deemed distribution less the tax credit.
Distributions generally are included in a shareholder’s gross income for the taxable year in which they are received. However, dividends and other distributions declared in October, November, or December and made payable to shareholders of record in such a month are deemed to have been received on December 31, if they are paid during the following January.
Any gain or loss a shareholder realizes on the redemption or exchange of shares of a Fund, or on receipt of a distribution in complete liquidation of a Fund, generally will be a capital gain or loss, which will be long-term or short-term, depending upon the shareholder’s holding period for the shares. Any such gain an individual shareholder recognizes on a redemption or exchange of Fund shares that he or she has held for more than one year will qualify for the 15% or 20% maximum federal income tax rates mentioned in each Fund’s prospectus. Any loss realized on a redemption or exchange of shares will be disallowed to the extent the shares are replaced (including shares acquired pursuant to a dividend reinvestment plan) within a period of 61 days beginning 30 days before and ending 30 days after disposition of the shares; in such a case, the basis in the acquired shares will be adjusted to reflect the disallowed loss. Any loss a shareholder realizes on a disposition of shares held for six months or less will be treated as a long-term capital loss to the extent of any distributions of net capital gain the shareholder received with respect to such shares.
If a Fund’s distributions in a taxable year exceed its current and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess distributed to each shareholder will be treated as a “return of capital” to the extent of the shareholder’s basis in its shares and thereafter as capital gain. A return of capital distribution is not taxable, but it reduces a shareholder's basis in its shares and thus results in a higher capital gain or lower capital loss when the shares are redeemed. Distributions in excess of a Fund's distribution requirement, but not in excess of its earnings and profits, will be taxable to its shareholders and will not constitute non-taxable returns of capital.
For federal income tax purposes, net capital losses incurred by the Fund in a particular taxable year can be carried forward to offset net capital gains in any subsequent year until such loss carryforwards have been fully used, and such capital losses carried forward will retain their character as either short-term or long-term capital losses. To the extent subsequent net capital gains are offset by such losses, they would not result in federal income tax liability to the Fund and would not be distributed as such to shareholders.
The following table summarizes the capital loss carryforwards not subject to expiration for the applicable Funds as of April 30, 2024.
Fund
Short-Term Amount
(000s)
Long-Term Amount
(000s)
Victory Income Fund
($860)
($182,877)
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
($4,262)
($33,616)
Victory Science & Technology Fund
($76,445)
$-
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
($84,423)
($210,290)
Victory High Income Fund
($32,515)
($220,758)
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
($4,507)
($8,674)
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
($1,723)
($1,078)
56

Shareholders will receive information about the source and tax status of all distributions promptly after the close of each calendar year.
In addition to the requirement to report the gross proceeds from redemptions of Fund shares, each Fund (or its administrative agent) must report to the IRS the basis information for Fund shares purchased after December 31, 2011, (“Covered Shares”) that are redeemed or exchanged and indicate whether they had a short-term (one year or less) or long-term (more than one year) holding period. In addition, each Fund will indicate whether the lot has been adjusted for a wash sale. The requirement to report only the gross proceeds from a redemption or exchange of Fund shares will continue to apply to all non-Covered Shares.
In addition to the requirement to report the gross proceeds from redemptions of Fund shares, each Fund (or its administrative agent) must report to the IRS the basis information for Fund shares purchased after December 31, 2011 ("Covered Shares") that are redeemed or exchanged and indicate whether they had a short-term (one year or less) or long-term (more than one year) holding period. In addition, each Fund will indicate whether the lot has been adjusted for a wash sale. The requirement to report only the gross proceeds from a redemption or exchange of Fund shares will continue to apply to all non-Covered Shares.
Under the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act (“FATCA”), foreign financial institutions (“FFIs”) and non-financial foreign entities (“NFFEs”) that are shareholders of a Fund may be subject to a generally nonrefundable 30% withholding tax on income dividends the Fund pays. As discussed more fully below, the FATCA withholding tax generally can be avoided (a) by an FFI, if it reports certain information regarding direct and indirect ownership of financial accounts U.S. persons hold with the FFI, and (b) by an NFFE that certifies its status as such and, in certain circumstances, information regarding substantial U.S. owners.
An FFI can avoid FATCA withholding by becoming a “participating FFI,” which requires the FFI to enter into a tax compliance agreement with the IRS under the Code. Under such an agreement, a participating FFI agrees to (1) verify and document whether it has U.S. accountholders, (2) report certain information regarding their accounts to the IRS, and (3) meet certain other specified requirements. The U.S. Treasury has negotiated intergovernmental agreements (“IGAs”) with certain countries and is in various stages of negotiations with other foreign countries with respect to one or more alternative approaches to implement FATCA. An entity in one of those countries may be required to comply with the terms of the IGA instead of U.S. Treasury regulations.
An FFI resident in a country that has entered into a Model I IGA with the United States must report to that country’s government (pursuant to the terms of the applicable IGA and applicable law), which will, in turn, report to the IRS. An FFI resident in a Model II IGA country generally must comply with U.S. regulatory requirements, with certain exceptions, including the treatment of recalcitrant accountholders. An FFI resident in one of those countries that complies with whichever of the foregoing applies will be exempt from FATCA withholding.
An NFFE that is the beneficial owner of a payment from a Fund can avoid FATCA withholding generally by certifying its status as such and, in certain circumstances, either that (1) it does not have any substantial U.S. owners or (2) it does have one or more such owners and reports the name, address, and taxpayer identification number of each such owner. The NFFE will report to the Fund or other applicable withholding agent, which will, in turn, report information to the IRS.
Those foreign shareholders also may fall into certain exempt, excepted, or deemed compliant categories established by U.S. Treasury regulations, IGAs, and other guidance regarding FATCA. An FFI or NFFE that invests in a Fund will need to provide the Fund with documentation properly certifying the entity’s status under FATCA to avoid FATCA withholding. The requirements imposed by FATCA are different from, and in addition to, the tax certification rules to avoid backup withholding described in the Funds’ prospectuses. Foreign investors are urged to consult their tax advisers regarding the application of these requirements to their own situation and the impact thereof on their investment in a Fund.
*  *  *  *  *
The foregoing discussion of certain federal tax considerations affecting each Fund and its shareholders is only a summary and is not intended as a substitute for careful tax planning. Purchasers of Fund shares should consult their own tax advisers as to the tax consequences of investing in shares, including under federal, state, local, and other tax laws. Finally, the foregoing discussion is based on current applicable provisions of the Code and the regulations promulgated thereunder, judicial authority, and administrative interpretations published by the date hereof; changes in any applicable authority could materially affect the conclusions discussed above, possibly retroactively, and such changes often occur.
Management of the Trust
The Board consists of seven Trustees who supervise the business affairs of the Trust. The Board is responsible for the general oversight of the Funds' business and for assuring that the Funds are managed in the best interests of each Fund's respective shareholders. The Board periodically reviews the Funds' investment performance as well as the quality of other services provided to the Funds and their shareholders by each of the Funds' service providers, including Victory Capital and its affiliates.
57

Board Leadership Structure
The Board is comprised of a super-majority (80% or more) of Trustees who are not “interested persons” (as defined under the 1940 Act) of the Funds (the “Independent Trustees”) and one Trustee who is an “interested person” of the Funds (the “Interested Trustee”). Prior to July 2, 2021, Mr. Dan McNamara was deemed an “interested person” due to his previous position as Director of AMCO, the former investment adviser of the Funds. Effective July 2, 2021, Mr. McNamara became an Independent Trustee to the Funds. Mr. David Brown is deemed an “interested person” due to his position as Chief Executive Officer of Victory Capital, investment adviser to the Funds. Mr. Jefferson Boyce is the Chairman of the Board and presides at meetings of the Trustees and may call meetings of the Board and any Board committee whenever he deems it necessary. The Chairman participates in the preparation of the agenda for meetings of the Board and the identification of information to be presented to the Board with respect to matters to be acted upon by the Board. The Chairman also acts as a liaison with the Funds' management, officers, and other Trustees generally between meetings. The Chairman may perform such other functions as may be requested by the Board from time to time. Except for any duties specified in this SAI or pursuant to the Trust’s Master Trust Agreement or By-laws, or as assigned by the Board, the designation of a Trustee as Chairman does not impose on that Trustee any duties, obligations or liability that are greater than the duties, obligations or liability imposed on any other Trustee, generally. The Chairman may call meetings of the Board and any Board committee whenever he deems it necessary and presides at meetings of the Trustees. The Chairman participates in the preparation of the agenda for meetings of the Board and the identification of information to be presented to the Board with respect to matters to be acted upon by the Board. In addition, the Chairman will coordinate activities performed by the Independent Trustees as a group and will serve as the main liaison between the Independent Trustees and the Funds' management and officers between meetings. The Chairman may perform such other functions as may be requested by the Board from time to time. The Board has designated a number of standing committees as further described below, each of which has a chairman. The Board also may designate working groups or ad hoc committees as it deems appropriate.
The Board believes that this leadership structure is appropriate because it allows the Board to exercise informed and independent judgment over matters under its purview, and it allocates areas of responsibility among committees or working groups of Trustees and the full Board in a manner that enhances effective oversight. The Board considers leadership by an Independent Trustee as Chairman to be integral to promoting effective independent oversight of the Funds' operations and meaningful representation of the shareholders’ interests, given the number of funds offered by the Trust and the amount of assets that these funds represent. The Board also believes that having a super-majority of Independent Trustees is appropriate and in the best interest of the Funds' shareholders. Nevertheless, the Board also believes that having an interested person serve on the Board brings corporate and financial viewpoints that are, in the Board’s view, important elements in its decision-making process. In addition, the Board believes that the Interested Trustee provides the Board with the Adviser’s perspective in managing and sponsoring the Funds. The leadership structure of the Board may be changed, at any time and in the discretion of the Board, including in response to changes in circumstances or the characteristics of the Trust.
Board Oversight of Risk Management
As a series of a registered investment company, the Funds are subject to a variety of risks, including investment risks (such as, among others, market risk, credit risk, and interest rate risk), financial risks (such as, among others, settlement risk, liquidity risk, and valuation risk), compliance risks, and operational risks. The Trustees play an active role, as a full board and at the committee level, in overseeing risk management for the Funds. The Trustees delegate the day-to-day risk management of the Funds to various groups, including but not limited to, portfolio management, risk management, compliance, legal, fund accounting, and various committees discussed herein. These groups provide the Trustees with regular reports regarding investment, valuation, liquidity, and compliance, as well as the risks associated with each. The Trustees also oversee risk management for the Funds through regular interactions with the Funds' external auditors and periodic presentations from the Adviser.
The Board also participates in the Funds' risk oversight, in part, through the Funds' compliance program, which covers the following broad areas of compliance: portfolio management, trading practices, code of ethics, and protection of non-public information, accuracy of disclosures, safeguarding of fund assets, recordkeeping, marketing, fees, privacy, anti-money laundering, business continuity, valuation and pricing of funds shares, processing of fund shares, affiliated transactions, fund governance, and market timing. The Board also receives periodic updates regarding cybersecurity matters. The program seeks to identify and assess risk through various methods, including through regular interdisciplinary communications between compliance professionals, operational risk management, and business personnel who participate on a daily basis in risk management on behalf of the Funds. The Funds' chief compliance officer provides an annual compliance report and other compliance related briefings to the Board in writing and in person.
Victory Capital seeks to identify for the Board the risks that it believes may affect the Funds and develop processes and controls regarding such risks. However, risk management is a complex and dynamic undertaking and it is not always possible to comprehensively identify and/or mitigate all such risks at all times since risks are at times impacted by external events. In discharging its oversight responsibilities, the Board considers risk management issues throughout the year with the assistance of its various committees as described below. Each committee presents reports to the Board after its meeting, which may prompt further discussion
58

of issues concerning the oversight of the Funds' risk management. The Board as a whole also reviews written reports or presentations on a variety of risk issues as needed and may discuss particular risks that are not addressed in the committee process.
Among other committees, the Board has established an Audit and Compliance Committee, which is composed solely of Independent Trustees and oversees management of financial risks and controls. The Audit and Compliance Committee serves as the channel of communication between the independent auditors of the Funds and the Board with respect to financial statements and financial reporting processes, systems of internal control, and the audit process. Although the Audit and Compliance Committee is responsible for overseeing the management of financial risks, the Board is regularly informed of these risks through committee reports.
Trustees and Officers
Set forth below are the Independent Trustees and the Interested Trustee, and each of their respective offices and principal occupations during the last five years, length of time served, information relating to any other directorships held, and the specific roles and experience of each Board member that factor into the determination that the Trustee should serve on the Board. Under the Trust’s organizational documents, each Trustee serves as a Trustee of the Trust during the lifetime of the Trust and until its termination except as such Trustee sooner dies, resigns, retires, or is removed. However, pursuant to a policy adopted by the Board, each elected or appointed Independent Trustee may serve as a Trustee until the Trustee reaches age 75, and the Interested Trustee may serve as a Trustee until the Trustee reaches age 75. The Board may change or grant exceptions from this policy at any time without shareholder approval. A Trustee may resign, or may be removed by a written instrument signed by two-thirds of the number of Trustees before the removal, or may be removed by a vote of two-thirds of the outstanding shares of the Trust, at any time. Vacancies on the Board can be filled by the action of a majority of the Trustees, provided that after filling such vacancy at least two-thirds of the Trustees have been elected by the shareholders. The mailing address of the Trustees is 15935 La Cantera Parkway, San Antonio, TX 78256.
Independent Trustees
Name and
Date of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Funds
Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served
Principal
Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five
Years
Number of Portfolios
in Fund Complex
Overseen by Trustee
Other
Directorships
Held During
the Past Five
Years
Jefferson C.
Boyce
(September
1957)
Independent
Chair
January 2021
September 2013
Retired.
45
Westhab, Inc.,
New York
Theological
Seminary,
American
Filtration Corp.
Dawn M.
Hawley
(February 1954)
Trustee
April 2014
Retired.
45
None
59

Name and
Date of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Funds
Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served
Principal
Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five
Years
Number of Portfolios
in Fund Complex
Overseen by Trustee
Other
Directorships
Held During
the Past Five
Years
Daniel S.
McNamara
(June 1966)
Trustee
January 2012
President of Financial
Advice & Solutions
Group (FASG), USAA
(02/13-03/21); Director
of USAA Investment
Services Company
(ISCO) (formerly USAA
Investment Management
Company) (09/09-
03/21); Chairman of
Board of ISCO
(04/13-12/20); Senior
Vice President of USAA
Financial Planning
Services Insurance
Agency, Inc. (FPS)
(04/11-03/21); Director
and Vice Chairman of
FPS (12/13-03/21);
President and Director
of USAA Investment
Corporation (ICORP)
(03/10-03/21); Chairman
of Board of ICORP
(12/13-03/21); Director
of USAA Financial
Advisors, Inc. (FAI)
(12/13-03/21); Chairman
of Board of FAI
(3/15-03/21).
45
None
Richard Y.
Newton, III
(January 1956)
Trustee
March 2017
Director, Elta North
America (01/18-08/19),
which is a global leader
in the design,
manufacture, and
support of innovative
electronic systems in the
ground, maritime,
airborne, and security
domains for the nation’s
warfighters, security
personnel, and first
responders; Managing
Partner, Pioneer
Partnership
Development Group
(12/15-present).
45
Terran Orbital
Corp.,
American Made
Filtration Corp.
60

Name and
Date of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Funds
Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served
Principal
Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five
Years
Number of Portfolios
in Fund Complex
Overseen by Trustee
Other
Directorships
Held During
the Past Five
Years
Barbara B.
Ostdiek, Ph.D.
(March 1964)
Trustee
January 2008
Senior Associate Dean
of Degree programs at
Jesse H. Jones Graduate
School of Business at
Rice University
(07/13-present);
Associate Professor of
Finance at Jesse H.
Jones Graduate School
of Business at Rice
University (07/01-
07/21); Professor of
Finance at Jesse H.
Jones Graduate School
of Business at Rice
University
(07/21-present).
45
None
61

Name and
Date of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Funds
Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served
Principal
Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five
Years
Number of Portfolios
in Fund Complex
Overseen by Trustee
Other
Directorships
Held During
the Past Five
Years
John C. Walters
(February 1962)
Trustee
July 2019
Retired.
45
Guardian
Variable
Products Trust
(16 series)
Interested Trustee
Name and
Date of Birth
Position(s)
Held with Fund
Term of Office
and Length of
Time Served
Principal
Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five
Years
Number of Portfolios
in Fund Complex
Overseen by Trustee
Other
Directorships
Held During
the Past Five
Years
David C. Brown
(May 1972)
Trustee
July 2019
Chairman and Chief
Executive Officer
(2013-present), Victory
Capital Management
Inc.; Chief Executive
Officer and Chairman
(2013-present), Victory
Capital Holdings, Inc.;
Director, Victory Capital
Services, Inc. (2013-
present); Director,
Victory Capital Transfer
Agency, Inc. (2019-
present).
45 portfolios within the
Trust; 37 portfolios
within the Victory
Portfolios, 30 series
within the Victory
Portfolios II, and 6
series within the Victory
Variable Insurance
Funds
None
Trustee Qualifications
The Board believes that all the Trustees bring to the Board a wealth of executive leadership experience derived from their service as executives, board members, and leaders of diverse companies, academic institutions, and community and other organizations. The Board also believes that the different perspectives, viewpoints, professional experience, education, and individual qualities of each Trustee represent a diversity of experiences and a variety of complementary skills. In determining whether an individual is qualified to serve as a Trustee of the Funds, the Board considers a wide variety of information about the Trustee, and multiple factors contribute to the Board's decision. However, there are no specific required qualifications for Board membership. Each Trustee is determined to have the experience, skills, and attributes necessary to serve the Funds and their shareholders because each Trustee demonstrates an exceptional ability to consider complex business and financial matters, evaluate the relative importance and priority of issues, make decisions, and contribute effectively to the deliberations of the Board. The Board also considers the individual experience of each Trustee and determines that the Trustee’s professional experience, education, and background contribute to the diversity of perspectives on the Board. The business experience and objective thinking of the Trustees are considered invaluable assets for Victory Capital and, ultimately, the Funds' shareholders.
The following summarizes the experience and qualifications of the Trustees.
• Jefferson C. Boyce. Mr. Boyce brings to the Board experience in financial investment management, and, in particular, institutional and retail mutual funds, variable annuity products, broker dealers, and retirement programs, including experience in organizational development, marketing, product development, and money management as well as over 11 years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
• David C. Brown. Mr. Brown brings to the Board extensive business, finance and leadership skills gained and developed through years of experience in the financial services industry, including his tenure overseeing the strategic direction as CEO of Victory Capital. These skills, combined with Mr. Brown's extensive knowledge of the financial services industry and demonstrated success in the development and distribution of investment strategies and products, enable him to provide valuable insights to the Board and strategic direction for the Funds.
• Dawn M. Hawley. Ms. Hawley brings to the Board experience in financial investment management and, in particular, institutional and retail mutual funds, variable annuity products, broker dealers, and retirement programs, including experience
62

in financial planning, budgeting, accounting practices, and asset/liability management functions including major acquisitions and mergers, as well as over 10 years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
• Daniel S. McNamara. Mr. McNamara brings to the Board extensive experience in the financial services industry, including experience as an officer of the Trust, as well as over 12 years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
• Richard Y. Newton, III. Lt. Gen. Newton brings to the Board extensive management and military experience, as well as over seven years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
• Barbara B. Ostdiek. Dr. Ostdiek brings to the Board particular experience with financial investment management, education, and research as well as over 16 years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
• John C. Walters. Mr. Walters brings significant Board experience including active involvement with the board of a Fortune 500 company, and a proven record of leading large, complex financial organizations. He has a demonstrated record of success in distribution, manufacturing, investment brokerage, and investment management in both the retail and institutional investment businesses. He has substantial experience in the investment management business with a demonstrated ability to develop and drive strategy while managing operational, financial, and investment risk as well as over five years’ experience as a Board member of Victory Portfolios III.
Committees of the Board
• The Board typically conducts regular meetings five or six times a year to review the operations of the Funds in Victory Portfolios III. A portion of these meetings is devoted to various committee meetings of the Board, which focus on particular matters. In addition, the Board may hold special meetings by telephone or in person to discuss specific matters that may require action prior to the next regular meeting. The Board has four committees: Audit and Compliance Committee, Product Management and Distribution Committee, Corporate Governance Committee, and Investments Committee. The duties of these four Committees and their membership are as follows:
• Audit and Compliance Committee: The Audit and Compliance Committee of the Board of Trustees reviews the financial information and the independent auditor’s reports and undertakes certain studies and analyses as directed by the Board. The Audit and Compliance Committee has responsibility for the review of the Trust’s compliance program and the performance of the Trust’s chief compliance officer, as well as responsibility for certain additional compliance matters. The Audit and Compliance Committee is comprised of all Independent Trustees, with Ms. Hawley serving as the chair of the Committee.
• Product Management and Distribution Committee: The Product Management and Distribution Committee of the Board reviews the Funds offered by the Trust and the respective investment objectives and policies, as well as the Adviser’s selection of subadvisers; oversees the distribution and marketing of the Funds; and assists the Board in overseeing certain third-party service providers and related matters. The Product Management and Distribution Committee provides oversight with respect to the sale and distribution of shares of the Funds, including payments made by the Funds pursuant to the Trust’s 12b-1 Plan. The Product Management and Distribution Committee is comprised of all Trustees, with Mr. Walters serving as the chair of the Committee.
• Corporate Governance Committee: The Corporate Governance Committee of the Board maintains oversight of the organization, performance, and effectiveness of the Board and the Independent Trustees. The Corporate Governance Committee is responsible for maintaining a policy on Board tenure and term limitations for the Independent Trustees, establishing procedures to identify and recruit potential candidates for Board membership, and recommending candidates to fill any vacancy for Independent Trustees on the Board. The Corporate Governance Committee has adopted procedures to consider nominees recommended by shareholders. Shareholders may send recommendations to Mr. Richard Newton, chair of the Corporate Governance Committee. To be considered by the Board, any recommendations for a nomination submitted by a shareholder must include at least the following information: name; date of birth; contact information; education; business profession and other expertise; affiliations; experience relating to serving on the Board; and references. The Corporate Governance Committee is comprised of all Independent Trustees, with Mr. Newton serving as the chair of the Committee.
• Investments Committee: The Investments Committee assists the Board in fulfilling its responsibilities overseeing, among other things: the investment programs implemented by Victory Capital and/or, if applicable, the investment subadviser(s) for the Funds; the performance and portfolio composition of the Funds; and the valuation and liquidity of each Fund’s assets. In addition, the Investments Committee coordinates the Board’s consideration of investment advisory and underwriting agreements pursuant to Section 15(c) of the 1940 Act. The Investments Committee is comprised of all Trustees, with Dr. Ostdiek serving as the chair of the Committee.
63

During the Funds’ most recent fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the Board held meetings four times. The Audit and Compliance Committee held three meetings; the Product Management and Distribution Committee held three meetings; the Corporate Governance Committee held three meetings; and the Investments Committee held three meetings.
There are no family relationships among the Trustees, officers, and managerial level employees of the Trust.
Officers of the Trust
The officers of the Trust are elected by the Board to actively supervise the Trust’s day-to-day operations. The officers of the Trust, their date of birth, the length of time served, and their principal occupations during the past five years are detailed in the following table. Each officer serves until the earlier of his or her resignation, removal, retirement, death, or the election of a successor. The mailing address of each officer of the Trust is 15935 La Cantera Parkway, San Antonio, Texas 78256. The officers of the Trust receive no compensation directly from the Trust for performing the duties of their offices.
Name
and Date
of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Fund
Term of
Office and
Length of
Time Served
Principal Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five Years
Thomas
Dusenberry
(July 1977)
President
May 2022*
Director, Fund Administration, the Adviser; Victory
Capital Management Inc. (May 2023-present); Manager,
Fund Administration, the Adviser; Victory Capital
Management Inc. (2022-April 2023); Treasurer and
Principal Financial Officer (2020-2022), Assistant
Treasurer (2019), Salient MF Trust, Salient Midstream,
MLP Fund, and Forward Funds; Principal Financial
Officer (2018-2021) and Treasurer (2020-2021), Salient
Private Access Funds and Endowment PMF Funds;
Senior Vice President of Fund Accounting and
Operations, Salient Partners (2020-2022); Director of
Fund Operations, Salient Partners (2016-2019). Mr.
Dusenberry also serves as President of Victory
Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable
Insurance Funds.
Scott Stahorsky
(July 1969)
Vice President
July 2019
Director, Third-Party Dealer Services & Reg
Administration, Fund Administration, the Adviser
(5/1/2023-present); Vice President, Victory Capital
Transfer Agency, Inc. (4/20/23-present); Manager, Fund
Administration, the Adviser (2015-4/30/23). Mr.
Stahorsky also serves as Vice President of Victory
Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable
Insurance Funds.
Patricia
McClain
(September 1962)
Secretary
June 2024
Director, Regulatory Administration, Fund
Administration, the Adviser (July 2019-present). Ms.
McClain also serves as Secretary of Victory Portfolios,
Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable Insurance
Funds.
Allan Shaer,
(March 1965)
Treasurer
July 2019*
Senior Vice President, Financial Administration, Citi
Fund Services Ohio, Inc. (since 2016). Mr. Shaer also
serves as the Funds’ Principal Financial and Accounting
Officer. Mr. Shaer also serves as Treasurer of Victory
Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable
Insurance Funds.
Christopher Ponte,
(March 1984)
Assistant
Treasurer
May 2023
Director, Fund and Broker Dealer Finance, Fund
Administration, (5/1/23-present); Victory Capital
Transfer Agency, Inc. (May 2023-present); Manager,
Fund Administration, the Adviser (2017-2023); Chief
Financial Officer, Victory Capital Services, Inc. (since
2018). Mr. Ponte also serves as Assistant Treasurer of
Victory Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory
Variable Insurance Funds.
64

Name
and Date
of Birth
Position(s)
Held with
Fund
Term of
Office and
Length of
Time Served
Principal Occupation(s) Held
During the Past Five Years
Carol D. Trevino
(October 1965)
Assistant
Treasurer
September 2018
Director, Financial Reporting, Fund Administration
(5/1/23-present); Director, Accounting and Finance, the
Adviser (7/1/19-4/30/23). Ms. Trevino also serves as
Assistant Treasurer of Victory Portfolios, Victory
Portfolios II, and Victory Variable Insurance Funds.
Michael Bryan
(December 1962)
Anti-Money
Laundering
Compliance
Officer and
Identity Theft
Officer
May 2023
Vice President, CCO Compliance Support Services, Citi
Fund Services Ohio, Inc. (2008-present). Mr. Bryan
also serves as the Anti-Money Laundering Compliance
Officer and Identity Theft Officer for Victory
Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and Victory Variable
Insurance Funds.
Sean Fox
(September 1976)
Chief
Compliance
Officer
June 2022
Deputy Chief Compliance Officer (July 2021-June
2022), Senior Compliance Officer, the Adviser
(2019-present); Compliance Officer, the Adviser
(2015-2019). Mr. Fox also serves as Chief Compliance
Officer for Victory Portfolios, Victory Portfolios II, and
Victory Variable Insurance Funds.
* Effective June 12, 2024, Mr. Dusenberry resigned as Secretary and accepted the position of President. Effective on May 1, 2023, Mr. Shaer resigned as Assistant Treasurer and accepted the position of Treasurer.
Trustees’ Fund Ownership
The following tables set forth the dollar range of total equity securities beneficially owned by the Trustees of the Funds listed in this SAI and in all of the Victory Funds overseen by the Trustees as of the calendar year ended December 31, 2023. As of July 31, 2024, the officers and Trustees of the Trust, as a group, owned beneficially or of record less than 1% of the outstanding shares of the Trust.
Independent Trustees
Trustee
Dollar Range of Beneficial
Ownership of Fund Shares
Aggregate Dollar Range
of Beneficial Ownership
of Shares of All Series
of the Victory Portfolios III Complex
Jefferson C. Boyce
Victory Income Stock Fund: $10,001-$50,000
$50,001-$100,000
Dawn M. Hawley
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund:
$10,001-$50,000
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund:
$10,001-$50,000
Victory Value Fund: Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Daniel S. McNamara
Victory Extended Market Index Fund:
$1-$10,000
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund: $50,001-
$100,000
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund: Over
$100,000
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund:
$50,001-$100,000
Victory Value Fund: Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Richard Y. Newton, III
None
None
Barbara B. Ostdiek, Ph.D.
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund:
$10,001-$50,000
Victory 500 Index Fund: $10,001-$50,000
Victory Money Market Fund: Over $100,000
Victory Science & Technology Fund: $1-$10,000
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund: $1-$10,000
Victory Value Fund: $10,001-$50,000
Victory Capital Growth Fund: $1-$10,000
Over $100,000
65

Trustee
Dollar Range of Beneficial
Ownership of Fund Shares
Aggregate Dollar Range
of Beneficial Ownership
of Shares of All Series
of the Victory Portfolios III Complex
John C. Walters
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund: Over
$100,000
Over $100,000
Interested Trustee
Trustee
Dollar Range of Beneficial
Ownership of Fund Shares
Aggregate Dollar Range
of Beneficial Ownership
of Shares of All Series
of the Victory Portfolios III Complex
David C. Brown
None
None
Compensation
The following tables set forth information describing the compensation of the current Trustees of the Trust for their services as Trustees for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024. As of April 30, 2024, the Victory Portfolios III consisted of one registered investment company offering 45 individual funds. The Trust does not maintain a retirement plan for its Trustees.
Independent Trustees
Trustee
Aggregate Compensation
from the Funds
Aggregate Compensation
from the Trust
Jefferson C. Boyce
$147,000
$367,500
Dawn M. Hawley
$127,200
$318,000
Daniel S. McNamara
$119,000
$297,500
Richard Y. Newton, III
$123,000
$307,500
Barbara B. Ostdiek, Ph.D.
$125,400
$313,500
John C. Walters
$125,400
$313,500
Interested Trustee
Trustee
Aggregate Compensation
from the Funds
Aggregate Compensation
from the Trust
David C. Brown*
None
None
*
David C. Brown is affiliated with the Trust's investment adviser, Victory Capital. Accordingly, he receives no remuneration from the Trust or any other fund of the Victory Portfolios Complex.
Control Persons and Principal Shareholders
A principal shareholder is any person who owns of record or beneficially 5% or more of the outstanding shares of a Fund. A control person is one who owns beneficially or through controlled companies more than 25% of the voting securities of a company, who acknowledges the existence of control, or by whom the Fund acknowledges control. Shareholders with a controlling interest could affect the outcome of voting or the direction of management of a Fund. Since the economic benefit of investing in a Fund is passed through to the underlying investors of the record owners of 25% or more of the Fund shares, these record owners are not considered the beneficial owners of the Fund’s shares or control persons of the Fund.
Control Persons
As of July 31, 2024, there were no control persons of the Funds.
Principal Shareholders
As of July 31, 2024, the following persons were known to own of record or beneficially 5% or more of the outstanding shares of the share class and Fund indicated in the table below. “Record” ownership means the shareholder of record, or the exact name of the shareholder on the account, i.e., “ABC Brokerage, Inc.” “Beneficial” ownership refers to the actual pecuniary, or financial, interest in the security, i.e., “Jane Doe Shareholder.”
66

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
VICTORY 500 INDEX FUND MEMBER
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
35.21%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
7.21%
VICTORY 500 INDEX FUND REWARD
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
28.43%
VICTORY AGGRESSIVE GROWTH FUND
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
16.73%
VICTORY AGGRESSIVE GROWTH FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
63.90%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
8.79%
 
RAYMOND JAMES FINANCIAL SERVICES,
INC.
880 CARILLON PARKWAY
SAINT PETERSBURG FL 337332749
6.41%
VICTORY CAPITAL GROWTH FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
42.23%
 
RAYMOND JAMES FINANCIAL SERVICES,
INC.
880 CARILLON PARKWAY
SAINT PETERSBURG FL 337332749
12.53%
 
UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC.
C/O CENTRAL DEPOSIT/MUTUAL FUNDS
1000 HARBOR BLVD 7TH FL
A/C YY011410610
WEEHAWKEN NJ 070866727
7.43%
 
RAYMOND JAMES & ASSOCIATES, INC.
880 CARILLON PARKWAY
ST PETERSBURG FL 337332749
7.33%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
5.21%
VICTORY CAPITAL GROWTH FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
18.26%
VICTORY CORE PLUS INTERMEDIATE BOND
FUND CLASS A
VOYA INSTITUTIONAL TRUST COMPANY
151 FARMINGTON AVE
HARTFORD CT 061560002
33.08%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
21.98%
 
EDWARD D. JONES & CO., L.P.
12555 MANCHESTER ROAD
SAINT LOUIS MO 631313729
15.26%
67

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
 
MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY LLC
2000 WESTCHESTER AVE LD
PURCHASE NY 105772530
10.49%
 
MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
ATTN: COMPENSATION TEAM
4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2
JACKSONVILLE FL 322466484
6.27%
VICTORY CORE PLUS INTERMEDIATE BOND
FUND INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
26.40%
 
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
15.46%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
12.37%
 
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
9.51%
 
MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY LLC
2000 WESTCHESTER AVE LD
PURCHASE NY 105772530
8.18%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
7.01%
 
MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
ATTN: COMPENSATION TEAM
4800 DEER LAKE DR E FL 2
JACKSONVILLE FL 322466484
6.40%
 
UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC.
C/O CENTRAL DEPOSIT/MUTUAL FUNDS
1000 HARBOR BLVD 7TH FL
A/C YY011410610
WEEHAWKEN NJ 070866727
5.28%
VICTORY CORE PLUS INTERMEDIATE BOND
FUND SHARES
LPL FINANCIAL CORPORATION
75 STATE STREET, 24TH FLOOR
BOSTON MA 02109
8.92%
VICTORY CORE PLUS INTERMEDIATE TERM
BOND FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
35.35%
VICTORY EXTENDED MARKET INDEX FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
30.97%
VICTORY GLOBAL MANAGED VOLATILITY
FUND INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
100.00%
VICTORY GLOBAL MANAGED VOLATILITY
FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
56.76%
68

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
VICTORY GROWTH & INCOME FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
68.66%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
8.49%
VICTORY GROWTH & INCOME FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
12.60%
VICTORY GROWTH FUND INSTITUTIONAL
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
73.17%
 
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
23.46%
VICTORY GROWTH FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
21.53%
VICTORY HIGH INCOME FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
56.92%
 
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
38.07%
VICTORY HIGH INCOME FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
34.91%
VICTORY INCOME FUND INSTITUTIONAL
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
77.53%
 
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
19.34%
VICTORY INCOME FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
36.58%
VICTORY INCOME STOCK FUND
INSTUTIONAL SHARES
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
55.28%
 
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
33.63%
 
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
9.94%
69

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
VICTORY INCOME STOCK FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
15.38%
VICTORY NASDAQ-100 INDEX FUND
CLASS A
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
90.46%
VICTORY NASDAQ-100 INDEX FUND
CLASS C
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
50.74%
 
LPL FINANCIAL CORPORATION
75 STATE STREET, 24TH FLOOR
BOSTON MA 02109
11.40%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
6.06%
VICTORY NASDAQ-100 INDEX FUND
CLASS R6
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
32.85%
 
VOYA INSTITUTIONAL TRUST COMPANY
ONE ORANGE WAY
WINDSOR CT 06095
15.88%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
14.53%
 
NATIONWIDE INVESTMENT SERVICES CORP.
CO IPO PORTFOLIO ACCOUNTING
PO BOX 182029
COLUMBUS OH 432182029
6.73%
VICTORY NASDAQ-100 INDEX FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
MAC AND CO 114429
STATE OF NEW YORK
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151 1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
80.66%
 
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
5.84%
VICTORY NASDAQ-100 INDEX FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
39.64%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
14.80%
VICTORY SCIENCE & TECHNOLOGY FUND
CLASS A
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
88.34%
VICTORY SCIENCE & TECHNOLOGY FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
20.82%
70

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
VICTORY SHORT TERM BOND FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
33.82%
 
LPL FINANCIAL CORPORATION
75 STATE STREET, 24TH FLOOR
BOSTON MA 02109
5.77%
VICTORY SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
CLASS A
JOHN HANCOCK TRUST COMPANY LLC
200 BERKELEY ST
BOSTON MA 02116
46.04%
 
EDWARD D. JONES & CO., L.P.
12555 MANCHESTER ROAD
SAINT LOUIS MO 631313729
39.72%
VICTORY SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
55.10%
 
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
12.12%
 
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
7.69%
 
MORGAN STANLEY SMITH BARNEY LLC
2000 WESTCHESTER AVE LD
PURCHASE NY 105772530
6.32%
VICTORY SMALL CAP STOCK FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
MAC CO AC 822432
FBO STATE OF ARIZONA
500 GRANT STREET
ROOM 151-1010
PITTSBURGH PA 15258
62.03%
 
GERLACH AND CO LLC CITIBANK OPEN
WE1
3800 CITIGROUP CTR
BUILDING B3 14
TAMPA FL 33610
33.99%
VICTORY SMALL CAP STOCK FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
24.80%
VICTORY ULTRA SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
CLASS A
PERSHING LLC
ONE PERSHING PLAZA
PRODUCT SUPPORT, 14TH FLOOR
JERSEY CITY NJ 07399
85.01%
 
EDWARD D. JONES & CO., L.P.
12555 MANCHESTER ROAD
SAINT LOUIS MO 631313729
9.18%
 
VICTORY CAPITAL MANAGEMENT INC
4900 TIEDEMAN ROAD 4TH FLOOR
C/O CATHY SAVVAS CONTROLLER
BROOKLYN OH 44144
5.80%
VICTORY ULTRA SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
CLASS R6
MATRIX TRUST COMPANY TRUSTEE FBO
VICTORY CAPITAL MANAGEMENT INC DE
PO BOX 52129
PHOENIX AZ 850722129
85.25%
71

Fund - Class
Name and Address of Owner
Percentage
Owned of
Record
 
NATIONWIDE INVESTMENT SERVICES CORP.
CO IPO PORTFOLIO ACCOUNTING
PO BOX 182029
COLUMBUS OH 432182029
12.16%
VICTORY ULTRA SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
INSTITUTIONAL SHARES
NATIONAL FINANCIAL SERVICES LLC
NEWPORT OFFICE CENTER III 5TH FLOOR
499 WASHINGTON BOULEVARD
JERSEY CITY NJ 07310
74.35%
 
UBS FINANCIAL SERVICES INC.
C/O CENTRAL DEPOSIT/MUTUAL FUNDS
1000 HARBOR BLVD 7TH FL
A/C YY011410610
WEEHAWKEN NJ 070866727
19.09%
VICTORY ULTRA SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
38.21%
 
LPL FINANCIAL CORPORATION
75 STATE STREET, 24TH FLOOR
BOSTON MA 02109
5.08%
VICTORY VALUE FUND SHARES
CHARLES SCHWAB & CO., INC.
211 MAIN STREET
SAN FRANCISCO CA 94105
28.37%
The Trust’s Adviser and Other Service Providers
Investment Adviser
Victory Capital, a New York corporation registered as an investment adviser with the SEC, serves as investment adviser to the Funds. Victory Capital’s principal business address is 15935 La Cantera Pkwy, San Antonio, Texas 78256. Victory Capital is an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of Victory Capital Holdings, Inc. (“VCH”) a publicly traded Delaware corporation. As of July 31, 2024, Victory Capital managed assets totaling in excess of $172.1 billion for numerous clients including large corporate and public retirement plans, Taft-Hartley plans, foundations and endowments, high net worth individuals and mutual funds. Effective July 1, 2019, VCH acquired AMCO from its parent company and Victory Capital became the adviser to the Funds.
Subject to the authority of the Board, the Adviser is responsible for the overall management and administration of the Funds’ business affairs. Victory Capital is responsible for selecting each Fund’s investments according to the Fund’s investment objective, policies, and restrictions. Victory Capital is a diversified global asset manager comprised of multiple investment teams, referred to as investment franchises, each of which utilizes an independent approach to investing. The Advisory Agreement also authorizes Victory Capital to retain one or more Subadvisers for the management of all or a portion of a Fund’s investment. Under the Advisory Agreement, the Adviser is responsible for monitoring the services furnished pursuant to the Subadvisory Agreements and making recommendations to the Board with respect to the retention or replacement of Subadvisers and renewal of Subadvisory Agreements.
Advisory Agreement
Under the Advisory Agreement, the Adviser provides an investment program, carries out the investment policy, and manages the portfolio assets for each Fund. The Adviser is authorized, subject to the control of the Board of the Trust, to determine the selection, amount, and time to buy or sell securities for each Fund.
For these services under this agreement, each Fund has agreed to pay the Adviser a fee computed as described under Organization and Management of the Fund in the prospectus. Management fees are computed and accrued daily and are payable monthly. The Adviser compensates all personnel, officers, and Trustees of the Trust if such persons are also employees of the Adviser or its affiliates.
The management fees of each Fund (except the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory Extended Market Index Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund) are based upon two components: (1) a base investment management fee, which is accrued daily and paid monthly, computed at an annual rate based on the average daily net assets of the Fund and (2) a performance adjustment that will be added to or subtracted from the base investment management fee depending upon the performance of the Fund relative to a relevant Lipper Index. Each Fund’s performance will be compared to the Lipper Index as listed below:
72

Fund
Lipper Index
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
Large-Cap Growth Funds Index
Victory Capital Growth Fund
Global Funds Index
Victory Growth Fund
Large-Cap Growth Funds Index
Victory Growth & Income Fund
Multi-Cap Core Funds Index
Victory High Income Fund
High Yield Bond Funds Index
Victory Income Fund
A Rated Bond Funds Index
Victory Income Stock Fund
Equity Income Funds Index
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
Core Plus Bond Funds Index
Victory Science & Technology Fund
Science & Technology Funds Index
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Short Investment Grade Debt Funds Index
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
Small-Cap Core Funds Index
Victory Value Fund
Multi-Cap Value Funds Index
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
Ultra Short Obligations Funds Index
With respect to the Victory Money Market Fund, Victory Extended Market Index Fund, Victory 500 Index Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund, the management fee does not include a performance adjustment.
Except for the services and facilities provided by the Adviser, the Funds pay all other expenses incurred in their operations. Expenses for which the Funds are responsible include taxes (if any); brokerage commissions on portfolio transactions (if any); expenses of issuance and redemption of shares; charges of transfer agents, custodians, and dividend disbursing agents; cost of preparing and distributing proxy material and all other expenses incidental to holding meetings of shareholders, including proxy solicitations therefor, unless otherwise required; auditing and legal expenses; certain expenses of registering and qualifying shares for sale; fees of Trustees who are not interested persons (not affiliated) of the Adviser; administrator, custodian, pricing and bookkeeping, registrar and transfer agent fees and expenses; fees and expenses related to the registration and qualification of the Funds’ shares for distribution under state and federal securities laws; expenses of typesetting for printing prospectuses and SAIs and supplements thereto expenses of printing and mailing these sent to existing shareholders; (xi) insurance premiums for fidelity bonds and other coverage to the extent approved by the Trust’s Board of Trustees; (xii) association membership dues authorized by the Trust’s Board of Trustees; and (xiii) such non-recurring or extraordinary expenses as may arise, including those relating to actions, suits or proceedings to which the Trust is a party (or to which the Funds’ assets are subject) and any legal obligation for which the Trust may have to provide indemnification to the Trust’s Trustees and officers.
The Advisory Agreement provides that the Adviser shall not be liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or for any loss suffered by the Funds in connection with the performance of the services pursuant thereto, except a loss resulting from a breach of fiduciary duty with respect to the receipt of compensation for services or a loss resulting from willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence on the part of the Adviser in the performance of its duties, or from reckless disregard by the Adviser of its duties and obligations thereunder.
The Advisory Agreement will remain in effect until June 30, 2024, for each Fund and will continue in effect from year to year thereafter for each Fund as long as it is approved at least annually (i) by a vote of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund (as defined by the 1940 Act) or by the Board (on behalf of the Fund), and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons of the Adviser or (otherwise than as Trustees) of the Trust cast, at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval. The Advisory Agreement may be terminated at any time, without payment of any penalty, by either the Trust or Victory Capital on 60 days’ written notice and will automatically terminate in the event of its assignment (as defined by the 1940 Act).
The following management fees were paid to Victory Capital for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
$7,395,108
$4,494,780
$7,562,434
Victory Growth Fund
$14,717,827
$9,313,430
$19,517,837
Victory Growth & Income Fund
$10,541,011
$6,573,537
$10,563,718
Victory Income Stock Fund
$12,904,056
$9,333,484
$13,085,157
Victory Income Fund
$14,776,228
$11,616,613
$12,636,687
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$6,181,908
$4,753,547
$7,276,805
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$7,243,693
$4,944,180
$10,766,646
Victory Money Market Fund
$4,884,936
$3,493,465
$4,530,553
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$13,027,236
$8,537,494
$13,066,617
73

Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory High Income Fund
$4,907,255
$3,353,909
$5,505,582
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$6,479,808
$5,202,670
$9,147,506
Victory Capital Growth Fund
$6,647,863
$4,620,032
$6,426,946
Victory Value Fund
$7,864,427
$5,371,227
$7,183,499
The following management fees were paid to Victory Capital for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended December 31, 2022.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
$721,638
$230,865
$770,386
Victory 500 Index Fund
$10,616,123
$3,103,379
$9,512,586
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
$10,845,252
$2,661,683
$7,531,191
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
$3,024,607
$974,374
$3,051,889
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$847,395
$278,511
$826,684
Fee Waiver and Expense Reimbursements
The Adviser has contractually agreed to reimburse expenses so that the total annual operating expenses (excluding certain items such as acquired fund fees and expenses, interest, taxes, brokerage commissions, capitalized expenses, and other extraordinary expenses) do not exceed a certain amount for each Fund through at least August 31, 2025. The Adviser is permitted to recoup any reimbursed expenses for up to three years after the date of the waiver or reimbursement took place, subject to the lesser of any operating expense limits in effect at the time of: (a) the original expense reimbursement; or (b) the recoupment, after giving effect to the recoupment amount. This agreement may only be terminated by the Funds’ Board of Trustees.
From time to time, the Adviser may, without prior notice to shareholders, waive all or any portion of fees or agree to reimburse expenses incurred by a Fund.
For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, Victory Capital reimbursed the Funds as follows:
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
$14,042
$16,978
$10,479
Victory Growth Fund
$19,212
$56,235
$
Victory Growth & Income Fund
$32,264
$28,528
$30,533
Victory Income Stock Fund
$50,138
$73,002
$47,484
Victory Income Fund
$226,203
$279,501
$25,015
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$62,374
$75,635
$18,832
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$735
$29,646
$
Victory Money Market Fund
$38,321
$56,004
$5,161,726
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$449,113
$403,945
$275,614
Victory High Income Fund
$96,204
$123,523
$95,371
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$71,740
$86,278
$72,855
Victory Capital Growth Fund
$13,280
$13,141
$12,945
Victory Value Fund
$46,115
$40,435
$33,107
For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended December 31, 2022, Victory Capital reimbursed the Funds as follows:
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory 500 Index Fund
$2,571,602
$937,034
$2,034,099
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
$52,605
$13,545
$31,633
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
$391,011
$174,609
$404,981
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$42,208
$27,171
$126,677
For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, Victory Capital recouped management fees previously waived and/or reimbursed in the amounts listed in the table below.
74

Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Growth Fund Institutional Shares
$26,059
$
$
Victory Income Stock Fund Institutional Shares
$9,844
$
$
Victory Income Fund Institutional Shares
$35,407
$274
$
Victory Income Fund Shares
$14,000
$
$
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Shares
$17,525
$
$
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Class R6
$
$
$15,906
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Institutional Shares
$42,636
$
$
Victory Science & Technology Fund Shares
$31,382
$49
$
Victory Money Market Fund Shares
$4,712
$
$
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class A
$5,542
$
$
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class C
$375
$
$
Victory High Income Fund Shares
$25,568
$
$
Victory Capital Growth Fund Shares
$
$3,059
$56,806
Victory Value Fund Institutional Shares
$772
$
$
Victory Value Fund Shares
$
$
$48,267
For the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, Victory Capital recouped management fees previously waived and/or reimbursed in the amounts listed in the table below.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory 500 Index Fund Member Shares
$5,620
$–
$
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Institutional Shares
$
$–
$4,867
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Institutional Shares
$16,500
$–
$14,618
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Class R6
$609
$–
$54
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Shares
$8,616
$–
$
Computing the Performance Adjustment
For any month, the base investment management fee of each Fund will equal the Fund’s average daily net assets for that month multiplied by the annual base investment management fee rate for the Fund, multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days in the month and the denominator of which is 365 (366 in leap years). The Investment Advisory Agreement with Victory Capital permits calculation and application of the performance adjustment (1) on a class-by-class basis or (2) by designating a single share class of a Fund for purposes to calculate the performance adjustment, and then applying the same performance adjustment to each other class of shares of the Fund. The performance adjustment is currently calculated separately for each share class on a monthly basis and is added to or subtracted from the base investment management fee depending upon the performance over the performance period of the respective share class relative to the performance of each Fund's relevant Lipper Index. The methodology for calculating the performance adjustment may change in the future, as approved by the Board of the Trust and consistent with the terms of the Investment Advisory Agreement.
The performance period for each Fund consists of the current month plus the previous 35 months (or the number of months since the date of the investment advisory agreement, if shorter). The annual performance adjustment rate is multiplied by the average daily net assets of the Fund over the performance period, which is then multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days in the month and the denominator of which is 365 (366 in leap years). The resulting amount is then added to (in the case of overperformance) or subtracted from (in the case of underperformance) the base investment management fee as referenced in the chart below:
Fixed Income Funds:
Victory High Income Fund
Victory Income Fund
Victory Intermediate-Term Bond Fund
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
75

Over/Under Performance
Relative to Index
(in basis points) 1
Annual Adjustment Rate
(in basis points as a percentage
of a Fund’s average daily net assets)
+/- 20 to 50
+/– 4
+/– 51 to 100
+/– 5
+/– 101 and greater
+/– 6
1 Based on the difference between the average annual performance of the relevant share class of the Fund and its relevant Lipper index, rounded to the nearest basis point. The performance adjustment rate included in the investment advisory fee may differ from the maximum over/under Annual Adjustment Rate due to differences in average net assets for the reporting period and rolling 36-month performance period.
Equity Funds:
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
Victory Value Fund
Victory Growth Fund
Victory Growth & Income Fund
Victory Income Stock Fund
Victory Science & Technology Fund
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
Victory Capital Growth Fund
Over/Under Performance
Relative to Index
(in basis points) 1
Annual Adjustment Rate
(in basis points as a percentage
of a Fund’s average daily net assets)
+/– 100 to 400
+/– 4
+/– 401 to 700
+/– 5
+/– 701 and greater
+/– 6
1
Based on the difference between average annual performance of the relevant share class of the Fund and its relevant Lipper index, rounded to the nearest basis point. The performance adjustment rate included in the investment advisory fee may differ from the maximum over/under Annual Adjustment Rate due to differences in average net assets for the reporting period and rolling 36-month performance period.
Each Fund measures its investment performance by comparing the beginning and ending redeemable value of an investment in the Fund during the measurement period, assuming the reinvestment of dividends and capital gain distributions during the period. Lipper uses this same methodology when it measures the investment performance of the component mutual funds within the respective Lipper Index. Because the adjustment to the base investment management fee is based upon the Fund’s performance compared to the investment record of its Lipper Index, the controlling factor as to whether a performance adjustment will be made is not whether the Fund’s performance is up or down per se, but whether it is up or down more or less than the record of its respective Lipper Index. Moreover, the comparative investment performance of the Fund is based solely on the relevant performance period without regard to the cumulative performance over a longer or shorter period of time.
For Funds that offer multiple classes of shares, the performance adjustment is determined on a class-by-class basis. In some circumstances, the Adviser has agreed to waive certain expenses of the Funds, the impact of which may be to increase the performance of those Funds. Any corresponding increase in the performance of a Fund may contribute to a positive performance adjustment.
Subadvisory Agreements
The Manager has entered into Subadvisory Agreements dated July 1, 2019, with Granahan Investment Management, LLC (“GIM”), Wellington Management Company LLP (“Wellington Management”), and Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P. (“Loomis Sayles”) under which each Subadviser is engaged to provide day-to-day discretionary management of the portion of the applicable Fund’s assets allocated to it by the Manager. Each Subadviser will manage the applicable Fund’s assets in accordance with that Fund’s investment objective(s), policies, and restrictions, subject to the general supervision of the Manager and the Board. The Manager may allocate all, a portion, or none of a Fund’s assets to a Subadviser in its discretion.
Each Subadvisory Agreement will remain in effect with respect to a Fund until June 30, 2024. Each Subadvisory Agreement will continue in effect from year to year thereafter for each Fund as long as it is approved at least annually (i) by a vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Fund (as defined by the 1940 Act) or by the Board (on behalf of the Fund) and (ii) by vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons of Victory Capital or (otherwise than as Trustees) of the Trust, at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval. Each Subadvisory Agreement may be terminated, without penalty, with respect to a Fund at any time by vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of a Fund (as defined in the 1940 Act) on 60 days’ written notice; by Victory Capital at any time; or by the applicable Subadviser on 90 days’ written notice. Each Subadvisory Agreement will automatically terminate in the event of its assignment (as defined by the 1940 Act).
76

GIM, located at 404 Wyman Street, Waltham, Massachusetts 02451, is an independent, employee-owned firm founded in 1985 by investment professionals with a passion for small capitalization equity investing. The firm remains committed to the smaller cap area of the market and has dedicated its investment expertise to serving institutions and family offices.
Loomis Sayles is a Delaware limited partnership. Loomis Sayles’ sole general partner, Loomis, Sayles & Company, Inc. is directly owned by Natixis Investment Managers, LLC. (“Natixis LLC”). Natixis LLC is an indirect subsidiary of Natixis Investment Managers, an international asset management group based in Paris, France, that is in turn owned by Natixis, a French investment banking and financial services firm. Natixis is wholly-owned by BPCE, France’s second largest banking group. BPCE is owned by banks comprising two autonomous and complementary retail banking networks consisting of the Caisse d’Epargne regional savings banks and the Banque Populaire regional cooperative banks. The registered address of Natixis is 30, avenue Pierre Mendès France, 75013 Paris, France. The registered address of BPCE is 50, avenue Pierre Mendès France, 75013 Paris, France. Loomis Sayles is headquartered at One Financial Center, Boston, Massachusetts 02111. Loomis Sayles has served the needs of institutional, high-net-worth, and mutual fund clients for more than 90 years.
Wellington Management is a Delaware limited liability partnership with principal offices at 280 Congress Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02210. Wellington Management is a professional investment counseling firm, which provides investment services to investment companies, employee benefit plans, endowments, foundations, and other institutions. Wellington Management and its predecessor organizations have provided investment advisory services for over 90 years. Wellington Management is owned by the partners of Wellington Management Group LLP, a Massachusetts limited liability partnership.
Prior to March 19, 2021, Wellington Management served as a Subadviser of the Victory Small Cap Stock Fund. Victory Capital paid the following aggregate subadvisory fees for the subadvised Funds for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, as follows:
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Growth Fund
$2,288,790
$1,440,044
$2,304,517
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$534,445
$498,722
$1,203,743
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$861,157
$617,011
$1,267,179
Administration, Servicing, and Accounting Agreement
Under a Fund Administration, Servicing, and Accounting Agreement effective July 1, 2019 (“Administration Agreement”), Victory Capital is obligated on a continuous basis to provide such administrative services as the Board reasonably deems necessary for the proper administration of the Funds. Victory Capital may delegate one or more of its responsibilities to others at its expense. Citi Fund Services of Ohio, Inc. (“Citi”) serves as sub-administrator and sub-fund accountant to the Trust pursuant to an agreement with Victory Capital, as disclosed in greater detail under “Sub-Administrator and Sub-Fund Accountant.” As administrator, Victory Capital supervises the Trust’s operations, including the services that Citi provides to the Funds as sub-administrator, but excluding those that Victory Capital provides as investment adviser, all subject to the supervision of the Board.
Victory Capital coordinates the preparation, filing, and distribution of amendments to the Trust’s registration statement on Form N-1A, supplements to prospectuses and SAIs, and proxy materials in connection with shareholder meetings; drafts shareholder communications, including annual and semi annual reports; administers the Trust’s other service provider contracts; monitors compliance with investment restrictions imposed by the 1940 Act, each Fund’s investment objective, defined investment policies, and restrictions, tax diversification, and distribution and income requirements; coordinates the Funds’ service arrangements with financial institutions that make the Funds’ shares available to their customers; assists with regulatory compliance; supplies individuals to serve as Trust officers; prepares Board meeting materials; and annually determines whether the services that it provides (or the services that Citi provides as sub-administrator) are adequate and complete.
Victory Capital also performs fund accounting services for each Fund. In addition, the Funds may reimburse Victory Capital for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in providing the services and certain other expenses specifically allocated to the Funds under the Administration Agreement.
The Administration Agreement provides that Victory Capital shall not be liable for any action or inaction, except for any action or inaction constituting willful misfeasance, bad faith, or negligence in the performance of its duties hereunder or the reckless disregard of such duties.
For these services under the Administration Agreement, the Trust has agreed to pay Victory Capital a fee computed daily and paid monthly, as indicated in the table below.
77

Fund/Class
Fee
 
(% of average daily net assets)
Victory Money Market Fund
0.10%
Fund Shares of:
0.15%, calculated and paid separately for each Fund’s Fund Shares
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
 
Victory Capital Growth Fund
 
Victory Growth Fund
 
Victory Growth & Income Fund
 
Victory High Income Fund
 
Victory Income Fund
 
Victory Income Stock Fund
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
 
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Science & Technology Fund
 
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
 
Victory Value Fund
 
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Class A shares of:
0.15%, calculated and paid separately for each Fund’s Class A shares
Victory Growth & Income Fund
 
Victory High Income Fund
 
Victory Income Fund
 
Victory Intermediate-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Science & Technology Fund
 
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Value Fund
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Class C shares of:
0.15%, calculated and paid separately for each Fund’s Class C shares
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
Institutional Shares of:
0.10%, calculated and paid separately for each Fund’s Institutional Shares
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
 
Victory Capital Growth Fund
 
Victory Growth Fund
 
Victory Growth & Income Fund
 
Victory Income Fund
 
Victory Income Stock Fund
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
 
Victory High Income Fund
 
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
 
Victory Value Fund
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
0.05%, calculated and paid separately for the Fund's Institutional Shares
78

Fund/Class
Fee
Class R6 shares of:
0.05%, calculated and paid separately for each Fund’s Class R6 shares
Victory High Income Fund
 
Victory Income Fund
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
 
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
 
Member Shares of:
 
Victory 500 Index Fund
0.06%
Reward Shares of:
 
Victory 500 Index Fund
0.06%
The following administration and servicing fees were paid to Victory Capital for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended July 31, 2022.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund Shares
$2,812,639
$1,692,006
$2,999,439
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund Institutional Shares
$4,945
$2,270
$15,789
Victory Growth Fund Shares
$2,745,659
$1,664,484
$2,907,149
Victory Growth Fund Institutional Shares
$433,842
$430,503
$1,291,698
Victory Growth & Income Fund Shares
$2,628,530
$1,773,304
$2,750,560
Victory Growth & Income Fund Institutional Shares
$3,691
$3,435
$59,865
Victory Growth & Income Fund Class A
$319
$854
$1,174
Victory Income Stock Fund Shares
$2,461,758
$1,825,809
$2,601,260
Victory Income Stock Fund Institutional Shares
$834,881
$649,491
$1,079,756
Victory Income Fund Shares
$3,192,000
$2,573,427
$4,193,336
Victory Income Fund Institutional Shares
$2,438,997
$1,945,336
$3,702,735
Victory Income Fund Class A
$71,043
$59,839
$101,729
Victory Income Fund Class R6
$4,193
$2,330
$3,789
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Shares
$1,217,695
$990,599
$1,474,018
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Institutional Shares
$1,383,508
$1,042,462
$1,851,420
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Class A
$23,852
$16,136
$22,156
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Class R6
$93,810
$55,562
$29,550
Victory Science & Technology Fund Shares
$1,545,975
$1,073,676
$2,226,473
Victory Science & Technology Fund Class A
$74,616
$55,442
$121,643
Victory Money Market Fund
$2,035,391
$1,455,612
$1,887,727
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Shares
$2,135,485
$1,620,679
$2,620,205
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Institutional Shares
$1,728,603
$1,009,147
$1,641,873
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class A
$107,829
$59,751
$73,253
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class C
$6,886
$1,870
$3,396
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class R6
$202,830
$76,327
$68,802
Victory High Income Fund Shares
$1,118,208
$841,898
$1,315,304
Victory High Income Fund Institutional Shares
$274,922
$197,723
$405,221
Victory High Income Fund Class A
$2,932
$2,408
$3,560
Victory High Income Fund Class R6
$483
$288
$221
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund Shares
$856,975
$660,903
$1,090,291
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund Institutional Shares
$354,199
$268,660
$438,322
Victory Capital Growth Fund Shares
$1,255,747
$872,064
$1,298,488
Victory Capital Growth Fund Institutional Shares
$2,077
$1,745
$2,145
Victory Value Fund Shares
$1,109,274
$823,897
$1,212,684
Victory Value Fund Institutional Shares
$455,853
$308,718
$350,303
Victory Value Fund Class A
$1,035
$115
$171
79

The following administration and servicing fees were paid to Victory Capital for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and the fiscal year ended December 31, 2022, as follows.
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Extended Market Index Fund Shares
$1,082,458
$346,297
$1,155,586
Victory 500 Index Fund Member Shares
$2,421,959
$708,309
$2,231,361
Victory 500 Index Fund Reward Shares
$3,947,715
$1,153,718
$3,476,160
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Shares
$6,555,578
$1,607,573
$5,176,191
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Institutional Shares
$735,213
$209,908
$250,207
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Class A
$69,862
$10,188
$25,135
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Class C
$15,642
$2,064
$4,319
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Class R6
$130,013
$20,525
$22,475
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund Shares
$14,562
$4,604
$15,087
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund Institutional Shares
$247,196
$79,663
$249,298
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Shares
$238,882
$82,609
$281,965
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Institutional Shares
$145,149
$39,979
$102,536
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Class A
$401
$67
$833
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Class R6
$5,126
$817
$1,587
Sub-Administrator and Sub-Fund Accountant
Citi serves as sub-administrator and sub-fund accountant to the Funds pursuant to a Sub-Administration and Sub-Fund Accounting Agreement dated October 1, 2015, as amended, by and between Victory Capital and Citi. Citi assists in supervising all operations of the Funds (other than those performed by Victory Capital either as investment adviser or administrator), subject to the supervision of the Board.
Under the Sub-Administration and Sub-Fund Accounting Agreement, for the sub-administration services that Citi renders to the Funds, other series of the Trust, and the series of Victory Portfolios (“VP”), Victory Portfolios II (“VPII”), and Victory Variable Insurance Funds (“VVIF”), Victory Capital pays Citi a fee for providing these services. Citi may periodically waive all or a portion of the amount of its fee that is allocated to any Fund in order to increase the net income of the Funds available for distribution to shareholders. In addition, the Trust, VP, VPII, and VVIF reimburse Victory Capital and Citi for all of its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in providing these services and certain other expenses specifically allocated to the Funds under the Sub-Administration and Sub-Fund Accounting Agreement.
The Sub-Administration and Sub-Fund Accounting Agreement provides that Citi shall not be liable for any error of judgment or mistake of law or any loss suffered by the Trust in connection with the matters to which the Agreement relates, except a loss resulting from bad faith, willful misfeasance, negligence, or reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Agreement.
Under the Sub-Administration and Sub-Fund Accounting Agreement, Citi calculates Trust expenses and makes disbursements; calculates capital gain and distribution information; registers the Funds’ shares with the states; prepares shareholder reports and reports to the SEC on Forms N-CEN, N-PORT, N-MFP, and N-CSR; coordinates dividend payments; calculates the Funds’ performance information; files the Trust’s tax returns; supplies individuals to serve as Trust officers; monitors the Funds’ status as regulated investment companies under the Code; assists in developing portfolio compliance procedures; reports to the Board amounts paid under shareholder service agreements; assists with regulatory compliance; obtains, maintains and files fidelity bonds and Trustees’ and officers’/errors and omissions insurance policies for the Trust; and assists in the annual audit of the Funds.
Custodian
Citibank, N.A., 388 Greenwich St., New York, New York 10013, is the custodian for the Funds. The custodian is responsible for, among other things, safeguarding and controlling each Fund’s cash and securities, handling the receipt and delivery of securities, processing the pricing of each Fund’s securities, and collecting interest on the Funds’ investments. In addition, assets of the Funds may be held by certain foreign subcustodians and foreign securities depositories as agents of the custodian in accordance with the rules and regulations established by the SEC.
Transfer Agent
Victory Capital Transfer Agency, Inc. (the “Transfer Agent”), 15935 La Cantera Parkway, San Antonio, Texas 78256, an affiliate of the Adviser, performs transfer agent services for the Trust under a Transfer Agency Agreement. Services include maintenance of shareholder account records, handling of communications with shareholders, distribution of Fund dividends, and production of reports with respect to account activity for shareholders and the Trust.
80

For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Fund Shares of each fund (excluding the Victory Money Market Fund) pay the Transfer Agent an annual fixed fee of $23 to $25.50 per shareholder account. The Victory 500 Index Fund Member Shares and Reward Shares pay the Transfer Agent an annual fixed fee of $20 per account. The fee is subject to change at any time.
For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, each Class A shares (formerly, Adviser Shares) and Class C shares pays the Transfer Agent a fee computed daily and paid monthly, at an annual rate equal to one-tenth of one percent (0.10%) of the average net assets.
For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent receives a fee computed daily and paid monthly, at an annual rate equal to five one-hundredths of one percent (0.05%) of the average daily net assets per account for the Institutional Shares of the Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund and one-tenth of one percent (0.10%) of the average net assets from the Institutional Shares of each of the Victory Aggressive Growth Fund, Victory Capital Growth Fund, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund, Victory Growth & Income Fund, Victory Growth Fund, Victory Income Stock Fund, Victory Income Fund, Victory High Income Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, Victory Small Cap Stock Fund, Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund, and Victory Value Fund; and one-fourth of one percent (0.25%) of the average net assets from the Victory Money Market Fund.
For its services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, the Transfer Agent receives a fee computed daily and paid monthly, at an annual rate equal to one-hundredth of one percent (0.01%) of the average net assets from the Class R6 shares of each of the Victory Income Fund, Victory High Income Fund, Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund, Victory Short-Term Bond Fund, Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund, and Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund.
In addition to these fees, the Transfer Agent also is entitled to reimbursement from the Trust for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, charges and other disbursements incurred by it in connection with the performance of services under the Transfer Agency Agreement, including but not limited to: (1) the cost of any and all forms, statements, labels, envelopes, checks, tax forms, and other printed materials which is required by the Transfer Agent to perform its duties; (2) delivery charges, including postage incurred in delivering materials to, and receiving them from, the Trust and shareholders; (3) communication charges; (4) maintenance of shareholder records (including charges for retention and imaging); (5) tax reporting systems; (6) counsel fees; and (7) cash and asset management services.  The fee paid to the Transfer Agent includes processing of all transactions and correspondence. Fees are billed on a monthly basis at the rate of one-twelfth of the annual fee. Each Fund pays all out-of-pocket expenses of the Transfer Agent and other expenses specifically allocated to the Funds that are incurred at the specific direction of the Trust. Fees paid under the Transfer Agency Agreement are subject to change at any time.
The Transfer Agent is authorized to enter into arrangements with third-party service providers to provide a portion or all of the functions under the Transfer Agency Agreement. For accounts held with third-party intermediaries, the Trust pays the Transfer Agent the same fees that would have been paid to the Transfer Agent if all the accounts had been maintained by the Transfer Agent. The intermediaries may receive payments directly or indirectly from the Transfer Agent, the Adviser, or their affiliates for providing services to their clients who hold Fund shares.
Sub-Transfer Agent
Under its agreement with the Trust, the Transfer Agent may delegate one or more of its responsibilities to others at its expense. The Transfer Agent has engaged FIS Investor Services LLC (“FIS”), 4249 Easton Way, Suite 400, Columbus, Ohio 43219, to serve as sub-transfer agent and dividend disbursing agent for the Funds. Under its agreement with the Transfer Agent, FIS has agreed to (1) issue and redeem shares of the Funds; (2) address and mail all communications by the Funds to their shareholders, including reports to shareholders, dividend and distribution notices and proxy material for its meetings of shareholders; (3) respond to correspondence or inquiries by shareholders and others relating to its duties; (4) maintain shareholder accounts and certain sub-accounts; and (5) make periodic reports to the Board concerning the Funds’ operations.
Underwriter and Distributor
The Trust has an agreement with Victory Capital Services, Inc. (“VCS”), 4900 Tiedeman Road, Brooklyn, Ohio 44144, an affiliate of the Adviser, for exclusive underwriting and distribution of each Fund's shares on a continuing, best efforts basis. This agreement provides that VCS will receive no fee or other compensation for such distribution services, but may receive 12b-1 fees with respect to Class A and Class C shares.
Securities Lending
The Funds, through a Securities Lending Agreement with Citibank, N.A. (“Citibank”), may lend its securities to qualified financial institutions, such as certain broker-dealers and banks, to earn additional income, net of income retained by Citibank. Borrowers are required to initially secure their loans for collateral in the amount of at least 102% of the value of U.S. securities loaned or at least 105% of the value of non-U.S. securities loaned, marked-to-market daily. Any collateral shortfalls associated with increases in the valuation
81

of the securities loaned generally are cured the next business day. The collateral can be received in the form of cash collateral and/or non-cash collateral. Non-cash collateral can include U.S. government securities and other securities as permitted by Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) guidelines. The cash collateral is invested in short-term instruments or cash equivalents, primarily open-end investment companies. The Funds effectively do not have control of the non-cash collateral. Collateral requirements are determined daily based on the value of a Fund’s securities on loan as of the end of the prior business day. During the time portfolio securities are on loan, the borrower will pay the Fund any dividends or interest paid on such securities plus any fee negotiated between the parties to the lending agreement. A Fund also earns a return from the collateral. A Fund pays Citibank various fees in connection with the investment of cash collateral and fees based on the investment income received from securities lending activities. Loans are terminable upon demand and the borrower must return the loaned securities within the lesser of one standard settlement period or five business days. Although risk is mitigated by the collateral, a Fund could experience a delay in recovering its securities and possible loss of income or value if the borrower fails to return them. In addition, there is a risk that the value of the short-term investments will be less than the amount of cash collateral required to be returned to the borrower.
The Funds’ agreement with Citibank does not include master netting provisions. Non-cash collateral received by a Fund may not be sold or repledged, except to satisfy borrower default.
The Funds pay various fees in connection with the investment of cash collateral. The Funds pay Citibank fees based on the investment income received from securities lending activities. In its role as securities lending agent, Citibank (i) arranges and administers the loan of securities when establishing a loan and the return of securities upon termination of a loan, (ii) collects from borrowers cash, securities or other instruments to serve as collateral for the loans, (iii) monitors the value of securities on loan and the value of the corresponding collateral, (iv) communicates to each borrower the minimum amount of collateral required for each loan and collects additional collateral as required on a daily basis to maintain such minimum, (v) collects or arranges for the collection of any interest, dividends or other distributions related to loaned securities, and (vi) performs other necessary services related to the establishment and maintenance of the Funds’ securities lending program.
The Victory Money Market Fund did not engage in any securities lending activities. The following reflects the dollar amounts of income and fees/compensation related to the Funds’ securities lending activities during the Funds’ fiscal year ended April 30, 2024:
Fund
Gross Income
from securities
lending activities
Fees paid to
securities lending
agent from a
revenue split
Rebate
(paid to
borrower)
Aggregate
fees/compensation
for securities
lending activities
Net income
from securities
lending
activities
Victory Aggressive
Growth Fund
$119,321
$374
$115,589
$115,963
$3,358
Victory Growth Fund
$385,172
$1,513
$370,042
$371,555
$13,617
Victory Growth &
Income Fund
$106,046
$5,669
$46,272
$51,941
$54,105
Victory Income Stock
Fund
$663,606
$54,583
$107,447
$162,030
$501,576
Victory Income Fund
$1,949,111
$50,357
$1,441,539
$1,491,896
$457,215
Victory Short-Term
Bond Fund
$552,191
$10,051
$451,253
$461,304
$90,887
Victory Science &
Technology Fund
$810,136
$23,891
$570,373
$594,264
$215,872
Victory Core Plus
Intermediate Bond
Fund
$1,283,498
$13,849
$1,145,134
$1,158,983
$124,515
Victory High Income
Fund
$1,910,036
$61,006
$1,296,666
$1,357,672
$552,364
Victory Small Cap
Stock Fund
$794,255
$19,892
$594,288
$614,180
$180,075
Victory Capital
Growth Fund
$413,298
$35,394
$57,925
$93,319
$319,979
Victory Value Fund
$96,601
$2,949
$67,017
$69,966
$26,635
Victory Extended
Market Index Fund
$1,629,175
$85,680
$764,219
$849,899
$779,276
Victory 500 Index
Fund
$548,189
$30,193
$243,771
$273,964
$274,225
Victory Nasdaq-100
Index Fund
$2,904,313
$227,325
$623,383
$850,708
$2,053,605
82

Fund
Gross Income
from securities
lending activities
Fees paid to
securities lending
agent from a
revenue split
Rebate
(paid to
borrower)
Aggregate
fees/compensation
for securities
lending activities
Net income
from securities
lending
activities
Victory Global
Managed Volatility
Fund
$125,992
$5,039
$74,341
$79,380
$46,612
Victory Ultra
Short-Term Bond
Fund
$139,804
$3,562
$103,920
$107,482
$32,322
Compliance Services
Effective July 1, 2019, as amended on July 1, 2021, the Trust entered into an Agreement to Provide Compliance Services (“Compliance Agreement”) with the Adviser, pursuant to which the Adviser furnishes its compliance personnel, including the services of the CCO, and other resources reasonably necessary to provide the Trust with compliance oversight services related to the design, administration, and oversight of a compliance program for the Trust in accordance with Rule 38a-1 under the 1940 Act. The Funds in the Victory Funds complex, in the aggregate, compensate the Adviser for these services.
The Funds paid Victory Capital for compliance and legal services for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, as follows:
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
$16,876
$11,133
$14,814
Victory Growth Fund
$20,478
$15,649
$23,692
Victory Growth & Income Fund
$16,028
$11,617
$13,962
Victory Income Stock Fund
$22,895
$18,326
$20,631
Victory Income Fund
$43,090
$36,370
$48,795
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$22,125
$17,931
$21,405
Victory Science & Technology Fund
$9,836
$7,447
$11,649
Victory Money Market Fund
$18,756
$13,979
$13,967
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$32,793
$22,298
$26,425
Victory High Income Fund
$9,441
$7,476
$9,662
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$8,688
$6,874
$8,676
Victory Capital Growth Fund
$7,697
$5,678
$6,363
Victory Value Fund
$11,053
$8,306
$8,468
The Funds paid Victory Capital for compliance and legal services for the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, the fiscal period ended April 30, 2023, and fiscal year ended July 31, 2022, as follows:
Fund
2024
2023
2022
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
$6,673
$2,271
$6,711
Victory 500 Index Fund
$96,658
$30,255
$81,790
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund
$48,285
$13,053
$32,314
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
$4,646
$1,585
$4,389
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$2,893
$965
$2,488
Legal Counsel
K&L Gates LLP, 1601 K Street, N.W., Washington, DC 20006, reviews certain legal matters for the Trust in connection with the shares offered by the prospectus.
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Ernst & Young LLP, 111 West Houston Street, Suite 1901, San Antonio, Texas 78205, is the independent registered public accounting firm for the Funds. In this capacity, the firm is responsible for the audits of the annual financial statements of each Fund.
83

Codes of Ethics
Each of the Trust, the Adviser, and the Distributor has adopted a Code of Ethics in accordance with Rule 17j-1 under the 1940 Act. The Adviser Code of Ethics applies to all Access Personnel (the Adviser’s directors, officers, and employees with investment advisory duties) and all Supervised Personnel (all of the Adviser’s directors, officers, and employees). Each Code of Ethics provides that Access Personnel must refrain from certain trading practices. Each Code of Ethics also requires all Access Personnel (and, in the Adviser Code of Ethics, all Supervised Personnel) to report certain personal investment activities, including, but not limited to, purchases or sales of securities that may be purchased or held by the Funds. Violations of any Code of Ethics can result in penalties, suspension, or termination of employment.
Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures
In accordance with the 1940 Act, the Trust has adopted policies and procedures for voting proxies related to equity securities held by the Funds (the “Proxy Voting Policy”). The Trust’s Proxy Voting Policy is designed to: (i) ensure that proxies are voted in the best interests of shareholders of the Funds with a view toward maximizing the value of their investments; (ii) address conflicts of interests between these shareholders, on the one hand, and affiliates of the Fund, the Adviser or the Distributor, on the other, that may arise regarding the voting of proxies; and (iii) provide for the disclosure of the Funds’ proxy voting records and the Proxy Voting Policy.
The Proxy Voting Policy delegates to the Adviser the obligation to vote the Funds’ proxies in the best interests of the Funds and their shareholders, subject to oversight by the Board. The Board has authorized the Adviser to delegate proxy voting authority with respect to a subadvised Fund to that Fund’s subadviser. Pursuant to such delegations, each of GIM, Loomis Sayles, and Wellington Management is authorized to vote proxies on behalf of the applicable Fund or Funds for which it serves as subadviser, in accordance with the proxy voting policies and procedures of each such subadviser.
Summaries of the proxy voting policies and procedures for each of the Adviser, GIM, Wellington Management, and Loomis Sayles are included in Appendix B.
The Funds’ Proxy Voting Policy provides that the Funds, in accordance with SEC rules, annually will disclose on Form N-PX the Funds’ proxy voting record. Information regarding how the Funds voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30th is updated each year by August 31st and is available without charge, upon request, by calling toll free (800) 235-8396 or by accessing the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.
Distribution and Service Plans
Multiple Class Information
Each Fund, excluding the Victory Money Market Fund and Victory Extended Market Index Fund, is comprised of multiple classes of shares. Each class has a common investment objective and investment portfolio. The classes have different fees, expenses and/or minimum investment and eligibility requirements. The difference in the fee structures between the classes is the result of their separate arrangements for shareholder and distribution services and other expenses attributable to the particular class. It is not the result of any difference in advisory or custodial fee rate schedules or other expenses related to the management of the Funds' assets, which generally do not vary by class.
Except as described below, the share classes have identical voting, dividend, liquidation and other rights, preferences, terms and conditions. The primary differences between the classes are (a) each class may be subject to different expenses specific to that class; (b) each class has a different identifying designation or name; (c) each class has exclusive voting rights with respect to matters solely affecting that class; and (d) each class may have different purchase, exchange, and redemption privileges.
Rule 12b-1 Distribution and Service Plans
The Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan pursuant to Rule 12b-1 (“Rule 12b-1 Plan”) under the 1940 Act, as amended, with respect to Class A and Class C shares. Under the Rule 12b-1 Plan such fees may cover expenses incurred by the Payee in connection with the distribution and/or servicing of Class A and Class C shares of the Fund and relating (among other things) to:
• compensation to the Payee and its employees;
• payment of the Payee’s expenses, including overhead and communication expenses;
• compensation to broker-dealers, financial intermediaries and other entities to pay or reimburse them for their services or expenses in connection with the distribution of Class A shares;
84

• printing and mailing of prospectuses, SAIs, and reports for prospective shareholders;
• the preparation and distribution of sales literature and advertising materials;
• responding to inquiries from shareholders or their financial representatives requesting information regarding the Victory Funds; and
• responding to inquiries by and correspondence from shareholders regarding ownership of their shares or their accounts.
The Distributor pays all or a portion of such fees to financial intermediaries that make the Class A and Class C shares available for investment by their customers and the Distributor may retain part of this fee as compensation for providing these services. If the fees received by the Distributor under the Rule 12b-1 Plan exceed its expenses, the Distributor may realize a profit from these arrangements. Because these fees are paid out of the Fund’s assets on an ongoing basis, over time these fees will increase the cost of your investment in the Class A or Class C shares and may cost you more than paying other types of sales charges. In addition, because some or all of the fees payable pursuant to the Rule 12b-1 Plan may be used to pay for shareholder services that are not related to prospective sales of the Fund, the Class A and Class C shares may continue to make payments under the Rule 12b-1 Plan even if the Fund terminates the sale of Class A or Class C shares to investors.
Class A Rule 12b-1 Plan. Under the Rule 12b-1 Plan, the Class A share class of each Fund pays a fee at the annual rate of up to 0.25% of that class’s average daily net assets to the Distributor, or such other entities as the Fund’s Board may approve (the Payee), as compensation for rendering services and bearing expenses in connection with activities primarily intended to result in the sale of Class A shares and/or providing services to shareholders of Class A shares. The fee may be split among intermediaries based on the level of services provided. The amount of fees paid by a Class A share class during any year may be more or less than the cost of distribution and other services provided to that class and its shareholders. Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”) rules limit the amount of annual distribution and service fees that may be paid by a mutual fund and impose a ceiling on the cumulative distribution fees paid.
Class C Rule 12b-1 Plan. Under the Rule 12b1- Plan, the Class C share class of the Fund will pay to the Distributor a monthly fee at an annual rate of 1.00% of the average daily net assets of its Class C shares. Of this amount, 0.75% of the Fund’s Class C shares average daily net assets will be paid for general distribution services and for selling Class C shares. The Fund will pay 0.25% of its Class C shares average daily net assets to compensate financial institutions that provide personal services to Class C shareholders of the Fund. Distribution and selling services are provided by the Distributor or by agents of the Distributor and include those services intended to result in the sale of the Fund's Class C shares. Personal services to shareholders generally are provided by broker-dealers or other financial intermediaries and consist of responding to inquiries, providing information to shareholders about their Fund accounts, establishing and maintaining accounts and records, providing dividend and distribution payments, arranging for bank wires, assisting in transactions and changing account information.
Rule 12b-1 Plans. Prior to approving the Rule 12b-1 Plan, the Trustees considered various factors relating to the implementation of the Rule 12b-1 Plan and determined that there is a reasonable likelihood that the Rule 12b-1 Plan will benefit each Fund, its Class A and Class C shares, and the shareholders of the Class A and Class C shares. Among other things, the Trustees noted that, to the extent the Rule 12b-1 Plan allows each Fund to sell Class A and Class C shares in markets to which it would not otherwise have access, the Rule 12b-1 Plan may result in additional sales of Fund shares, including to USAA members who do not hold mutual fund accounts directly with the Adviser, and would enhance the Funds' competitive position in relation to other funds that have implemented or are seeking to implement similar distribution arrangements. In addition, certain ongoing shareholder services may be provided more effectively by intermediaries with which shareholders have an existing relationship.
The plan is renewable from year to year with respect to the Class A and Class C share class of each Fund, so long as its continuance is approved at least annually (1) by the vote of a majority of the Trustees and (2) by a vote of the majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the plan or any Rule 12b-1 related agreements, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval. The Rule 12b-1 Plan may not be amended to increase materially the amount of fees paid by any Class A and Class C share class thereunder unless such amendment is approved by a majority vote of the outstanding shares of such class and by the Trustees in the manner prescribed by Rule 12b-1 under the 1940 Act. The Rule 12b-1 Plan is terminable with respect to any Fund’s Class A and Class C share class at any time by a vote of a majority of the Independent Trustees who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the Rule 12b-1 Plan or any Rule 12b-1 related agreements, or by a majority vote of the outstanding shares in that class. The Rule 12b-1 Plan requires that the Distributor provide, or cause to be provided, a quarterly written report identifying the amounts expended by the Class A and Class C shares and the purposes for which such expenditures were made to the Trustees for their review.
For the most recent fiscal year ended April 30, the Funds paid distribution services fees for expenditures under the Distribution and Shareholder Services Plan as set forth in the table below.
85

Fund
2024
Victory Growth & Income Fund Class A
$532
Victory Income Fund Class A
$118,405
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund Class A
$39,754
Victory Science & Technology Fund Class A
$124,360
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class A
$179,715
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund Class C
$45,907
Victory High Income Fund Class A
$4,887
Victory Value Fund Class A
$1,724
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Class A
$116,436
Victory Nasdaq-100 Index Fund Class C
$104,282
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund Class A
$669
Other Compensation to Financial Intermediaries
In addition to the compensation paid by the Funds for the distribution and servicing of Class A shares described above, the Adviser or its affiliates, from time to time may make additional payments to financial intermediaries for the sale, distribution, and retention of shares of a Fund and for services to the shares of a Fund and its shareholders. These non-plan payments are intended to provide additional compensation to financial intermediaries for various services and may take the form of, among other things, “due diligence” payments for a dealer’s examination of the Funds and payments for providing extra employee training and information relating to Funds; “listing” fees for the placement of the Funds on a dealer’s list of mutual funds available for purchase by its customers; “finders” fees for directing investors to a Fund; “distribution and marketing support” fees or “revenue sharing” for providing assistance in promoting the sale of the Funds' shares; payments for the sale of shares and/or the maintenance of share balances; CUSIP fees; maintenance fees for, among other things, account maintenance and tax reporting; and set-up fees regarding the establishment of new accounts. These financial intermediaries may impose additional or different conditions than the Funds on purchases, redemptions or exchanges of shares. They also may independently establish and charge their customers or program participants transaction fees, account fees and other amounts in connection with purchases, redemptions and exchanges of shares in addition to any fees imposed by the Funds. The additional fees charged by financial intermediaries may vary and over time could increase the cost of an investment in the Funds and lower investment returns. Each financial intermediary is responsible for transmitting to its customers and program participants a schedule of any such fees and information regarding any additional or different conditions regarding purchases, redemptions and exchanges. Shareholders who are customers of these financial intermediaries or participants in programs serviced by them should contact the financial intermediary for information regarding these fees and conditions, if any.
From time to time, the Adviser or its affiliates also may pay a portion of the fees for administrative, networking, omnibus, operational and recordkeeping, sub-transfer agency, and shareholder services at its or their own expense and out of its or their legitimate profits.
Such revenue sharing payments are intended to compensate a financial intermediary for one or more of the following: (1) distribution, which may include expenses incurred by financial intermediaries for their sales activities with respect to a Fund, such as preparing, printing, and distributing sales literature and advertising materials and compensating registered representatives or other employees of such financial intermediaries for their sales activities, as well as the opportunity for a Fund to be made available by such financial intermediaries; (2) shareholder services, such as providing individual and custom investment advisory services to clients of the financial intermediaries; and (3) marketing and promotional services, including business planning assistance, educating personnel about a Fund, including a Fund on preferred or recommended lists or in certain sales programs sponsored by the intermediary, and sponsorship of sales meetings, which may include covering costs of providing speakers. The distributor may sponsor seminars and conferences designed to educate financial intermediaries about a Fund and may cover the expenses associated with attendance at such meetings, including travel costs. These payments and activities are intended to educate financial intermediaries about a Fund and may help defray or compensate the financial intermediary for the costs associated with offering a Fund.
The additional payments made by the Adviser and its affiliates may be a fixed dollar amount or may be based on a percentage of the value of shares sold to, or held by, customers of the financial intermediary involved, and may be different for different financial intermediaries. These payments may be negotiated based on a number of factors including, but not limited to, the financial intermediary’s reputation in the industry, ability to attract and retain assets, target markets, customer relationships and quality of service. No one factor is determinative of the type or amount of additional compensation to be provided. The payments described above are made from the Adviser’s or its affiliates’ own assets pursuant to agreements with the financial intermediaries and do not change the price paid by investors for the purchase of a Fund’s shares or the amount a Fund will receive as proceeds from such sales.
The level of payments made to the financial intermediaries in any year will vary and normally will be based on a percentage of sales or assets attributable to that financial intermediary invested in the particular share class of a Fund. Furthermore, the Adviser or its affiliates may contribute to various non-cash and cash incentive arrangements to promote the sale of shares, and may sponsor various
86

contests and promotions subject to applicable FINRA regulations in which participants may receive prizes such as travel awards, merchandise and cash. Subject to applicable FINRA regulations, the Adviser or its affiliates also may: (i) pay for the travel expenses, meals, lodging and entertainment of financial intermediary representatives and their salespersons in connection with educational and sales promotional programs, (ii) sponsor speakers, educational seminars and charitable events and (iii) provide other sales and marketing conferences and other resources to financial intermediaries and their salespersons. The amount of any payments is determined by us or the distributor, and all such amounts are paid out of our available assets or the assets of the distributor and do not directly affect the total expense ratio of a Fund. In addition, certain financial intermediaries may have access to certain services from Adviser or the distributor, including research reports and economic analysis, and portfolio analysis tools. In certain cases, the financial intermediary may not pay for these services.
In some instances, these incentives may be made available only to financial intermediaries whose representatives have sold or may sell a significant number of shares. The financial intermediaries receiving additional payments include those that may recommend that their clients consider or select a Fund for investment purposes, including those that may include one or more Funds on a “preferred” or “recommended” list of mutual funds. These payments may create an incentive for a financial intermediary or its representatives to recommend or offer shares of the Funds to its customers over shares of other funds. In addition, these payments may result in greater access by the Distributor or its affiliates to, without limitation, the financial intermediary, its representatives, advisors and consultants and sales meetings, than other funds, which do not make such payments or which make lower such payments. You should consult your financial adviser and review carefully any disclosure by the financial intermediary as to compensation received by your financial adviser for more information about the payments described above.
Shareholders of Class R6 shares do not require the same level of shareholder and administrative services from the Fund as shareholders of the other classes. In addition, the Manager and its affiliates do not pay any service, distribution, or administrative fees to financial intermediaries for services provided to the Class R6 shares and their shareholders. As a result, the Class R6 shares pay lower fees. Different fees and expenses will affect performance.
Portfolio Manager Disclosure
VICTORY CAPITAL
This section includes information about the Funds' portfolio managers, including information concerning other accounts they manage, the dollar range of Fund shares they own, and how they are compensated. For each Fund, the portfolio managers listed in the following table manage all of the other investment companies, other pooled investment vehicles, and other accounts shown below as a team.
Victory Income Investors
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth the accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Kurt Daum
8
$15,389.92
0
$
0
$
Brian Smith
6
$14,220.79
0
$
0
$
John Spear
8
$15,389.92
0
$
0
$
R. Neal Graves
16
$21,136.55
0
$
7
$296.76
James Jackson Jr
16
$21,136.55
3
$298.55
7
$296.76
Douglas Rollwitz
2
$2,735.30
0
$
0
$
Cody Perkins
3
$3,264.62
0
$
0
$
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
87

 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Kurt Daum
4
$12,366.83
0
$—
0
$—
Brian Smith
4
$11,639.51
0
$—
0
$—
John Spear
4
$11,484.72
0
$—
0
$—
R. Neal Graves
6
$13,661.64
0
$—
0
$—
James Jackson Jr
6
$13,661.64
0
$—
0
$—
Douglas Rollwitz
2
$2,735.30
0
$—
0
$—
Cody Perkins
0
$
0
$—
0
$—
Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, the dollar range of shares beneficially owned by the portfolio managers of the Funds are set forth below:
Portfolio Manager
Fund
Dollar Range
John Spear
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$50,001- $100,000
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$50,001- $100,000
 
Victory High Income Fund
$10,001- $50,000
 
Victory Income Fund
$50,001- $100,000
Kurt Daum
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$500,001- $1,000,000
 
Victory High Income Fund
$100,001 - $500,000
R. Neal Graves
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$100,001 - $500,000
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$100,001-$500,000
 
Victory High Income Fund
$50,001- $100,000
 
Victory Income Fund
$100,001-$500,000
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$100,001- $500,000
James Jackson, Jr.
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$10,001- $50,000
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$10,001- $50,000
 
Victory High Income Fund
$10,001- $50,000
 
Victory Income Fund
$100,001- $500,000
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$10,001- $50,000
Brian W. Smith
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
$100,001-$500,000
 
Victory Core Plus Intermediate Bond Fund
$1-$10,000
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
None
 
Victory Income Fund
$1-$10,000
Douglas Rollwitz
Victory Short-Term Bond Fund
None
 
Victory Ultra Short-Term Bond Fund
$100,001- $500,000
Cody Perkins
Victory Money Market Fund
None
Integrity
Other Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth other accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Daniel G. Bandi
5
$2,233.34
4
$1,665.72
50
$1,679.05
Daniel J. DeMonica
6
$2,293.15
5
$1,698.72
50
$1,679.05
88

 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Adam I. Friedman
5
$2,233.34
4
$1,665.72
50
$1,679.05
Joe A. Gilbert
5
$2,233.34
4
$1,665.72
50
$1,679.05
J. Bryan Tinsley
5
$2,233.34
4
$1,665.72
50
$1,679.05
Michael P. Wayton
6
$2,293.15
5
$1,698.72
50
$1,679.05
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Daniel G. Bandi
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
Daniel J. DeMonica
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
Adam I. Friedman
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
Joe A. Gilbert
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
J. Bryan Tinsley
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
Michael P. Wayton
1
$173.19
0
$—
0
$—
Portfolio Ownership: As of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of Integrity beneficially owned any shares of the Victory Small Cap Stock Fund.
NewBridge Asset Management
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Eric F. Maronak
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
11
$598.42
Jason E. Dahl
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
11
$598.42
Michael B. Koskuba
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
11
$598.42
Kristin Fong
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
11
$598.42
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Eric F. Maronak
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
0
$—
Jason E. Dahl
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
0
$—
Michael B. Koskuba
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
0
$—
89

 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Kristin Fong
2
$1,153.50
0
$—
0
$—
Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of NewBridge beneficially owned any shares of the Funds that they manage.
RS Investments
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
D. Scott Tracy
12
$5,536.23
2
$74.13
4
$72.24
Stephen J. Bishop
13
$5,711.16
2
$74.13
3
$27.54
Melissa Chadwick-Dunn
12
$5,536.23
2
$74.13
3
$82.03
Christopher Clark
13
$5,711.16
3
$90.17
3
$27.54
Paul Leung
13
$5,711.16
2
$74.13
3
$27.54
U-Wen Kok
6
$3,110.40
1
$346.88
4
$1,759.84
Adam Mezan
6
$3,110.40
1
$346.88
4
$1,759.84
Robert Harris
8
$2,913.54
2
$189.07
12
$80.00
Joseph Mainelli
8
$2,913.54
2
$189.07
12
$80.00
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
D. Scott Tracy
4
$3,359.65
0
$
2
$44.71
Stephen J. Bishop
4
$3,359.65
0
$
0
$
Melissa Chadwick-Dunn
4
$3,359.65
0
$
0
$
Christopher Clark
5
$3,397.96
1
$16.04
0
$
Paul Leung
5
$3,397.96
0
$
0
$
U-Wen Kok
3
$1,649.88
0
$
0
$
Adam Mezan
3
$1,649.88
0
$
0
$
Robert Harris
3
$787.21
0
$
0
$
Joseph Mainelli
3
$787.21
0
$
0
$
Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of RS Investments beneficially owned any shares of the Funds that they manage.
90

Sophus Capital
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Michael Reynal
4
$847.55
6
$2,257.99
2
$983.16
Maria Freund
4
$847.55
6
$2,257.99
2
$983.16
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Michael Reynal
3
$433.55
0
$—
0
$—
Maria Freund
3
$433.55
0
$—
0
$—
Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of Sophus Capital beneficially owned any shares of the Funds they manage.
THB
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth other accounts for which the Fund’s portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Christopher N. Cuesta
5
$596.84
3
$146.90
19
$116.17
Manish Maheshwari
5
$596.84
3
$146.90
19
$116.17
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Christopher N. Cuesta
3
$480.28
0
$—
0
$—
Manish Maheshwari
3
$480.28
0
$—
0
$—
As of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of THB beneficially owned any shares of the Victory Small Cap Stock Fund.
91

Trivalent Investments
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth accounts for which the Fund’s portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Peter S. Carpenter
4
$948.06
2
$57.87
1
$259.19
Jeffrey R. Sullivan
4
$948.06
2
$57.87
1
$259.19
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Peter S. Carpenter
3
$735.75
0
$—
0
$—
Jeffrey R. Sullivan
3
$735.75
0
$—
0
$—
Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of Trivalent Investments beneficially owned any shares of the Fund they manage.
Victory Solutions
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth the accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Mannik Dhillon
59
$55,517.16
4
$62.78
19
$4,740.40
Lance Humphrey
18
$10,965.83
0
$
4
$2,305.12
Elie Masri
3
$3,166.10
0
$
0
$
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Mannik Dhillon
14
$19,217.33
0
$—
0
$—
Lance Humphrey
2
$558.91
0
$—
0
$—
Elie Masri
3
$3,166.10
0
$—
0
$—
92

Portfolio Ownership: As of April 30, 2024, the dollar range of shares beneficially owned by the portfolio managers of the Funds are set forth below:
Portfolio Manager
Fund
Dollar Range
Mannik Dhillon
Victory Aggressive Growth Fund
None
 
Victory Capital Growth Fund
None
 
Victory Income Stock Fund
$1 - $10,000
 
Victory Growth & Income Fund
None
 
Victory Growth Fund
None
 
Victory Science & Technology Fund
None
 
Victory Small Cap Stock Fund
$1 - $10,000
 
Victory Value Fund
$1 – 10,000
 
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
None
 
Victory 500 Index Fund
None
 
Victory Extended Market Index Fund
None
 
Victory Nasdaq-100 Fund
$10,001 - $50,000
Lance Humphrey
Victory Income Stock Fund
$100,001 - $500,000
 
Victory Global Managed Volatility Fund
None
Elie Masri
Victory Income Stock Fund
$10,001 - $50,000
WestEnd
Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth the accounts for which the Funds' portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of the fiscal period ended April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Fritz Porter
1
$324.18
0
$—
96
$21,020.02
Ned Durden
1
$324.18
0
$—
96
$21,020.02
Ty Peebles
1
$324.18
0
$—
96
$21,020.02
Jacob Buchanan
0
$
0
$—
0
$
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Fritz Porter
0
$—
0
$—
0
$—
Ned Durden
0
$—
0
$—
0
$—
Ty Peebles
0
$—
0
$—
0
$—
Jacob Buchanan
0
$—
0
$—
0
$—
Conflicts of Interest
The Adviser’s portfolio managers are often responsible for managing one or more Funds as well as other accounts, such as separate accounts, and other pooled investment vehicles, such as collective trust funds or unregistered hedge funds. A portfolio manager may manage other accounts which have materially higher fee arrangements than a Fund and may, in the future, manage other accounts which have a performance-based fee. A portfolio manager also may make personal investments in accounts he or she manages or supports. The side-by-side management of the Funds along with other accounts may raise potential conflicts of interest by incenting a portfolio
93

manager to direct a disproportionate amount of: (1) their attention; (2) limited investment opportunities, such as less liquid securities or initial public offering; and/or (3) desirable trade allocations to such other accounts. In addition, certain trading practices, such as cross-trading between Funds or between a Fund and another account, raise conflict of interest issues. The Adviser has adopted numerous compliance policies and procedures, including a Code of Ethics, and brokerage and trade allocation policies and procedures, which seek to address the conflicts associated with managing multiple accounts for multiple clients. In addition, the Adviser has a designated Chief Compliance Officer (selected in accordance with the federal securities laws) and compliance staff whose activities are focused on monitoring the activities of the Adviser’s investment franchises and employees in order to detect and address potential and actual conflicts of interest. However, there can be no assurance that the Adviser’s compliance program will achieve its intended result.
Portfolio Manager Compensation
The Adviser has designed the structure of its portfolio managers’ compensation to (1) align portfolio managers’ interests with those of the Adviser’s clients with an emphasis on long-term, risk-adjusted investment performance, (2) help the Adviser attract and retain high-quality investment professionals, and (3) contribute to the Adviser’s overall financial success. Each of the portfolio managers receives a base salary plus an annual incentive bonus for managing a Fund, separate accounts, other investment companies, other pooled investment vehicles and other accounts (including any accounts for which the Adviser receives a performance fee) (together, “Accounts”). A portfolio manager’s base salary is dependent on the portfolio manager’s level of experience and expertise. The Adviser monitors each portfolio manager’s base salary relative to salaries paid for similar positions with peer firms by reviewing data provided by various independent, third-party consultants that specialize in competitive salary information. Such data, however, is not considered to be a definitive benchmark.
Members of the Adviser’s Victory Solutions platform may earn incentive compensation based on the performance of the Victory Solutions platform. Members of the Adviser’s other investment franchises may earn incentive compensation based on a percentage of the Adviser’s revenue attributable to fees paid by Accounts managed by that team. The chief investment officer or a senior member of the team, in coordination with the Adviser, determines the allocation of the incentive compensation earned by the team among the team’s portfolio managers by establishing a “target” incentive for each portfolio manager based on the portfolio manager’s level of experience and expertise in the portfolio manager’s investment style. Individual performance is based on objectives established annually using performance metrics such as portfolio structure and positioning, research, stock selection, asset growth, client retention, presentation skills, marketing to prospective clients and contribution to the Adviser’s philosophy and values, such as leadership, risk management and teamwork. The annual incentive bonus also factors in individual investment performance of each portfolio manager’s portfolio or Fund relative to a selected peer group(s). The overall performance results for a portfolio manager are based on the composite performance of all Accounts managed by that manager on a combination of one-, three-, and five-year rolling performance periods as compared to the performance information of a peer group of similarly-managed competitors.
The Adviser’s portfolio managers may participate in the equity ownership plan of the Adviser’s parent company. There is an ongoing annual equity pool granted to certain employees based on their contribution to the firm. Eligibility for participation in these incentive programs depends on the manager’s performance and seniority.
GIM
Other Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth other accounts for which the Victory Small Cap Stock Fund’s portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Jennifer M. Pawloski
1
$207.2
1
$357.7
7
$347.4
Andrew L. Beja
3
$583.2
2
$610.8
59
$1,130.5
David M. Rose
2
$568.5
3
$507.0
23
$356.9
Jeffrey A. Harrison
5
$599.3
3
$365.2
18
$501.8
Richard Watson
1
$207.2
2
$359.2
5
$345.3
Kelvin Jiang
1
$207.2
1
$357.7
5
$345.3
94

The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Jennifer M. Pawloski
0
$—
0
$—
0
$
Andrew L. Beja
0
$—
0
$—
2
$36.7
David M. Rose
0
$—
0
$—
0
$
Jeffrey A. Harrison
0
$—
0
$—
0
$
Richard Watson
0
$—
0
$—
0
$
Kelvin Jiang
0
$—
0
$—
0
$
Conflicts of Interest: The portfolio management team responsible for managing the Portfolio has similar responsibilities to other clients of GIM. The firm has established policies and procedures to address the potential conflicts of interest inherent in managing portfolios for multiple clients. These policies and procedures are designed to prevent and detect favorable treatment of one account over another, and include policies for allocating trades equitably across multiple accounts, monitoring the composition of client portfolios to ensure that each reflects the investment profile of that client, and reviewing the performance of accounts of similar styles. Additionally, each employee of GIM is bound by its Code of Ethics, which establishes policies and procedures designed to ensure that clients’ interests are placed before those of an individual or the firm.
Compensation: The GIM Portfolio is managed by the portfolio management team at GIM. The portfolio managers’ compensation is made up of a base salary plus a performance bonus. Base salary for portfolio managers varies depending on qualitative and quantitative factors such as salary levels in the industry, experience, length of employment, and the nature and number of other duties for which he or she has responsibility. The performance bonus is based on a number of factors including the one-and three-year returns, before management fees and taxes, of each account managed relative to its benchmark (the Russell 2000 Growth Index for the GIM sub Portfolio); the one-and three-year returns, before management fees and taxes, of each account managed relative to the benchmark sector for which that manager has responsibility; and the value of the assets managed by that manager. Additionally, each individual participates in the overall profit of the firm through a profit sharing plan.
Portfolio Ownership: As of the fiscal period ended April 30, 2024, no portfolio manager of GIM, who managed the Fund, beneficially owned shares of the Victory Small Cap Stock Fund.
Loomis Sayles
Other Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth other accounts for which the Victory Growth Fund’s portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Aziz V. Hamzaogullari
29*
$24,793.3
20
$15,641.2
136
$32,738.1
*Excludes Victory Growth Fund.
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
95

 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Aziz V. Hamzaogullari
0
$—
3
$671.6
1
$349.7
Conflicts of Interest: Conflicts of interest may arise in the allocation of investment opportunities and the allocation of aggregated orders among the Funds and other accounts managed by the portfolio managers. A portfolio manager potentially could give favorable treatment to some accounts for a variety of reasons, including favoring larger accounts, accounts that pay higher fees, accounts that pay performance-based fees, accounts of affiliated companies and accounts in which the portfolio manager has an interest. In addition, due to differences in the investment strategies or restrictions among a Fund and a portfolio manager’s other accounts, the portfolio manager may take action with respect to another account that differs from the action taken with respect to the Fund(s). Although such favorable treatment could lead to more favorable investment opportunities or allocations for some accounts and may appear to create additional conflicts of interest for the portfolio manager in the allocation of management time and resources, Loomis Sayles strives to ensure that portfolio managers endeavor to exercise their discretion in a manner that is equitable to all interested persons. Furthermore, Loomis Sayles makes investment decisions for all accounts (including institutional accounts, mutual funds, hedge funds and affiliated accounts) based on each account’s investment objective, investment guidelines and restrictions, the availability of other comparable investment opportunities and Loomis Sayles’ desire to treat all accounts fairly and equitably over time. Loomis Sayles maintains Trade Allocation and Aggregation Policies and Procedures to mitigate the effects of these potential conflicts as well as other types of conflicts of interest. However, there is no guarantee that such procedures will detect each and every situation where a conflict arises or that Loomis Sayles will treat all accounts identically. Conflicts of interest also arise to the extent a portfolio manager short sells a stock or otherwise takes a short position in one client account but holds that stock long in other accounts, including the Fund(s), or sells a stock for some accounts while buying the stock for others, and through the use of “soft dollar arrangements,” which are discussed in Loomis Sayles’ Brokerage Allocation Policies and Procedures and Loomis Sayles’ Trade Aggregation and Allocation Policies and Procedures.
Compensation: Loomis Sayles believes that Portfolio Manager compensation should be driven primarily by the delivery of consistent and superior long-term performance for its clients. Mr. Hamzaogullari’s compensation has four components: a competitive base salary, an annual incentive bonus driven by investment performance, participation in a long-term incentive plan (with an annual and a post-retirement payout), and a revenue sharing bonus if certain revenue thresholds and performance hurdles are met.
Maximum variable compensation potential is a multiple of base salary and reflects performance achievements relative to peers with similar disciplines. The performance review considers the asset class, manager experience, and maturity of the product. The incentive compensation is based on trailing strategy performance and is weighted at one third for the three-year period, one third for the five-year period and one third for the ten-year period. He also receives performance based compensation as Portfolio Manager for a private investment fund. The Firm’s senior management reviews the components annually.
In addition, Mr. Hamzaogullari participates in the Loomis Sayles profit sharing plan, in which Loomis Sayles makes a contribution to the retirement plan of each employee based on a percentage of base salary (up to a maximum amount). He may also participate in the Loomis Sayles deferred compensation plan which requires all employees to defer 50% of their annual bonus if in excess of a certain dollar amount, except for those employees who will be age 61 or older on the date the bonus is awarded. These amounts are deferred over a two year period with 50% being paid out one year from the bonus anniversary date and the second 50% being paid out two years from the bonus anniversary date. These deferrals are deposited into an investment account on the employee's behalf, but the employee must be with Loomis Sayles on the vesting dates in order to receive the deferred bonus.
Wellington Management
Other Accounts Managed
The following table sets forth other accounts for which the Victory Science & Technology Fund's portfolio managers were primarily responsible for the day-to-day portfolio management as of April 30, 2024.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Bruce L. Glazer
17
$1,603.6
40
$1,919.7
75
$1,194.1
96

 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicles
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Brian Barbetta
11
$4,485.2
24
$1,379.5
61
$1,865.6
Eunhak Bae
16
$3,830.9
29
$975.2
67
$2,253.8
Tom DeLong
10
$1,700
6
$135.1
14
$504.6
The following table lists the number and types of Performance-Based accounts managed by each individual and assets under management in those accounts as of the last completed fiscal year.
 
Registered
Investment
Companies
Other Pooled
Investment
Vehicle
Other
Accounts
Name
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Number
of
Accounts
Total
Assets
(in Millions)
Bruce L. Glazer
1
$35.2
13
$1,279.3
10
$151.8
Brian Barbetta
1
$1,929.9
5
$273.5
7
$307.4
Eunhak Bae
3
$1,856.8
5
$279.1
8
$463.6
Tom DeLong
0
$
4
$108.5
4
$26.1
Conflicts of Interest: Individual investment professionals at Wellington Management manage multiple accounts for multiple clients. These accounts may include mutual funds, separate accounts (assets managed on behalf of institutions, such as pension funds, insurance companies, foundations, or separately managed account programs sponsored by financial intermediaries), bank common trust accounts, and hedge funds. The Fund’s managers listed in the prospectus who are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Funds (“Investment Professionals”) generally manage accounts in several different investment styles. These accounts may have investment objectives, strategies, time horizons, tax considerations and risk profiles that differ from those of the Funds. The Investment Professionals make investment decisions for each account, including the relevant Fund, based on the investment objectives, policies, practices, benchmarks, cash flows, tax and other relevant investment considerations applicable to that account. Consequently, the Investment Professionals may purchase or sell securities, including IPOs, for one account and not another account, and the performance of securities purchased for one account may vary from the performance of securities purchased for other accounts. Alternatively, these accounts may be managed in a similar fashion to the relevant Fund and thus the accounts may have similar, and in some cases nearly identical, objectives, strategies and/or holdings to that of the relevant Fund.
An Investment Professional or other investment professionals at Wellington Management may place transactions on behalf of other accounts that are directly or indirectly contrary to investment decisions made on behalf of the relevant Fund, or make investment decisions that are similar to those made for the relevant Fund, both of which have the potential to adversely impact the relevant Fund depending on market conditions. For example, an investment professional may purchase a security in one account while appropriately selling that same security in another account. Similarly, an Investment Professional may purchase the same security for the relevant Fund and one or more other accounts at or about the same time. In those instances the other accounts will have access to their respective holdings prior to the public disclosure of the relevant Fund’s holdings. In addition, some of these accounts have fee structures, including performance fees, which are or have the potential to be higher, in some cases significantly higher, than the fees Wellington Management receives for managing the Funds. The Investment Professionals listed in the chart above also manage accounts, which pay performance allocations to Wellington Management or its affiliates. Because incentive payments paid by Wellington Management to the Investment Professionals are tied to revenues earned by Wellington Management and, where noted, to the performance achieved by the manager in each account, the incentives associated with any given account may be significantly higher or lower than those associated with other accounts managed by a given Investment Professional. Finally, the Investment Professionals may hold shares or investments in the other pooled investment vehicles and/or other accounts identified above.
Wellington Management’s goal is to meet its fiduciary obligation to treat all clients fairly and provide high quality investment services to all of its clients. Wellington Management has adopted and implemented policies and procedures, including brokerage and trade allocation policies and procedures, which it believes address the conflicts associated with managing multiple accounts for multiple clients. In addition, Wellington Management monitors a variety of areas, including compliance with primary account guidelines, the allocation of IPOs, and compliance with the firm’s Code of Ethics, and places additional investment restrictions on investment professionals who manage hedge funds and certain other accounts. Furthermore, senior investment and business personnel at Wellington Management periodically review the performance of Wellington Management’s investment professionals. Although Wellington Management does not track the time an investment professional spends on a single account, Wellington Management does
97

periodically assess whether an investment professional has adequate time and resources to effectively manage the investment professional’s various client mandates.
Compensation: Wellington Management receives a fee based on the assets under management of the Fund as set forth in the Investment Subadvisory Agreement between Wellington Management and the Manager on behalf of the Fund. Wellington Management pays its investment professionals out of its total revenues, including the advisory fees earned with respect to the Fund. The following information relates to the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024.
Wellington Management’s compensation structure is designed to attract and retain high-caliber investment professionals necessary to deliver high quality investment management services to its clients. Wellington Management’s compensation of the Fund’s managers listed in the prospectus who are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Fund (the “Investment Professionals”) includes a base salary and incentive components. The base salary for each Investment Professional who is a partner (a “Partner”) of Wellington Management Group LLP, the ultimate holding company of Wellington Management, is generally a fixed amount determined by the managing partners of Wellington Management Group LLP. Each Investment Professional is eligible to receive an incentive payment based on the revenues earned by Wellington Management from the Fund managed by the Investment Professional and generally each other account managed by such Investment Professional. Each Investment Professional’s incentive payment relating to the Fund is linked to the gross pre-tax performance of the portion of the Fund managed by the Investment Professional compared to the benchmark index and/or peer group identified below over one-, three- and five-year periods, with an emphasis on five-year results. Wellington Management applies similar incentive compensation structures (although the benchmarks or peer groups, time periods and rates may differ) to other accounts managed by the Investment Professionals, including accounts with performance fees.
Portfolio-based incentives across all accounts managed by an investment professional can, and typically do, represent a significant portion of an investment professional’s overall compensation; incentive compensation varies significantly by individual and can vary significantly from year to year. The Investment Professionals also may be eligible for bonus payments based on their overall contribution to Wellington Management’s business operations. Senior management at Wellington Management may reward individuals as it deems appropriate based on other factors. Each Partner is eligible to participate in a Partner-funded tax qualified retirement plan, the contributions to which are made pursuant to an actuarial formula. Messrs. Glazer, Barbetta, and Wantman and Ms. Bae are Partners.
Fund
Benchmark Index and/or Peer Group for
Incentive Period
Victory Science & Technology Fund (Science Portion)
Effective 4/1/2016, S&P Composite 1500 Health
Care Index; 8/1/2015 through 3/31/2016, S&P North
American Healthcare Index.
Victory Science & Technology Fund (Technology Portion)
S&P North American Technology Sector Index (TR)
Portfolio Ownership: As of the fiscal year ended April 30, 2024, no portfolio managers of Wellington Management beneficially owned any shares of the Fund.
Portfolio Holdings Disclosure
The Board has adopted policies and procedures with respect to the disclosure of each Fund’s portfolio holdings by the Fund, the Adviser, or their affiliates. These policies and procedures provide that each Fund’s portfolio holdings information generally may not be disclosed to any party prior to the information becoming public. Certain limited exceptions are described below. These policies and procedures apply to disclosures to all categories of persons, including individual investors, institutional investors, intermediaries who sell shares of a Fund, third parties providing services to the Funds (accounting agent, print vendors, etc.), rating and ranking organizations (Lipper, Morningstar, etc.) and affiliated persons of the Funds.
The Trust’s Chief Compliance Officer is responsible for monitoring each Fund’s compliance with these policies and procedures and for providing regular reports (at least annually) to the Board regarding the adequacy and effectiveness of the policy and recommend changes, if necessary.
Public Disclosure
The Funds disclose their complete portfolio holdings in its annual and semi annual reports to shareholders, which are sent to shareholders, and quarterly schedules of portfolio holdings no later than 60 days after the relevant fiscal period and are available on the Funds’ website, VictoryFunds.com. The Funds also file their complete portfolio holdings with the SEC for the first and third fiscal quarters on Form N-PORT. You can find these filings on the SEC’s website, www.sec.gov, and the Funds’ portfolio holdings are available at VictoryFunds.com in accordance with Rule 30e-3 under the 1940 Act.
98

In addition, the Funds disclose their complete portfolio holdings as of the quarter-end on the Funds’ website no earlier than the 15th day following the end of the calendar quarter (and five days in the case of money market funds). The Victory Money Market Fund will post information relating to its portfolio holdings on vcm.com five business days after the end of each month and will keep such information on the website for six months thereafter. The Funds intend to publish its top 10 holdings on the Funds’ website on a monthly basis no earlier than the 10th day following the end of the month.
Non-Public Disclosures
The Adviser may authorize the disclosure of non-public portfolio holdings information under certain limited circumstances. The Funds’ policies provide that non-public disclosures of a Fund’s portfolio holdings may only be made if: (i) the Fund has a “legitimate business purpose” (as determined by the President of the Trust) for making such disclosure; and (ii) the party receiving the non-public information enters into a confidentiality agreement, which includes a duty not to trade on the non-public information and describes any compensation to be paid to the Fund or any “affiliated person” of the Adviser or Distributor, including any arrangement to maintain assets in the Fund or in other investment companies or accounts managed by the Adviser or by any “affiliated person” of the Adviser or Distributor.
The Adviser will consider any actual or potential conflicts of interest between the Adviser and a Fund’s shareholders and will act in the best interest of the Fund’s shareholders with respect to any such disclosure of portfolio holdings information. If a potential conflict can be resolved in a manner that does not present detrimental effects to Fund shareholders, the Adviser may authorize release of portfolio holdings information. Conversely, if the potential conflict cannot be resolved in a manner that does not present detrimental effects to Fund shareholders, the Adviser will not authorize such release.
Ongoing Arrangements to Disclose Portfolio Holdings
As previously authorized by the Board and/or the Trust’s executive officers, a Fund periodically discloses non-public portfolio holdings on a confidential basis to various service providers that require such information in order to assist the Fund in its day-to-day operations, as well as public information to certain ratings organizations. These entities are described in the following table. The table also includes information as to the timing of these entities receiving the portfolio holdings information from a Fund. In none of these arrangements does a Fund or any “affiliated person” of the Adviser or Distributor receive any compensation, including any arrangement to maintain assets in the Fund or in other investment companies or accounts managed by the Adviser or by any “affiliated person” of the Adviser or Distributor.
Type of Service Provider
Name of Service Provider
Timing of Release of
Portfolio Holdings Information
Adviser and Fund Accountant
Victory Capital Management Inc.
Daily.
Underwriter and Distributor
Victory Capital Services, Inc.
Daily.
Custodian
Citibank, N.A.
Daily.
Sub-Fund Accountant
Citi Fund Services Ohio, Inc.
Daily.
Financial Data Service
FactSet Research Systems, Inc.
Daily.
Liquidity Risk Management Service
Provider
MSCI, Inc.
Daily.
Independent Registered Public
Accounting Firm
Ernst & Young LLP
Annual Reporting Period: within 15
business days of end of reporting period.
Legal Counsel, for EDGAR filings on
Forms N-CSR and Form N-Port
K&L Gates LLP
Up to 30 days before filing with the
SEC.
Ratings Agency
Lipper
Quarterly, no later than 15 calendar days
after the end of the previous quarter.
Ratings Agency
Morningstar
Quarterly, no later than 15 calendar days
after the end of the previous quarter.
Financial Data Service
Bloomberg L.P.
Quarterly, no later than 15 calendar days
after the end of the previous quarter.
These service providers are required to keep all non-public information confidential and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information, except as necessary in providing services to a Fund.
There is no guarantee that a Fund’s policies on use and dissemination of holdings information will protect the Fund from the potential misuse of holdings by individuals or firms in possession of such information.
• Where the person to whom the disclosure is made owes a fiduciary or other duty of trust or confidence to the Victory Fund (e.g., auditors, attorneys, and Access Persons under the Victory Capital Code of Ethics);
99

• Where the person has a valid reason to have access to the portfolio holdings information and has agreed not to disclose or misuse the information (e.g., custodians, accounting agents, securities lending agents, subadvisers, rating agencies, mutual fund evaluation services, such as Lipper, Inc. and proxy voting agents);
• As disclosed in this SAI; and
• As required by law or a regulatory body.
If portfolio holdings are released pursuant to an ongoing arrangement with any party that owes a fiduciary or other duty of trust or confidence to the Victory Fund or has a valid reason to have access to the portfolio holdings information and has agreed not to disclose or misuse the information, the Victory Fund must have a legitimate business purpose for doing so, and neither the Victory Fund, nor the Adviser or its affiliates, may receive any compensation in connection with an arrangement to make available information about the Victory Fund’s portfolio holdings. If the applicable conditions set forth above are satisfied, a Victory Fund may distribute portfolio holdings to mutual fund evaluation services such as Lipper and broker-dealers that may be used by the Victory Fund, for the purpose of efficient trading and receipt of relevant research. In providing this information to broker-dealers, reasonable precautions are taken to avoid any potential misuse of the disclosed information.
Each Victory Fund also may disclose any and all portfolio information to its service providers and others who generally need access to such information in the performance of their contractual duties and responsibilities and are subject to duties of confidentiality, including a duty not to trade on non-public information, imposed by law and/or agreement. Each Victory Fund may provide portfolio holdings information to the following affiliates, subadvisers, vendors, broker-dealers and service providers: (1) certain affiliated entities with common systems access; (2) subadvisers to series of the Trust; (3) custodians and tax service providers (e.g., Citibank, N.A.); (4) securities lending agents (e.g., Citibank); (5) proxy voting and class action filing agents (ISS); (6) trade analytic consultants (e.g., Markit); (7) financial statement service providers (e.g., Toppan Merrill and Donnelley Financial Solutions); (8) certain mutual fund evaluation service providers (e.g., Lipper, Inc., Morningstar, Inc., Factset, Bloomberg Finance LP); (9) pricing vendors (e.g., S&P, JJ Kenney & Co., Thompson Financial/Reuters, ValueLine, Yield Book, and IDC) and (10) platform vendors, ICE Data Pricing & Reference Data LLC (“ICE”), (e.g., Charles River and Sungard (Dataware Solutions)) as well as certain other individuals that owe the Trust a duty of trust and confidence including fund counsel, internal audit, independent auditors, identified nationally recognized statistical rating organizations and executing broker dealers.
Any person or entity that does not have a previously approved ongoing arrangement to receive non-public portfolio holdings information and seeks a Victory Fund’s portfolio holdings information that (i) has not been filed with the SEC, or (ii) is not available on VictoryFunds.com, must submit its request in writing to the Victory Funds’ Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”), or Victory Funds Legal Counsel, or their designee(s), who will make a determination whether disclosure of such portfolio holdings may be made and whether the relevant Fund needs to make any related disclosure in its SAI.
Each Fund intends to post its annual and semi annual reports and quarterly schedules of portfolio holdings on VictoryFunds.com (which typically occurs approximately 60 days after the end of each fiscal quarter). Each Fund intends to post its quarterly portfolio holdings on VictoryFunds.com (which typically occurs approximately 15 calendar days after each calendar quarter and five days in the case of money market funds). The Victory Money Market Fund will post information relating to its portfolio holdings on vcm.com five business days after the end of each month and will keep such information on the website for six months thereafter. In addition, each Fund intends to post its top 10 holdings on VictoryFunds.com 10 days following the end of each month. Monthly portfolio disclosures are filed with the SEC on Forms N-PORT and N-MFP. Information reported on Form N-PORT for the third month of each Fund’s fiscal quarter will be made publicly available 60 days after the end of the Fund’s fiscal quarter.
Approximately 31 days after the end of each month, each Fund’s portfolio holdings will be delivered to certain independent evaluation and reporting services such as Bloomberg, S&P, and Morningstar.
For the last month of each quarter, after all Victory funds' top holdings are made available on VictoryFunds.com, this information for each Fund will be delivered to certain independent evaluation and reporting services such as Lipper, S&P, Thomson Financial, and Value Line.
In order to address potential conflicts of interest between the interests of each Fund’s shareholders, on the one hand, and the interests of the Funds’ Adviser, principal underwriter, or certain affiliated persons, on the other, the Victory Funds have adopted the policies described above (i) prohibiting the receipt of compensation in connection with an arrangement to make available information about each Fund’s portfolio holdings and (ii) requiring certain requests for non-public portfolio holdings information to be approved by the CCO or the Funds Legal Counsel, and then reported to the Board, including the Independent Trustees.
100

Appendix A - Long-Term and Short-Term Debt Ratings
1. Long-Term Debt Ratings:
Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (Moody’s)
Aaa Obligations rated Aaa are judged to be of the highest quality, subject to the lowest level of credit risk.
Aa Obligations rated Aa are judged to be of high quality and are subject to very low credit risk.
A Obligations rated A are judged to be upper-medium grade and are subject to low credit risk.
Baa Obligations rated Baa are subject to moderate credit risk. They are judged to be medium-grade and as such may possess certain speculative characteristics.
Ba Obligations rated Ba are judged to be speculative and are subject to substantial credit risk.
B Obligations rated B are considered speculative and are subject to high credit risk.
Caa Obligations rated Caa are judged to be speculative, of poor standing, and are subject to very high credit risk.
Ca Obligations rated Ca are highly speculative and are likely in, or very near, default, with some prospect of recovery of principal and interest.
C Obligations rated C are the lowest rated and typically are in default, with little prospect for recovery of principal and interest.
Note: Moody’s applies numerical modifiers 1, 2, and 3 in each generic rating classification. Modifier 1 indicates that the obligation ranks in the higher end of its generic rating category, modifier 2 indicates a mid-range ranking, and modifier 3 indicates a ranking in the lower end of that generic rating category.
S&P Global Ratings (S&P)
AAA An obligation rated ‘AAA’ has the highest rating assigned by S&P. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is extremely strong.
AA An obligation rated ‘AA’ differs from the highest-rated obligation only to a small degree. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is very strong.
A An obligation rated ‘A’ is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligations in higher rated categories. However, the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation is still strong.
BBB An obligation rated ‘BBB’ exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely to weaken the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
Obligations rated ‘BB,’ ‘B,’ ‘CCC,’ ‘CC,’ and ‘C’ are regarded as having significant speculative characteristics. ‘BB’ indicates the least degree of speculation and ‘C’ the highest. While such obligations will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these may be outweighed by large uncertainties or major exposures to adverse conditions.
BB An obligation rated ‘BB’ is less vulnerable to nonpayment than other speculative issues. However, it faces major ongoing uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions that could lead to the obligor’s inadequate capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
B An obligation rated ‘B’ is more vulnerable to nonpayment than obligations rated BB, but the obligor currently has the capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair the obligor’s capacity or willingness to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
CCC An obligation rated ‘CCC’ is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic conditions, the obligor is not likely to have the capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
CC An obligation rated ‘CC’ is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment. The ‘CC’ rating is used when a default has not yet occurred, but S&P expects default to be a virtual certainty, regardless of the anticipated time to default.
101

C An obligation rated ‘C’ is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment, and the obligation is expected to have lower relative seniority or lower ultimate recovery compared with obligations that are rated higher.
D An obligation rated ‘D’ is in default or in breach of an imputed promise. For non-hybrid capital instruments, the ‘D’ rating category is used when payments on an obligation are not made on the date due, unless S&P believes that such payments will be made within five business days in the absence of a stated grace period or within the earlier of the stated grace period or the next 30 calendar days. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar action and where default on an obligation is a virtual certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions. A rating on an obligation is lowered to ‘D’ if it is subject to a distressed debt restructuring.
NR This indicates that no rating has been requested, or that there is insufficient information on which to base a rating, or that S&P does not rate a particular obligation as a matter of policy.
Plus (+) or Minus (-): The ratings from ‘AA’ to ‘CCC’ may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign to show relative standing within the rating categories.
Fitch Ratings Inc. (Fitch)
AAA Highest credit quality. “AAA” ratings denote the lowest expectation of credit risk. They are assigned only in case of exceptionally strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments. This capacity is highly unlikely to be adversely affected by foreseeable events.
AA Very high credit quality. “AA” ratings denote a very low expectation of credit risk. They indicate very strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments. This capacity is not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable events.
A High credit quality. “A” ratings denote a low expectation of credit risk. The capacity for timely payment of financial commitments is considered strong. This capacity may, nevertheless, be more vulnerable to adverse or economic conditions than is the case for higher ratings.
BBB Good credit quality. “BBB” ratings indicate that expectations of default are currently low. The capacity for payment of financial commitments is considered adequate, but adverse business or economic conditions are more likely to impair this capacity.
BB Speculative. “BB” ratings indicate an elevated vulnerability to default risk, particularly in the event of adverse economic conditions over time; however, business or financial flexibility exists that supports the servicing of financial commitments.
B Highly speculative. “B” ratings indicate that material default risk is present, but a limited margin of safety remains. Financial commitments are currently being met; however, capacity for continued payment is vulnerable to deterioration in the business and economic environment.
CCC Substantial credit risk. Default is a real possibility.
CC Very high levels of credit risk. Default of some kind appears probable.
C Near default. A default or default-like process has begun, or the issuer is in standstill, or for a closed funding vehicle, payment capacity is irrevocably impaired. Conditions that are indicative of a ‘C’ category rating for an issuer include:
a.the issuer has entered into a grace or cure period following non-payment of a material financial obligation;
b.the issuer has entered into a temporary negotiated waiver or standstill agreement following a payment default on a material financial obligation;
c.the formal announcement by the issuer or its agent of a distressed debt exchange;
d.a closed financing vehicle where payment capacity is irrevocably impaired such that it is not expected to pay interest and/or principal in full during the life of the transaction, but where no payment default is imminent.
RD Restricted Default. ‘RD’ ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch’s opinion has experienced:
a.an uncured payment default on a bond, loan or other material financial obligation, but
b.has not entered into bankruptcy filings, administration, receivership, liquidation, or other formal winding-up procedure, and
c.has not otherwise ceased operating.
102

This would include:
i.the selective payment default on a specific class or currency of debt;
ii.the uncured expiry of any applicable grace period, cure period or default forbearance period following a payment default on a bank loan, capital markets security or other material financial obligation;
iii.the extension of multiple waivers or forbearance periods upon a payment default on one or more material financial obligations, either in series or in parallel; and iv. ordinary execution of a distressed debt exchange on one or more material financial obligations.
D Default. “D” ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch’s opinion has entered into bankruptcy filings, administration, receivership, liquidation, or other formal winding-up procedure or that has otherwise ceased business.
Plus (+) or Minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.
S&P Global Ratings (S&P)
AAA
An obligation rated ‘AAA’ has the highest rating assigned by S&P. The obligor’s capacity to meet its financial
commitments on the obligation is extremely strong.
AA
An obligation rated ‘AA’ differs from the highest-rated obligation only to a small degree. The obligor’s capacity to meet
its financial commitments on the obligation is very strong.
A
An obligation rated ‘A’ is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic
conditions than obligations in higher rated categories. However, the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments
on the obligation is still strong.
BBB
An obligation rated ‘BBB’ exhibits adequate protection parameters. However, adverse economic conditions or changing
circumstances are more likely to weaken the obligor’s capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
 
Obligations rated ‘BB,’ ‘B,’ ‘CCC,’ ‘CC,’ and ‘C’ are regarded as having significant speculative characteristics. ‘BB’
indicates the least degree of speculation and ‘C’ the highest. While such obligations will likely have some quality and
protective characteristics, these may be outweighed by large uncertainties or major exposures to adverse conditions.
BB
An obligation rated ‘BB’ is less vulnerable to nonpayment than other speculative issues. However, it faces major ongoing
uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions that could lead to the obligor’s inadequate
capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
B
An obligation rated ‘B’ is more vulnerable to nonpayment than obligations rated BB, but the obligor currently has the
capacity to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will
likely impair the obligor’s capacity or willingness to meet its financial commitments on the obligation.
CCC
An obligation rated ‘CCC’ is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and
economic conditions for the obligor to meet its financial commitments on the obligation. In the event of adverse business,
financial, or economic conditions, the obligor is not likely to have the capacity to meet its financial commitments on the
obligation.
CC
An obligation rated ‘CC’ is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment. The ‘CC’ rating is used when a default has not yet
occurred, but S&P expects default to be a virtual certainty, regardless of the anticipated time to default.
C
An obligation rated ‘C’ is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment, and the obligation is expected to have lower relative
seniority or lower ultimate recovery compared with obligations that are rated higher.
D
An obligation rated ‘D’ is in default or in breach of an imputed promise. For non-hybrid capital instruments, the ‘D’ rating
category is used when payments on an obligation are not made on the date due, unless S&P believes that such payments
will be made within five business days in the absence of a stated grace period or within the earlier of the stated grace period
or the next 30 calendar days. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar
action and where default on an obligation is a virtual certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions. A rating on
an obligation is lowered to ‘D’ if it is subject to a distressed debt restructuring.
103

NR
This indicates that no rating has been requested, or that there is insufficient information on which to base a rating, or that
S&P does not rate a particular obligation as a matter of policy.
Plus (+) or Minus (-): The ratings from ‘AA’ to ‘CCC’ may be modified by the addition of a plus (+) or minus (-) sign to show relative standing within the rating categories.
Fitch Ratings Inc. (Fitch)
AAA
Highest credit quality. “AAA” ratings denote the lowest expectation of credit risk. They are assigned only in case of
exceptionally strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments. This capacity is highly unlikely to be adversely
affected by foreseeable events.
AA
Very high credit quality. “AA” ratings denote a very low expectation of credit risk. They indicate very strong capacity for
timely payment of financial commitments. This capacity is not significantly vulnerable to foreseeable events.
A
High credit quality. “A” ratings denote a low expectation of credit risk. The capacity for timely payment of financial
commitments is considered strong. This capacity may, nevertheless, be more vulnerable to adverse or economic conditions
than is the case for higher ratings.
BBB
Good credit quality. “BBB” ratings indicate that expectations of default are currently low. The capacity for payment of
financial commitments is considered adequate, but adverse business or economic conditions are more likely to impair this
capacity.
BB
Speculative. “BB” ratings indicate an elevated vulnerability to default risk, particularly in the event of adverse economic
conditions over time; however, business or financial flexibility exists that supports the servicing of financial commitments.
B
Highly speculative. “B” ratings indicate that material default risk is present, but a limited margin of safety remains.
Financial commitments are currently being met; however, capacity for continued payment is vulnerable to deterioration in
the business and economic environment.
CCC
Substantial credit risk. Default is a real possibility.
CC
Very high levels of credit risk. Default of some kind appears probable.
C
Near default. A default or default-like process has begun, or the issuer is in standstill, or for a closed funding vehicle,
payment capacity is irrevocably impaired. Conditions that are indicative of a ‘C’ category rating for an issuer include:
 
a. the issuer has entered into a grace or cure period following non-payment of a material financial obligation;
 
b. the issuer has entered into a temporary negotiated waiver or standstill agreement following a payment default on a
material financial obligation;
 
c. the formal announcement by the issuer or its agent of a distressed debt exchange;
 
d. a closed financing vehicle where payment capacity is irrevocably impaired such that it is not expected to pay interest
and/or principal in full during the life of the transaction, but where no payment default is imminent.
RD
Restricted Default. 'RD' ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch’s opinion has experienced:
 
a. an uncured payment default on a bond, loan or other material financial obligation, but
 
b. has not entered into bankruptcy filings, administration, receivership, liquidation, or other formal winding-up procedure,
and
 
c. has not otherwise ceased operating.
 
This would include:
 
i. the selective payment default on a specific class or currency of debt;
 
ii. the uncured expiry of any applicable grace period, cure period or default forbearance period following a payment default
on a bank loan, capital markets security or other material financial obligation;
104

 
iii. the extension of multiple waivers or forbearance periods upon a payment default on one or more material financial
obligations, either in series or in parallel; and
 
iv. ordinary execution of a distressed debt exchange on one or more material financial obligations.
D
Default. “D” ratings indicate an issuer that in Fitch’s opinion has entered into bankruptcy filings, administration,
receivership, liquidation, or other formal winding-up procedure or that has otherwise ceased business.
Plus (+) or Minus (-): The ratings from AA to CCC may be modified by the addition of a plus or minus sign to show relative standing within the major rating categories.
2. Short-Term Debt Ratings:
Moody’s Municipal Obligations
MIG 1 This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by established cash flows, high reliable liquidity support, or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for refinancing.
MIG 2 This designation denotes strong credit quality. Margins of protection are ample, although not as large as in the preceding group.
MIG 3 This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Liquidity and cash-flow protection may be narrow, and market access for refinancing is likely to be less well-established.
SG This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Debt instruments in this category may lack sufficient margins of protection.
Moody’s Demand Obligations
VMIG 1 This designation denotes superior credit quality. Excellent protection is afforded by the superior short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections.
VMIG 2 This designation denotes strong credit quality. Good protection is afforded by the strong short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections.
VMIG 3 This designation denotes acceptable credit quality. Adequate protection is afforded by the satisfactory short-term credit strength of the liquidity provider and structural and legal protections.
SG This designation denotes speculative-grade credit quality. Demand features rated in this category may be supported by a liquidity provider that does not have a sufficiently strong short-term rating or may lack structural or legal protections.
Moody’s Corporate and Government
Prime-1 Ratings of Prime-1 reflect a superior ability to repay short-term obligations.
Prime-2 Ratings of Prime-2 reflect a strong ability to repay short-term obligations.
Prime-3 Ratings of Prime-3 reflect an acceptable ability to repay short-term obligations.
NP Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Not Prime do not fall within any of the Prime rating categories.
S&P Municipal
SP-1 Strong capacity to pay principal and interest. An issue determined to possess a very strong capacity to pay debt service is given a plus (+) designation.
SP-2 Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest, with some vulnerability to adverse financial and economic changes over the term of the notes.
SP-3 Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.
D ‘D’ is assigned upon failure to pay the note when due, completion of a distressed debt restructuring, or the filing of a bankruptcy petition or the taking of similar action and where default on an obligation is a virtual certainty, for example due to automatic stay provisions.
105

Fitch
F1
Highest credit quality. Indicates the strongest capacity for timely payment of financial commitments; may have an added “+”
to denote any exceptionally strong credit feature.
F2
Good credit quality. A satisfactory capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, but the margin of safety is not as
great as in the case of the higher ratings.
F3
Fair credit quality. The capacity for timely payment of financial commitments is adequate; however, near-term adverse
changes could result in a reduction to non-investment grade.
B
Speculative. Minimal capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, plus vulnerability to near-term adverse changes
in financial and economic conditions.
C
High default risk. Default is a real possibility. Capacity for meeting financial commitments is solely reliant upon a sustained,
favorable business and economic environment.
D
Default. Denotes actual or imminent payment default
106

Appendix B - Summary of Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures
Victory Capital Management Inc. (the “Adviser”)
To assist the Adviser in making proxy-voting decisions, the Adviser has adopted a Proxy Voting Policy (“Policy”) that establishes voting guidelines (“Proxy Voting Guidelines”) with respect to certain recurring issues. The Policy is reviewed on an annual basis by the Adviser’s Proxy Committee (“Proxy Committee”) and revised when the Proxy Committee determines that a change is appropriate. The Board annually reviews the Trust’s Proxy Voting Policy and the Adviser’s Policy and determines whether amendments are necessary or advisable.
Voting under the Adviser’s Policy may be executed through administrative screening per established guidelines with oversight by the Proxy Committee or upon vote by a quorum of the Proxy Committee. The Adviser allows its Investment Franchises to modify their voting instructions against that of the default policy on a case-by-case basis, provided sufficient justification is provided and approved by the Proxy Committee. The Adviser delegates to Institutional Shareholder Services (“ISS”), an independent service provider, the non-discretionary administration of proxy voting for the Trust, subject to oversight by the Adviser’s Proxy Committee. In no circumstances shall ISS have the authority to vote proxies except in accordance with standing or specific instructions given to it by the Adviser.
The Adviser votes proxies in the best interests of the Funds and their shareholders. This entails voting client proxies with the objective of increasing the long-term economic value of Fund assets. The Adviser’s Proxy Committee determines how to vote proxies by following established guidelines, which are intended to assist in voting proxies and are not considered to be rigid rules. The Proxy Committee is directed to apply the guidelines as appropriate. On occasion, however, a contrary vote may be warranted when such action is in the best interests of the Funds or if required by the Board or the Funds’ Proxy Voting Policy. In such cases, the Adviser may consider, among other things:
• the effect of the proposal on the underlying value of the securities
• the effect on marketability of the securities
• the effect of the proposal on future prospects of the issuer
• the composition and effectiveness of the issuer’s board of directors
• the issuer’s corporate governance practices
• the quality of communications from the issuer to its shareholders
The Adviser also may take into account independent third-party, general industry guidance or other corporate governance review sources when making decisions. It may additionally seek guidance from other senior internal sources with special expertise on a given topic where it is appropriate. The Adviser generally votes on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration whether implementation of an Environmental, Social, and Governance (“ESG”)-related proposal is likely to enhance or protect shareholder value. The investment team’s opinion concerning the management and prospects of the issuer may be taken into account in determining whether a vote for or against a proposal is in a Fund’s best interests. Insufficient information, onerous requests or vague, ambiguous wording may indicate that a vote against a proposal is appropriate, even when the general principal appears to be reasonable.
The following examples illustrate the Adviser’s policy with respect to some common proxy votes. This summary is not an exhaustive list of all the issues that may arise or of all matters addressed in the Guidelines, and whether the Adviser supports or opposes a proposal will depend upon the specific facts and circumstances described in the proxy statement and other available information.
Directors
• The Adviser generally supports the election of directors in uncontested elections, except when there are issues of accountability, responsiveness, composition, and/or independence.
• The Adviser generally supports proposals for an independent chair taking into account factors such as the current board leadership structure, the company’s governance practices, and company performance.
• The Adviser generally supports proxy access proposals that are in line with the market standards regarding the ownership threshold, ownership duration, aggregation provisions, cap on nominees, and do not contain any other unreasonably restrictive guidelines.
• The Adviser reviews contested elections on a case-by-case basis taking into account such factors as the company performance, particularly the long-term performance relative to the industry; the management track record; the nominee qualifications and
107

compensatory arrangements; the strategic plan of the dissident and its critique of the current management; the likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved; the ownership stakes of the relevant parties; and any other context that is particular to the company and the nature of the election.
Capitalization & Restructuring
• The Adviser generally supports capitalization proposals that facilitate a corporate transaction that is also being supported and for general corporate purposes so long as the increase is not excessive and there are no issues of superior voting rights, company performance, previous abuses of capital, or insufficient justification for the need for additional capital.
Mergers and Acquisitions
• The Adviser reviews mergers and acquisitions on a case-by-case basis to balance the merits and drawbacks of the transaction and factors such as valuation, strategic rationale, negotiations and process, conflicts of interest, and the governance profile of the company post-transaction.
Compensation
• The Adviser reviews all compensation proposals for pay-for-performance alignment, with emphasis on long-term shareholder value; arrangements that risk pay for failure; independence in the setting of compensation; inappropriate pay to non-executive directors, and the quality and rationale of the compensation disclosure.
• The Adviser will generally vote FOR advisory votes on executive compensation (“say on pay”) unless there is a pay-for-performance misalignment; problematic pay practice or non-performance-based element; incentive for excessive risk-taking, options backdating; or a lack of compensation committee communication and/or responsiveness to shareholder concerns.
• The Adviser will vote case-by-case on equity-based compensation plans taking into account factors such as the plan cost; the plan features; and the grant practices as well as any overriding factors that may have a significant negative impact on shareholder interests.
Social and Environmental Issues
• The Adviser generally will vote in line with the Board’s recommendations, with support limited to circumstances where it is considered that greater disclosure will directly enhance or protect shareholder value and is reflective of a clearly established reporting standard in the market.
Occasionally, conflicts of interest arise between the Adviser’s interests and those of a Fund or another client. When this occurs, the Proxy Committee must document the nature of the conflict and vote the proxy in accordance with the Proxy Voting Guidelines unless such guidelines are judged by the Proxy Committee to be inapplicable to the proxy matter at issue. In the event that the Proxy Voting Guidelines are inapplicable or do not mitigate the conflict, the Adviser will seek the opinion of the Adviser’s Chief Compliance Officer or consult with an external independent adviser. In the case of a Proxy Committee member having a personal conflict of interest (e.g. a family member is on the board of the issuer), such member will abstain from voting. Finally, the Adviser reports to the Board annually any proxy votes that took place involving a conflict, including the nature of the conflict and the basis or rationale for the voting decision made.
The Adviser generally will vote on proposals presented to shareholders of portfolio securities held by the Funds. However, the Adviser reserves the right not to vote on such proposals where it determines that the cost of exercising voting rights on behalf of a Fund exceeds the benefit of exercising such voting rights. In addition, the Adviser generally will not vote on proposals presented to shareholders with respect to foreign securities that are on loan under the Victory Funds’ securities lending program. In this connection, the Adviser has determined that the potential return from lending such securities generally is more advantageous to the Victory Fund than recalling such securities from the borrower to exercise voting rights with respect thereto. In addition, the Adviser generally will not vote on proposals presented to shareholders with respect to foreign securities that are subject to share blocking where the foreign company prevents the sale of shares for a certain period of time around the shareholder meeting. For companies in countries with share blocking periods, the disadvantage of being unable to sell the stock regardless of changing conditions typically outweighs the advantages of voting at the shareholder meeting. The Adviser has retained ISS to receive proxy statements, provide voting recommendations, vote shares according to our instructions, and to keep records of our votes on behalf of the Victory Funds. ISS has developed a set of criteria for evaluating and making recommendations on proxy voting issues (for example, elections of boards of directors or mergers and reorganizations). These criteria and general voting recommendations are set forth in the ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines as customized by the Adviser with respect to certain matters. The Adviser retains the authority to determine the final vote for securities held by the Victory Funds.
108

GIM PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES
Granahan Investment Management LLC (“GIM”) views proxy voting as an integral part of the overall investment process and is committed to supporting good governance practices. Our objective is to vote proxies in the best interest of our clients.  The Firm utilizes ISS (the “Provider”) recommendations as an aid in carrying out its proxy voting duties; though GIM retains ultimate authority over the process.
GIM generally votes in unison across all shares managed by GIM, where GIM has voting discretion. If a single account(s) casts a vote that is different from the other accounts, that reason must be well documented and is typically due to a specific request from the client to vote that way.
While GIM largely votes along with the Provider’s recommendations for routine matters, there are cases where GIM believes the recommendation conflicts with the vote that maximizes shareholder value and will vote against the recommendation. GIM expects companies we invest in to be led by an effective board whose approach is consistent with creating long term sustainable growth.  We expect the boards of the companies we own to promote a diverse and inclusive culture, transparency with shareholders, clear division of responsibilities, an appropriate balance of executive and non-executive members and transparency around renumeration.  Boards should ensure sound risk management and internal control systems.  In instances of conflict, the reason for our divergence from the recommendation must be written and approved by the CCO and CIO. The CCO and CIO will ensure there is no conflict of interest, personal or corporate, driving the vote against the recommendation. GIM seeks to vote ballots with the goal of maximizing shareholder value for all clients. In the event GIM chooses to vote against the provider’s recommendation, and that is clearly in conflict with a particular client’s best interest, GIM may choose to cast that client’s shares with a vote that eliminates any conflict.
GIM will evaluate and vote any proxy where the Provider does not give a recommendation or where the recommendation appears to be driven by a conflict of interest at the Provider.
GIM reviews proxy votes on a routine basis to confirm all ballot shares are voted, and to confirm that overrides have proper supporting documentation.
Foreign proxy voting can be impacted by operational issues, such as restricted liquidity while shares are being voted. GIM generally refrains from voting where the process itself impacts the marketability of the security.
GIM periodically assesses the Provider’s ability to continue to provide independent analysis, recommendations, and operational support to our proxy voting responsibilities through factors such as historical experience, perceived independence, and reputation.
LOOMIS SAYLES PROXY VOTING POLICIES AND PROCEDURES
Loomis Sayles uses the services of third parties (each a “Proxy Voting Service” and collectively the “Proxy Voting Services”), to provide research, analysis and voting recommendations and to administer the process of voting proxies for those clients for which Loomis Sayles has voting authority. Any reference in these Proxy Voting Procedures to a “Proxy Voting Service” is a reference either to the Proxy Voting Service that provides research, analysis and voting recommendations to Loomis Sayles or to the Proxy Voting Service that administers the process of voting proxies for Loomis Sayles or to both, as the context may require. Loomis Sayles will generally follow its express policy with input from the Proxy Voting Service that provides research, analysis and voting recommendations to Loomis Sayles unless the Proxy Committee determines that the client’s best interests are served by voting otherwise.
All issues presented for shareholder vote are subject to the oversight of the Proxy Committee, either directly or by application of this policy. All non-routine issues will generally be considered directly by the Proxy Committee and, when necessary, the investment professionals responsible for an account holding the security, and will be voted in the best investment interests of the client. All routine “for” and “against” issues will be voted according to this policy unless special factors require that they be considered by the Proxy Committee and, when necessary, the investment professionals responsible for an account holding the security.
The Proxy Committee’s specific responsibilities include the following:
a. developing, authorizing, implementing and updating the Proxy Voting Procedures, including:
(i) annually reviewing the Proxy Voting Procedures to ensure consistency with internal policies and regulatory agency policies, including determining the continuing adequacy of the Proxy Voting Procedures to confirm that they have been formulated reasonably and implemented effectively, including whether they continue to be reasonably designed to ensure that proxy votes are cast in clients’ best interest,
(ii) annually reviewing existing voting guidelines and developing of additional voting guidelines to assist in the review of proxy proposals, and
109

(iii) annually reviewing the proxy voting process and addressing any general issues that relate to proxy voting;
b. overseeing the proxy voting process, including:
(i) overseeing the vote on proposals according to the predetermined policies in the voting guidelines,
(ii) directing the vote on proposals where there is reason not to vote according to the predetermined policies in the voting guidelines or where proposals require special consideration,
(iii) consulting with the portfolio managers and analysts for the accounts holding the security when necessary or appropriate, and
(iv) periodically sampling or engaging an outside party to sample proxy votes to ensure they comply with the Proxy Voting Procedures and are cast in accordance with the clients’ best interests;
c. engaging and overseeing third-party vendors that materially assist Loomis Sayles with respect to proxy voting, such as the Proxy Voting Services, including:
(i) determining and periodically reassessing whether, as relevant, the Proxy Voting Service has the capacity and competency to adequately analyze proxy issues by considering:
(a) the adequacy and quality of the Proxy Voting Service’s staffing, personnel and technology,
(b) whether the Proxy Voting Service has adequately disclosed its methodologies in formulating voting recommendations, such that Loomis Sayles can understand the factors underlying the Proxy Voting Service’s voting recommendations,
(c) the robustness of the Proxy Voting Service’s policies and procedures regarding its ability to ensure that its recommendations are based on current, materially complete and accurate information, and
(d) the Proxy Voting Service’s policies and procedures regarding how it identifies and addresses conflicts of interest, including whether the Proxy Voting Service’s policies and procedures provide for adequate disclosure of its actual and potential conflicts of interest with respect to the services it provides to Loomis Sayles.
(ii) providing ongoing oversight of the Proxy Voting Services to ensure that proxies continue to be voted in the best interests of clients and in accordance with these Proxy Voting Procedures and the determinations and directions of the Proxy Committee,
(iii) receiving and reviewing updates from the Proxy Voting Services regarding relevant business changes or changes to the Proxy Voting Services’ conflict policies and procedures, and
(iv) in the event that the Proxy Committee becomes aware that a recommendation of the Proxy Voting Service was based on a material factual error (including materially inaccurate or incomplete information): investigating the error, considering the nature of the error and the related recommendation, and determining whether the Proxy Voting Service has taken reasonable steps to reduce the likelihood of similar errors in the future; and
d. further developing and/or modifying these Proxy Voting Procedures as otherwise appropriate or necessary.
Loomis Sayles has established policies and procedures to ensure that proxy votes are voted in its clients’ best interests and are not affected by any possible conflicts of interest. First, except in certain limited instances, Loomis Sayles votes in accordance with its pre-determined policies set forth in these Proxy Voting Procedures. Second, where these Proxy Voting Procedures allow for discretion, Loomis Sayles will generally consider the recommendations of the Proxy Voting Service in making its voting decisions. However, if the Proxy Committee determines that the Proxy Voting Service’s recommendation is not in the best interests of the firm’s clients, then the Proxy Committee may use its discretion to vote against the Proxy Voting Service’s recommendation, but only after taking the following steps: (1) conducting a review for any material conflict of interest Loomis Sayles may have, and (2) if any material conflict is found to exist, excluding anyone at Loomis Sayles who is subject to that conflict of interest from participating in the voting decision in any way. However, if deemed necessary or appropriate by the Proxy Committee after full disclosure of any conflict, that person may provide information, opinions or recommendations on any proposal to the Proxy Committee. In such event, prior to directing any vote, the Proxy Committee will make reasonable efforts to obtain and consider information, opinions and recommendations from or about the opposing position.
110

Wellington Management LLP
Introduction
Wellington Management has adopted and implemented policies and procedures it believes are reasonably designed to ensure that proxies are voted in the best interests of clients for which it exercises proxy-voting discretion.
The purpose of this document is to outline Wellington Management’s approach to executing proxy voting.
Wellington Management’s Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), which are contained in a separate document, set forth broad guidelines and positions on common issues that Wellington Management uses for voting proxies. The Guidelines set out our general expectations on how we vote rather than rigid rules that we apply without consideration of the particular facts and circumstances.
STATEMENT OF POLICY
Wellington Management:
Votes client proxies for clients that have affirmatively delegated proxy voting authority, in writing, unless we have arranged in advance with a particular client to limit the circumstances in which the client would exercise voting authority, or we determine that it is in the best interest of one or more clients to refrain from voting a given proxy.
Seeks to vote proxies in the best financial interests of the clients for which we are voting.
Identifies and resolves all material proxy-related conflicts of interest between the firm and our clients in the best interests of the client.
RESPONSIBILITY AND OVERSIGHT
The Proxy Voting Team monitors regulatory requirements with respect to proxy voting and works with the firm’s Legal and Compliance Group and the Investment Stewardship Committee to develop practices that implement those requirements. The Proxy Voting Team also acts as a resource for portfolio managers and investment research analysts on proxy matters as needed. Day-to-day administration of the proxy voting process is the responsibility of the Proxy Voting Team. The Investment Stewardship Committee a senior, cross-functional group of experienced professionals, is responsible for oversight of the implementation of the Global Proxy Policy and Procedures, review and approval of the Guidelines, and identification and resolution of conflicts of interest. The Investment Stewardship Committee reviews the Guidelines as well as the Global Proxy Policy and Procedures annually.
PROCEDURES
Use of Third-Party Voting Agent
Wellington Management uses the services of a third-party voting agent for research and to manage the administrative aspects of proxy voting. We view third-party research as an input to our process. Wellington Management complements the research provided by its primary voting agent with research from other firms.
Our primary voting agent processes proxies for client accounts and maintains records of proxies voted. For certain routine issues, as detailed below, votes may be instructed according to standing instructions given to our primary voting agent, which are based on the Guidelines.
We manually review instances where our primary voting agent discloses a material conflict of interest of its own, potentially impacting its research outputs. We perform oversight of our primary voting agent, which involves regular service calls and an annual due diligence exercise, as well as regular touchpoints in the normal course of business.
Receipt of Proxy
If a client requests that Wellington Management vote proxies on its behalf, the client must instruct its custodian bank to deliver all relevant voting materials to Wellington Management or its designated voting agent in a timely manner.
Reconciliation
Proxies for public equity securities received by electronic means are matched to the securities eligible to be voted, and a reminder is sent to custodians/trustees that have not forwarded the proxies due. This reconciliation is performed at the ballot level. Although proxies received for private equity securities, as well as those received in non-electronic format for any securities, are voted as received, Wellington Management is not able to reconcile these ballots and does not notify custodians of non-receipt; Wellington Management is only able to reconcile ballots where clients have consented to providing holdings information with its provider for this purpose.
Proxy Voting Process
111

Our approach to voting is investment-led and serves as an influential component of our engagement and escalation strategy. The Investment Stewardship Committee, a cross-functional group of experienced professionals, oversees Wellington Management’s activities with regards to proxy voting practices.
Routine issues that can be addressed by the proxy voting guidance below are voted by means of standing instructions communicated to our primary voting agent. Some votes warrant analysis of specific facts and circumstances and therefore are reviewed individually. We examine such vote sources including internal research notes, third-party voting research and company engagement. While manual votes are often resolved by investment research teams, each portfolio manager is empowered to make a final decision for their relevant client portfolio(s), absent a material conflict of interest. Proactive portfolio manager input is sought under certain circumstances, which may include consideration of position size and proposal subject matter and nature. Where portfolio manager input is proactively sought, deliberation across the firm may occur. This collaboration does not prioritize consensus across the firm above all other interests but rather seeks to inform portfolio managers’ decisions by allowing them to consider multiple perspectives. Portfolio managers may occasionally arrive at different voting conclusions for their clients, resulting in different decisions for the same vote. Voting procedures and the deliberation that occurs before a vote decision are aligned with our role as active owners and fiduciaries for our clients.
Material Conflict of Interest Identification and Resolution Processes
Further detail on our management of conflicts of interest can be found in our Stewardship Conflicts of Interest Policy, available on our website.
OTHER CONSIDERATIONS
In certain instances, Wellington Management may be unable to vote or may determine not to vote a proxy on behalf of one or more clients. While not exhaustive, the following are potential instances in which a proxy vote might not be entered.
Securities Lending
Clients may elect to participate in securities lending Such lending may impact their ability to have their shares voted. Under certain circumstances, and where practical considerations allow, Wellington Management may determine that the anticipated value of voting could outweigh the benefit to the client resulting from use of securities for lending and recommend that a client attempt to have its custodian recall the security to permit voting of related proxies. We do not borrow shares for the sole purpose of exercising voting rights.
Share Blocking and Re-Registration
Certain countries impose trading restrictions or requirements regarding re-registration of securities held in omnibus accounts in order for shareholders to vote a proxy. The potential impact of such requirements is evaluated when determining whether to vote such proxies.
Lack of Adequate Information, Untimely Receipt of Proxy Materials, or Excessive Costs
Wellington Management may abstain from voting a proxy when the proxy statement or other available information is inadequate to allow for an informed vote; the proxy materials are not delivered in a timely fashion; or, in Wellington Management’s judgment, the costs of voting exceed the expected benefits to clients (included but not limited to instances such as when powers of attorney or consularization or the disclosure of client confidential information are required).
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
Wellington Management maintains records related to proxies pursuant to Rule 204-2 of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (the “Advisers Act”), the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”), and other applicable laws. In addition, Wellington Management discloses voting decisions through its website, including the rationale for votes against management.
Wellington Management provides clients with a copy of its Global Proxy Policy and Procedures, as well as the Voting Guidelines, upon written request. In addition, Wellington Management will provide specific client information relating to proxy voting to a client upon written request.
06143-0924
112